0% found this document useful (0 votes)
218 views

FC300 Programming Guide

Uploaded by

Thanh Baron
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
218 views

FC300 Programming Guide

Uploaded by

Thanh Baron
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 246

FC 300 Programming Guide Contents

Contents

1 Introduction 3
Approvals 3
Symbols 3
Abbreviations 4
Definitions 4
Electrical wiring - control cables 10

2 How to Programme 15
The Graphical and Numerical Local Control Panels 15
How to Programme on the Graphical LCP 15
The LCD-Display 15
Display Mode 18
Display Mode - Selection of Read-Outs 19
Parameter Set-Up 20
Quick Menu Key Functions 21
Main Menu Mode 23
Parameter Selection 23
Infinitely Variable Change of Numeric Data Value 24
Read-out and Programming of Indexed Parameters 25
How to Programme on the Numerical Local Control Panel 26
Local Control Keys 27
Initialisation to Default Settings 28

3 Parameter descriptions 29
Parameters: Operation and Display 30
Parameters: Load and Motor 45
Parameters: Brakes 63
2-18 Brake Check Condition 66
Parameters: Reference/Ramps 69
Parameters: Limits/Warnings 83
Parameters: Digital In/Out 89
5-97 Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control 107
5-98 Pulse Out #X30/6 Timeout Preset 107
Parameters: Analog In/Out 107
6-55 Terminal 42 Output Filter 114
6-63 Terminal X30/8 Bus Control 116
6-64 Terminal X30/8 Output Timeout Preset 116
Parameters: Controllers 119
Parameters: Communications and Options 125
Parameters: Profibus 133

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 1


Contents FC 300 Programming Guide

Parameters: DeviceNet CAN Fieldbus 145


Parameters: Smart Logic Control 152
Parameters: Special Functions 168
14-35 Stall Protection 174
Parameters: Drive Information 177
Parameters: Data Read-outs 184
Parameters: Encoder Input 192
Parameters: Data Readouts 2 195

4 Parameter Lists 199


Parameter Lists 199

5 Troubleshooting 229
Warnings/Alarm Messages 229

Index 236

2 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

1 Introduction
1
Programming Guide
Software version: 5.5x

This Programming Guide can be used for all FC 300 frequency converters with software version 5.5x.
The software version number can be seen from par.15-43 Software Version.

1.1.1 Approvals

1.1.2 Symbols

Symbols used in this guide.

NB!
Indicates something to be noted by the reader.

Indicates a general warning.

Indicates a high-voltage warning.

* Indicates default setting

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 3


1 Introduction FC 300 Programming Guide

1.1.3 Abbreviations

1 Alternating current
American wire gauge
AC
AWG
Ampere/AMP A
Automatic Motor Adaptation AMA
Current limit ILIM
Degrees Celsius °C
Direct current DC
Drive Dependent D-TYPE
Electro Magnetic Compatibility EMC
Electronic Thermal Relay ETR
Drive FC
Gram g
Hertz Hz
Kilohertz kHz
Local Control Panel LCP
Meter m
Millihenry Inductance mH
Milliampere mA
Millisecond ms
Minute min
Motion Control Tool MCT
Nanofarad nF
Newton Meters Nm
Nominal motor current IM,N
Nominal motor frequency fM,N
Nominal motor power PM,N
Nominal motor voltage UM,N
Parameter par.
Protective Extra Low Voltage PELV
Printed Circuit Board PCB
Rated Inverter Output Current IINV
Revolutions Per Minute RPM
Regenerative terminals Regen
Second s
Synchronous Motor Speed ns
Torque limit TLIM
Volts V
The maximum output current IVLT,MAX
The rated output current supplied by the frequency converter IVLT,N

1.1.4 Definitions

Frequency converter:
D-TYPE
Size and type of the connected frequency converter (dependencies).

IVLT,MAX
The maximum output current.

IVLT,N
The rated output current supplied by the frequency converter.

UVLT, MAX
The maximum output voltage.

Input:
Group 1 Reset, Coasting stop, Reset and Coasting
Control command stop, Quick-stop, DC braking, Stop and the
You can start and stop the connected motor by means of LCP and the "Off" key.
Group 2 Start, Pulse start, Reversing, Start reversing,
digital inputs. Jog and Freeze output
Functions are divided into two groups.

Functions in group 1 have higher priority than functions in group 2.

Motor:
fJOG
The motor frequency when the jog function is activated (via digital terminals).

fM
The motor frequency.

4 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

fMAX
The maximum motor frequency.

fMIN
The minimum motor frequency.
1
fM,N
The rated motor frequency (nameplate data).

IM
The motor current.

IM,N
The rated motor current (nameplate data).

M-TYPE
Size and type of the connected motor (dependencies).

nM,N
The rated motor speed (nameplate data).

ns
Synchronous motor speed

2 × par . 1 − 23 × 60 s
ns =
par . 1 − 39
PM,N
The rated motor power (nameplate data).

TM,N
The rated torque (motor).

UM
The instantaneous motor voltage.

UM,N
The rated motor voltage (nameplate data).

Break-away torque

ηVLT
The efficiency of the frequency converter is defined as the ratio between the power output and the power input.

Start-disable command
A stop command belonging to the group 1 control commands - see this group.

Stop command
See Control commands.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 5


1 Introduction FC 300 Programming Guide

References:
Analog Reference

1 A signal transmitted to the analog inputs 53 or 54, can be voltage or current.

Binary Reference
A signal transmitted to the serial communication port.

Preset Reference
A defined preset reference to be set from -100% to +100% of the reference range. Selection of eight preset references via the digital terminals.

Pulse Reference
A pulse frequency signal transmitted to the digital inputs (terminal 29 or 33).

RefMAX
Determines the relationship between the reference input at 100% full scale value (typically 10 V, 20mA) and the resulting reference. The maximum
reference value set in par.3-03 Maximum Reference.

RefMIN
Determines the relationship between the reference input at 0% value (typically 0V, 0mA, 4mA) and the resulting reference. The minimum reference value
set in par.3-02 Minimum Reference.

Miscellaneous:
Analog Inputs
The analog inputs are used for controlling various functions of the frequency converter.
There are two types of analog inputs:
Current input, 0-20 mA and 4-20 mA
Voltage input, 0-10 V DC ()
Voltage input, -10 - +10 V DC (FC 302).

Analog Outputs
The analog outputs can supply a signal of 0-20 mA, 4-20 mA.

Automatic Motor Adaptation, AMA


AMA algorithm determines the electrical parameters for the connected motor at standstill.

Brake Resistor
The brake resistor is a module capable of absorbing the brake power generated in regenerative braking. This regenerative braking power increases the
intermediate circuit voltage and a brake chopper ensures that the power is transmitted to the brake resistor.

CT Characteristics
Constant torque characteristics used for all applications such as conveyor belts, displacement pumps and cranes.

Digital Inputs
The digital inputs can be used for controlling various functions of the frequency converter.

Digital Outputs
The frequency converter features two Solid State outputs that can supply a 24 V DC (max. 40 mA) signal.

DSP
Digital Signal Processor.

ETR
Electronic Thermal Relay is a thermal load calculation based on present load and time. Its purpose is to estimate the motor temperature.

Hiperface®
Hiperface® is a registered trademark by Stegmann.

Initialising
If initialising is carried out (par.14-22 Operation Mode), the frequency converter returns to the default setting.

Intermittent Duty Cycle


An intermittent duty rating refers to a sequence of duty cycles. Each cycle consists of an on-load and an off-load period. The operation can be either
periodic duty or non-periodic duty.

LCP
The Local Control Panel (LCP) makes up a complete interface for control and programming of the frequency converter. The control panel is detachable
and can be installed up to 3 metres from the frequency converter, i.e. in a front panel by means of the installation kit option.

lsb
Least significant bit.

6 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

msb
Most significant bit.

MCM
Short for Mille Circular Mil, an American measuring unit for cable cross-section. 1 MCM = 0.5067 mm2.
1
On-line/Off-line Parameters
Changes to on-line parameters are activated immediately after the data value is changed. Changes to off-line parameters are not activated until you enter
[OK] on the LCP.

Process PID
The PID regulator maintains the desired speed, pressure, temperature, etc. by adjusting the output frequency to match the varying load.

PCD
Process Data

Pulse Input/Incremental Encoder


An external, digital pulse transmitter used for feeding back information on motor speed. The encoder is used in applications where great accuracy in
speed control is required.

RCD
Residual Current Device.

Set-up
You can save parameter settings in four Set-ups. Change between the four parameter Set-ups and edit one Set-up, while another Set-up is active.

SFAVM
Switching pattern called Stator Flux oriented Asynchronous Vector Modulation (par.14-00 Switching Pattern).

Slip Compensation
The frequency converter compensates for the motor slip by giving the frequency a supplement that follows the measured motor load keeping the motor
speed almost constant..

Smart Logic Control (SLC)


The SLC is a sequence of user defined actions executed when the associated user defined events are evaluated as true by the Smart Logic Controller.
(Parameter group 13-xx Smart Logic Control (SLC)
The SLC is a sequence of user defined actions executed when the associated user defined events are evaluated as true by the Smart Logic Controller.
(Parameter group 13-xx).

STW
Status Word

FC Standard Bus
Includes RS 485 bus with FC protocol or MC protocol. See par.8-30 Protocol.

Thermistor:
A temperature-dependent resistor placed where the temperature is to be monitored (frequency converter or motor).

Trip
A state entered in fault situations, e.g. if the frequency converter is subject to an over-temperature or when the frequency converter is protecting the
motor, process or mechanism. Restart is prevented until the cause of the fault has disappeared and the trip state is cancelled by activating reset or, in
some cases, by being programmed to reset automatically. Trip may not be used for personal safety.

Trip Locked
A state entered in fault situations when the frequency converter is protecting itself and requiring physical intervention, e.g. if the frequency converter is
subject to a short circuit on the output. A locked trip can only be cancelled by cutting off mains, removing the cause of the fault, and reconnecting the
frequency converter. Restart is prevented until the trip state is cancelled by activating reset or, in some cases, by being programmed to reset automatically.
Trip may not be used for personal safety.

VT Characteristics
Variable torque characteristics used for pumps and fans.

VVCplus
If compared with standard voltage/frequency ratio control, Voltage Vector Control (VVCplus) improves the dynamics and the stability, both when the speed
reference is changed and in relation to the load torque.

60° AVM
Switching pattern called 60°Asynchronous Vector Modulation (par.14-00 Switching Pattern).

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 7


1 Introduction FC 300 Programming Guide

Power Factor 3 x U x I 1 cos ϕ


Power factor =
The power factor is the relation between I1 and IRMS. 3xU x I
RMS

1 The power factor for 3-phase control: I 1 x cos ϕ1 I1


= = since cos ϕ1 = 1
I RMS I RMS

I 12 + I 52 + I 72 + .. + I n2
The power factor indicates to which extent the frequency converter im-
I RMS =
poses a load on the mains supply.
The lower the power factor, the higher the IRMS for the same kW per-
formance.

In addition, a high power factor indicates that the different harmonic currents are low.
The frequency converters' built-in DC coils produce a high power factor, which minimizes the imposed load on the mains supply.

1.1.5 Safety Precautions

The voltage of the frequency converter is dangerous whenever connected to mains. Incorrect installation of the motor, frequency
converter or fieldbus may cause damage to the equipment, serious personal injury or death. Consequently, the instructions in this
manual, as well as national and local rules and safety regulations, must be complied with.

Safety Regulations
1. The mains supply to the frequency converter must be disconnected whenever repair work is to be carried out. Check that the mains supply has
been disconnected and that the necessary time has elapsed before removing motor and mains supply plugs.

2. The [OFF] button on the control panel of the frequency converterr does not disconnect the mains supply and consequently it must not be used
as a safety switch.

3. The equipment must be properly earthed, the user must be protected against supply voltage and the motor must be protected against overload
in accordance with applicable national and local regulations.

4. The earth leakage current exceeds 3.5 mA.

5. Protection against motor overload is not included in the factory setting. If this function is desired, set par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection to data
value ETR trip 1 [4] or data value ETR warning 1 [3].

6. Do not remove the plugs for the motor and mains supply while the frequency converter is connected to mains. Check that the mains supply has
been disconnected and that the necessary time has elapsed before removing motor and mains plugs.

7. Please note that the frequency converter has more voltage sources than L1, L2 and L3, when load sharing (linking of DC intermediate circuit)
or external 24 V DC are installed. Check that all voltage sources have been disconnected and that the necessary time has elapsed before
commencing repair work.

Warning against unintended start


1. The motor can be brought to a stop by means of digital commands, bus commands, references or a local stop, while the frequency converter
is connected to mains. If personal safety considerations (e.g. risk of personal injury caused by contact with moving machine parts following an
unintentional start) make it necessary to ensure that no unintended start occurs, these stop functions are not sufficient. In such cases the mains
supply must be disconnected or the Safe Stop function must be activated.

2. The motor may start while setting the parameters. If this means that personal safety may be compromised (e.g. personal injury caused by
contact with moving machine parts), motor starting must be prevented, for instance by use of the Safe Stop function or secure disconnection
of the motor connection.

3. A motor that has been stopped with the mains supply connected, may start if faults occur in the electronics of the frequency converter, through
temporary overload or if a fault in the power supply grid or motor connection is remedied. If unintended start must be prevented for personal
safety reasons (e.g. risk of injury caused by contact with moving machine parts), the normal stop functions of the frequency converter are not
sufficient. In such cases the mains supply must be disconnected or the Safe Stop function must be activated.

NB!
When using the Safe Stop function, always follow the instructions in the Safe Stop section of the VLT AutomationDrive Design Guide.

8 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

4. Control signals from, or internally within, the frequency converter may in rare cases be activated in error, be delayed or fail to occur entirely.
When used in situations where safety is critical, e.g. when controlling the electromagnetic brake function of a hoist application, these control
signals must not be relied on exclusively.
1
Touching the electrical parts may be fatal - even after the equipment has been disconnected from mains.

Also make sure that other voltage inputs have been disconnected, such as external 24 V DC, load sharing (linkage of DC intermediate circuit), as well as
the motor connection for kinetic back up.
Systems where frequency converters are installed must, if necessary, be equipped with additional monitoring and protective devices according to the
valid safety regulations, e.g law on mechanical tools, regulations for the prevention of accidents etc. Modifications on the frequency converters by means
of the operating software are allowed.

Hoisting applications:
The frequency converter functions for controlling mechanical brakes cannot be considered as a primary safety circuit. There must always be a redundancy
for controlling external brakes.

Protection Mode
Once a hardware limit on motor current or dc-link voltage is exceeded the drive will enter “Protection mode”. “Protection mode” means a change of the
PWM modulation strategy and a low switching frequency to minimize losses. This continues 10 sec after the last fault and increases the reliability and
the robustness of the drive while re-establishing full control of the motor.
In hoist applications “Protection mode” is not usable because the drive will usually not be able to leave this mode again and therefore it will extend the
time before activating the brake – which is not recommendable.
The “Protection mode” can be disabled by setting par.14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault to zero which means that the drive will trip immediately if one
of the hardware limits is exceeded.

NB!
It is recommended to disable protection mode in hoisting applications (par.14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault = 0)

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 9


1 Introduction FC 300 Programming Guide

1.1.6 Electrical wiring - control cables

Illustration 1.1: Diagram showing all electrical terminals without options.


Terminal 37 is the input to be used for Safe Stop. For instructions on Safe Stop installation please refer to the section Safe Stop Installa-
tion of the Design Guide.
* Terminal 37 is not included in (Except A1, which includes Safe Stop).
Terminal 29 and Relay 2, are not included in .

Very long control cables and analogue signals may in rare cases and depending on installation result in 50/60 Hz earth loops due to noise from mains
supply cables.

If this occurs, it may be necessary to break the screen or insert a 100 nF capacitor between screen and chassis.

The digital and analogue inputs and outputs must be connected separately to the common inputs (terminal 20, 55, 39) of the frequency converter to
avoid ground currents from both groups to affect other groups. For example, switching on the digital input may disturb the analog input signal.

10 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

Input polarity of control terminals

130BA681.10
NB!
Control cables must be screened/armoured.

See section entitled Earthing of Screened/Armoured Control Cables for


the correct termination of control cables.

130BA681.10

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 11


1 Introduction FC 300 Programming Guide

1.1.7 Start/Stop

1 Terminal 18 = par. 5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input [8] Start


Terminal 27 = par. 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input [0] No operation (De-
fault coast inverse)
Terminal 37 = Safe stop (where available!)

1.1.8 Pulse Start/Stop

Terminal 18 = par. 5-10 Terminal 18 Digital InputLatched start, [9]


Terminal 27= par. 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital InputStop inverse, [6]
Terminal 37 = Safe stop (where available!)

12 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 1 Introduction

1.1.9 Speed Up/Down

Terminals 29/32 = Speed up/down:.


Terminal 18 = par. 5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input Start [9] (de-
1
fault)

Terminal 27 = par. 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input Freeze refer-


ence [19]

Terminal 29 = par. 5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input Speed up [21]

Terminal 32 = par. 5-14 Terminal 32 Digital Input Speed down


[22]

Note: Terminal 29 only in FC x02 (x=series type).

1.1.10 Potentiometer Reference

Voltage reference via a potentiometer:


Reference Source 1 = [1] Analog input 53 (default)

Terminal 53, Low Voltage = 0 Volt

Terminal 53, High Voltage = 10 Volt

Terminal 53, Low Ref./Feedback = 0 RPM

Terminal 53, High Ref./Feedback = 1500 RPM

Switch S201 = OFF (U)

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 13


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

14 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

2 How to Programme

2.1 The Graphical and Numerical Local Control Panels


The easiest programming of the frequency converter is performed by the Graphical LCP ( 102). It is necessary to consult the frequency converter Design 2
Guide, when using the Numeric Local Control Panel (LCP 101).

2.1.1 How to Programme on the Graphical LCP

The following instructions are valid for the graphical LCP (LCP 102):

The control panel is divided into four functional groups:


1. Graphical display with Status lines.

2. Menu keys and indicator lights - changing parameters and


switching between display functions.

3. Navigation keys and indicator lights (LEDs).

4. Operation keys and indicator lights (LEDs).

All data is displayed in a graphical LCP display, which can show up to five
items of operating data while displaying [Status].

Display lines:
a. Status line: Status messages displaying icons and graphic.

b. Line 1-2: Operator data lines displaying data defined or chosen


by the user. By pressing the [Status] key, up to one extra line
can be added.

c. Status line: Status messages displaying text.

2.1.2 The LCD-Display

The LCD-display has back light and a total of 6 alpha-numeric lines. The display lines show the direction of rotation (arrow), the chosen Set-up as well
as the programming Set-up. The display is divided into 3 sections:

Top section shows up to 2 measurements in normal operating status.


130BP074.10

Top section
The top line in the Middle section shows up to 5 measurements with
related unit, regardless of status (except in the case of alarm/warning).
Middle section

Bottom section always shows the state of the frequency converter in


Bottom section
Status mode.

The Active Set-up (selected as the Active Set-up in par.0-10 Active Set-up) is shown. When programming another Set-up than the Active Set-up, the
number of the programmed Set-up appears to the right.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 15


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

Display Contrast Adjustment

Press [status] and [▲] for darker display

Press [status] and [▼] for brighter display

2 Most parameter set-ups can be changed immediately via the control panel, unless a password has been created via par.0-60 Main Menu Password or via
par.0-65 Quick Menu Password.

Indicator lights (LEDs):

If certain threshold values are exceeded, the alarm and/or warning LED lights up. A status and alarm text appear on the control panel.
The ON LED is activated when the frequency converter receives mains voltage or via a DC bus terminal or 24 V external supply. At the same time, the
back light is on.

• Green LED/On: Control section is working.

• Yellow LED/Warn.: Indicates a warning.

• Flashing Red LED/Alarm: Indicates an alarm.

LCP keys

The control keys are divided into functions. The keys below the display
and indicator lamps are used for parameter Set-up, including choice of
display indication during normal operation. 130BP045.10

[Status] indicates the status of the frequency converter and/or the motor. You can choose between 3 different readouts by pressing the [Status] key:
5 line readouts, 4 line readouts or Smart Logic Control.
Use [Status] for selecting the mode of display or for changing back to Display mode from either the Quick Menu mode, the Main Menu mode or Alarm
mode. Also use the [Status] key to toggle single or double read-out mode.

[Quick Menu] allows quick access to different Quick Menus such as:

- My Personal Menu

- Quick Set-up

- Changes Made

- Loggings

Use [Quick Menu] for programming the parameters belonging to the Quick Menu. It is possible to switch directly between Quick Menu mode and Main
Menu mode.

[Main Menu] is used for programming all parameters.


It is possible to switch directly between Main Menu mode and Quick Menu mode.
Parameter shortcut can be carried out by pressing down the [Main Menu] key for 3 seconds. The parameter shortcut allows direct access to any
parameter.

[Alarm Log] displays an Alarm list of the five latest alarms (numbered A1-A5). To obtain additional details about an alarm, use the arrow keys to
manoeuvre to the alarm number and press [OK]. You will now receive information about the condition of your frequency converter right before entering
the alarm mode.

16 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

[Back] takes you to the previous step or layer in the navigation structure.

[Cancel] annuls your last change or command as long as the display has not been changed.

[Info] supplies information about a command, parameter, or function in


any display window. [Info] provides detailed information whenever help
is needed.
2
Exit info mode by pressing either [Info], [Back], or [Cancel].

Navigation Keys
The four navigation arrows are used to navigate between the different choices available in [Quick Menu], [Main Menu] and [Alarm Log]. Use the
keys to move the cursor.

[OK] is used for choosing a parameter marked by the cursor and for enabling the change of a parameter.

Local Control Key for local control are found at the bottom of the con-
trol panel.

130BP046.10

[Hand On] enables control of the frequency converter via the LCP. [Hand on] also starts the motor, and it is now possible to enter the motor speed data
by means of the arrow keys. The key can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCP
External stop signals activated by means of control signals or a serial bus will override a “start” command via the LCP.
The following control signals will still be active when [Hand on] is activated:

• [Hand on] - [Off] - [Auto on]

• Reset

• Coasting stop inverse

• Reversing

• Set-up select bit 0- Set-up select bit 1

• Stop command from serial communication

• Quick stop

• DC brake

[Off] stops the connected motor. The key can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-41 [Off] Key on LCP. If no external stop function is
selected and the [Off] key is inactive the motor can be stopped by disconnecting the voltage.

[Auto On] enables the frequency converter to be controlled via the control terminals and/or serial communication. When a start signal is applied on the
control terminals and/or the bus, the frequency converter will start. The key can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-42 [Auto on] Key on
LCP.

NB!
An active HAND-OFF-AUTO signal via the digital inputs has higher priority than the control keys [Hand on] – [Auto on].

[Reset] is used for resetting the frequency converter after an alarm (trip). It can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-43 [Reset] Key on
LCP.

The parameter shortcut can be carried out by holding down the [Main Menu] key for 3 seconds. The parameter shortcut allows direct access to any
parameter.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 17


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

2.1.3 Quick Transfer of Parameter Settings between Multiple Frequency Converters

Once the set-up of a frequency converter is complete, we recommend

2
that you store the data in the LCP or on a PC via MCT 10 Set-up Software
Tool.

Data storage in LCP:


1. Go to par. 0-50 LCP Copy

2. Press the [OK] key

3. Select “All to LCP”

4. Press the [OK] key

All parameter settings are now stored in the LCP indicated by the progress bar. When 100% is reached, press [OK].

NB!
Stop the motor before performing this operation.

You can now connect the LCP to another frequency converter and copy the parameter settings to this frequency converter as well.

Data transfer from LCP to frequency converter:


1. Go to par. 0-50 LCP Copy

2. Press the [OK] key

3. Select “All from LCP”

4. Press the [OK] key

The parameter settings stored in the LCP are now transferred to the frequency converter indicated by the progress bar. When 100% is reached, press
[OK].

NB!
Stop the motor before performing this operation.

2.1.4 Display Mode

In normal operation, up to 5 different operating variables can be indicated continuously in the middle section: 1.1, 1.2, and 1.3 as well as 2 and 3.

18 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

2.1.5 Display Mode - Selection of Read-Outs

It is possible to toggle between three status read-out screens by pressing


Operating variable: Unit:
the [Status] key. par.16-00 Control Word hex
Operating variables with different formatting are shown in each status par.16-01 Reference [Unit] [unit]

2
par.16-02 Reference [%] %
screen - see below. par.16-03 Status Word hex
par.16-05 Main Actual Value [%] %
par.16-10 Power [kW] [kW]
The table shows the measurements you can link to each of the operating par.16-11 Power [hp] [HP]
variables. When Options are mounted, additional measurements are par.16-12 Motor Voltage [V]
par.16-13 Frequency [Hz]
available. Define the links via par.0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small, par.16-14 Motor Current [A]
par. 0-21 Display Line 1.2 Small, par. 0-22 Display Line 1.3 Small, par.16-16 Torque [Nm] Nm
par.16-17 Speed [RPM] [RPM]
par. 0-23 Display Line 2 Large, and par. 0-24 Display Line 3 Large.
par.16-18 Motor Thermal %
par.16-20 Motor Angle
par.16-30 DC Link Voltage V
Each readout parameter selected in par.0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small to par.16-32 Brake Energy /s kW
par. 0-24 Display Line 3 Large has its own scale and digits after a possible par.16-33 Brake Energy /2 min kW
par.16-34 Heatsink Temp. C
decimal point. By larger numeric value of a parameter fewer digits are
par.16-35 Inverter Thermal %
displayed after the decimal point. par.16-36 Inv. Nom. Current A
Ex.: Current readout par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current A
par.16-38 SL Controller State
5.25 A; 15.2 A 105 A. par.16-39 Control Card Temp. C
par.16-40 Logging Buffer Full
par.16-50 External Reference
par.16-51 Pulse Reference
par.16-52 Feedback [Unit] [Unit]
par.16-53 Digi Pot Reference
par.16-60 Digital Input bin
par.16-61 Terminal 53 Switch Setting V
par.16-62 Analog Input 53
par.16-63 Terminal 54 Switch Setting V
par.16-64 Analog Input 54
par.16-65 Analog Output 42 [mA] [mA]
par.16-66 Digital Output [bin] [bin]
par.16-67 Pulse Input #29 [Hz] [Hz]
par.16-68 Freq. Input #33 [Hz] [Hz]
par.16-69 Pulse Output #27 [Hz] [Hz]
par.16-70 Pulse Output #29 [Hz] [Hz]
par.16-71 Relay Output [bin]
par.16-72 Counter A
par.16-73 Counter B
par. 16-80 Fieldbus CTW 1 hex
par. 16-82 Fieldbus REF 1 hex
par. 16-84 Comm. Option STW hex
par. 16-85 FC Port CTW 1 hex
par. 16-86 FC Port REF 1 hex
par. 16-90 Alarm Word
par. 16-92 Warning Word
par.16-94 Ext. Status Word

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 19


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

Status screen I:

130BP041.10
This read-out state is standard after start-up or initialization.
Use [INFO] to obtain information about the measurement links to the
1.1
displayed operating variables (1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 2 and 3).
See the operating variables shown in the screen in this illustration.

2
1.2

3 1.3

Status screen II:

130BP062.10
See the operating variables (1.1, 1.2, 1.3 and 2) shown in the screen in
this illustration.
In the example, Speed, Motor current, Motor power and Frequency are
selected as variables in the first and second.
1.3
1.1

1.2

Status screen III:

130BP063.10
This state displays the event and action of the Smart Logic Control. For
further information, see section Smart Logic Control.

2.1.6 Parameter Set-Up

The frequency converter can be used for practically all assignments, which is why the number of parameters is quite large. The frequency converter offers
a choice between two programming modes - a Main Menu and a Quick Menu mode.
The former provides access to all parameters. The latter takes the user through a few parameters making it possible to start operating the frequency
converter.
Regardless of the mode of programming, you can change a parameter both in the Main Menu mode and in the Quick Menu mode.

20 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

2.1.7 Quick Menu Key Functions

Pressing [Quick Menus] The list indicates the different areas contained in
the Quick menu.
Select My Personal Menu to display the chosen personal parameters.
These parameters are selected in par.0-25 My Personal Menu. Up to 20
different parameters can be added in this menu.
2

Select Quick setup to go through a limited amount of parameters to get the motor running almost optimally. The default setting for the other parameters
considers the desired control functions and the configuration of signal inputs/outputs (control terminals).

The selection of parameter is effected by means of the arrow keys. The parameters in the following table are accessible.

Parameter Setting
par.0-01 Language
par.1-20 Motor Power [kW] [kW]
par.1-22 Motor Voltage [V]
par.1-23 Motor Frequency [Hz]
par.1-24 Motor Current [A]
par.1-25 Motor Nominal Speed [rpm]
par. 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input [0] No function*
par.1-29 Automatic Motor Adaptation (AMA) [1] Enable complete AMA
par.3-02 Minimum Reference [rpm]
par.3-03 Maximum Reference [rpm]
par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time [sec]
par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time [sec]
par.3-13 Reference Site

* If terminal 27 is set to “no function”, no connection to +24 V on terminal 27 is necessary.

Select Changes made to get information about:

• the last 10 changes. Use the [▲] [▼] navigation keys to scroll between the last 10 changed parameters.

• the changes made since default setting.

Select Loggings to get information about the display line read-outs. The
information is shown as graphs.
Only display parameters selected in par.0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small and
par. 0-24 Display Line 3 Large can be viewed. It is possible to store up
to 120 samples in the memory for later reference.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 21


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

2.1.8 Initial Commissioning

The easiest way of carrying out the initial commissioning is by using the Quick Menu button and follow the quick set-up procedure using LCP 102 (read
table from left to right). The example applies to open loop applications:

2 Press

Q2 Quick Menu

par.0-01 Language Set language

par.1-20 Motor Power [kW] Set Motor nameplate power

par.1-22 Motor Voltage Set Nameplate voltage

par.1-23 Motor Frequency Set Nameplate frequency

par.1-24 Motor Current Set Nameplate current

par.1-25 Motor Nominal Speed Set Nameplate speed in RPM

If terminal default is Coast inverse it is possible to change this


par. 5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input setting to No function. No connection to terminal 27 is then
needed for running AMA

par.1-29 Automatic Motor Adaptation Set desired AMA function. Enable complete AMA is recommen-
(AMA) ded

par.3-02 Minimum Reference Set the minimum speed of the motor shaft

par.3-03 Maximum Reference Set the maximum speed of the motor shaft

Set the ramping up time with reference to synchronous motor


par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time
speed, ns

Set the ramping down time with reference to synchronous mo-


par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time
tor speed, ns

par.3-13 Reference Site Set the site from where the reference must work

22 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

2.1.9 Main Menu Mode

Start the Main Menu mode by pressing the [Main Menu] key. The read-

130BP066.10
out shown to the right appears on the display.
The middle and bottom sections on the display show a list of parameter
groups which can be chosen by toggling the up and down buttons.
2

Each parameter has a name and number which remain the same regardless of the programming mode. In the Main Menu mode, the parameters are
divided into groups. The first digit of the parameter number (from the left) indicates the parameter group number.

All parameters can be changed in the Main Menu. However, depending on the choice of configuration (par.1-00 Configuration Mode), some parameters
can be "missing". E.g. open loop hides all the PID parameters, and other enabled options make more parameter groups visible.

2.1.10 Parameter Selection

In the Main menu mode, the parameters are divided into groups. You
Group no. Parameter group:
select a parameter group by means of the navigation keys. 0 Operation/Display
The following parameter groups are accessible: 1 Load/Motor
2 Brakes
3 References/Ramps
4 Limits/Warnings
5 Digital In/Out
6 Analog In/Out
7 Controls
8 Comm. and Options
9 Profibus
10 CAN Fieldbus
11 Reserved Com. 1
12 Reserved Com. 2
13 Smart Logic
14 Special Functions
15 Drive Information
16 Data Readouts
17 Motor Feedb. Option
18 Data Readouts 2
30 Special Features
32 MCO Basic Settings
33 MCO Adv. Settings
34 MCO Data Readouts

After selecting a parameter group, choose a parameter by means of the


130BP067.10

navigation keys.
The middle section on the display shows the parameter number and name
as well as the selected parameter value.

2.1.11 Changing Data

The procedure for changing data is the same whether you select a parameter in the Quick menu or the Main menu mode. Press [OK] to change the
selected parameter.
The procedure for changing data depends on whether the selected parameter represents a numerical data value or a text value.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 23


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

2.1.12 Changing a Text Value

If the selected parameter is a text value, change the text value by means

130BP068.10
of the [▲] [▼] navigation keys.
The up key increases the value, and the down key decreases the value.

2 Place the cursor on the value you want to save and press [OK].

2.1.13 Changing a Group of Numeric Data Values

If the chosen parameter represents a numeric data value, change the

130BP069.10
chosen data value by means of the [◀] [▶] navigation keys as well as

the [▲] [▼] navigation keys. Use the [◀] [▶] navigation keys to move
the cursor horizontally.

Use the [▲] [▼] navigation keys to change the data value. The up key

130BP070.10
enlarges the data value, and the down key reduces the data value. Place
the cursor on the value you want to save and press [OK].

2.1.14 Infinitely Variable Change of Numeric Data Value

If the chosen parameter represents a numeric data value, select a digit


130BP073.10

by means of the [◀] [▶] navigation keys.

24 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

Change the selected digit infinitely variably by means of the [▲] [▼]

130BP072.10
navigation keys.
The chosen digit is indicated by the cursor. Place the cursor on the digit
you want to save and press [OK].

2.1.15 Changing a Data Value, Step-by-Step

Certain parameters can be changed step by step or infinitely varying. This applies to par. 1-20 Motor Power [kW], par. 1-22 Motor Voltage and
par. 1-23 Motor Frequency.
The parameters are changed both as a group of numeric data values and as numeric data values infinitely varying.

2.1.16 Read-out and Programming of Indexed Parameters

Parameters are indexed when placed in a rolling stack.


par.15-30 Fault Log: Error Code to par.15-32 Alarm Log: Time contain a fault log which can be read out. Choose a parameter, press [OK], and use the
[▲] [▼] navigation keys to scroll through the value log.

Use par.3-10 Preset Reference as another example:


Choose the parameter, press [OK], and use the [▲] [▼] navigation keys to scroll through the indexed values. To change the parameter value, select the

indexed value and press [OK]. Change the value by using the [▲] [▼] keys. Press [OK] to accept the new setting. Press [CANCEL] to abort. Press [Back]
to leave the parameter.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 25


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

2.1.17 How to Programme on the Numerical Local Control Panel

The following instructions are valid for the Numerical LCP (LCP 101).
The control panel is divided into four functional groups:

1. Numerical display.

2 2. Menu keys and indicator lights - changing parameters and


switching between display functions.

3. Navigation keys and indicator lights (LEDs).

4. Operation keys and indicator lights (LEDs).

Display line: Status messages displaying icons and numeric val-


ue.

Indicator lights (LEDs):

• Green LED/On: Indicates if control section is on.

• Yellow LED/Wrn.: Indicates a warning.

• Flashing red LED/Alarm: Indicates an alarm.

LCP keys
[Menu] Select one of the following modes:

• Status

• Quick Setup

• Main Menu

Status Mode: Displays the status of the frequency converter or the mo-

130BP077.10
tor.
If an alarm occurs the NLCP automatically switches to status mode.
A number of alarms can be displayed.

NB!
Parameter copy is not possible with LCP 101 Numerical
Local Control Panel.
130BP078.10

26 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 2 How to Programme

Main Menu/ Quick Setup is used for programming all parameters or

130BP079.10
only the parameters in the Quick Meny (see also description of the LCP
102 earlier in this chapter).
The parameter values can be changed using the [▲] [▼] keys when the
value is flashing.
Select Main Menu by pressing [Menu] key a number of times.
Select the parameter group [xx-__] and press [OK]
2
Select the parameter [__-xx] and press [OK]
If the parameter is an array parameter select the array number and press
[OK]
Select the wanted data value and press [OK]
Parameters with functional choices display values such as [1], [2], etc.
For a description of the different choices, see the individual description
of the parameters in the Parameter Selection section

[Back] for stepping backwards


Arrow [▲] [▼] keys are used for manoeuvring between commands and
within parameters.

2.1.18 Local Control Keys

Keys for local control are found at the bottom of the LCP.

130BP046.10

[Hand on] enables control of the frequency converter via the LCP. [Hand on] also starts the motor and it is now possible to enter the motor speed data
by means of the arrow keys. The key can be selected as Enable [1] og Disable [0] via par.0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCP.
External stop signals activated by means of control signals or a serial bus will override a 'start' command via the LCP.
The following control signals will still be active when [Hand on] is activated:

• [Hand on] - [Off] - [Auto on]

• Reset

• Coasting stop inverse

• Reversing

• Set-up select lsb - Set-up select msb

• Stop command from serial communication

• Quick stop

• DC brake

[Off] stops the connected motor. The key can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-41 [Off] Key on LCP .
If no external stop function is selected and the [Off] key is inactive the motor can be stopped by disconnecting the voltage.

[Auto on] enables the frequency converter to be controlled via the control terminals and/or serial communication. When a start signal is applied on the
control terminals and/or the bus, the frequency converter will start. The key can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-42 [Auto on] Key on
LCP.

NB!
An active HAND-OFF-AUTO signal via the digital inputs has higher priority than the control keys [Hand on] [Auto on].

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 27


2 How to Programme FC 300 Programming Guide

[Reset] is used for resetting the frequency converter after an alarm (trip). It can be selected as Enable [1] or Disable [0] via par.0-43 [Reset] Key on
LCP.

2.1.19 Initialisation to Default Settings

2 Initialise the frequency converter to default settings in two ways:

Recommended initialisation (via par.14-22 Operation Mode)

1. Select par. 14-22 Operation Mode par. 14-22 Operation Mode initialises all except:
2. Press [OK] par.14-50 RFI Filter
3. Select “Initialisation” par.8-30 Protocol
4. Press [OK] par.8-31 Address
5. Cut off the mains supply and wait until the display turns off. par.8-32 FC Port Baud Rate
6. Reconnect the mains supply - the frequency converter is now par.8-35 Minimum Response Delay
reset. par.8-36 Max Response Delay
par.8-37 Max Inter-Char Delay
par.15-00 Operating Hours to par.15-05 Over Volt's
par.15-20 Historic Log: Event to par.15-22 Historic Log: Time
par.15-30 Fault Log: Error Code to par.15-32 Alarm Log: Time

Manual initialisation

1. Disconnect from mains and wait until the display turns off. This procedure initialises all except:
2a. Press [Status] - [Main Menu] - [OK] at the same time while par.15-00 Operating Hours
power up for LCP 102, Graphical Display par.15-03 Power Up's
2b. Press [Menu] while power up for LCP 101, Numerical Display par.15-04 Over Temp's
3. Release the keys after 5 s. par.15-05 Over Volt's
4. The frequency converter is now programmed according to
default settings.

NB!
When you carry out manual initialisation, you also reset serial communication, RFI filter settings (par.14-50 RFI Filter) and fault log
settings.

28 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3 Parameter descriptions

3.1 Parameter Selection


Parameters for FC 300 are grouped into various parameter groups for easy selection of the correct parameters for optimized operation of the frequency
converter.
0-xx Operation and Display parameters
3
• Basic Settings, set-up handling

• Display and Local Control Panel parameters for choosing readouts, setting up selections and copying functions

1-xx Load and Motor parameters includes all load and motor related parameters

2-xx Brake parameters

• DC brake

• Dynamic brake (Resistor brake)

• Mechanical brake

• Over Voltage Control

3-xx References and ramping parameters includes DigiPot function

4-xx Limits Warnings; setting of limits and warning parameters

5-xx Digital inputs and outputs includes relay controls

6-xx Analog inputs and outputs

7-xx Controls; Setting parameters for speed and process controls

8-xx Communication and option parameters for setting of FC RS485 and FC USB port parameters.

9-xx Profibus parameters

10-xx DeviceNet and CAN Fieldbus parameters

13-xx Smart Logic Control parameters

14-xx Special function parameters

15-xx Drive information parameters

16-xx Readout parameters

17-xx Encoder Option parameters

18-xx Readout 2 parameters

30-xx Special Features

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 29


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.2 Parameters: Operation and Display


3.2.1 0-** Operation / Display

Parameters related to the fundamental functions of the frequency converter, function of the LCP buttons and configuration of the LCP display.

3 3.2.2 0-0* Basic Settings

Parameter group for basic frequency converter settings.

30 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

0-01 Language
Option: Function:
Defines the language to be used in the display. The frequency converter can be delivered with 4
different language packages. English and German are included in all packages. English cannot be
erased or manipulated.

[0] * English Part of Language packages 1 - 4

[1] Deutsch Part of Language packages 1 - 4

[2] Francais Part of Language package 1


3
[3] Dansk Part of Language package 1

[4] Spanish Part of Language package 1

[5] Italiano Part of Language package 1

[6] Svenska Part of Language package 1

[7] Nederlands Part of Language package 1

[10] Chinese Part of Language package 2

[20] Suomi Part of Language package 1

[22] English US Part of Language package 4

[27] Greek Part of Language package 4

[28] Bras.port Part of Language package 4

[36] Slovenian Part of Language package 3

[39] Korean Part of Language package 2

[40] Japanese Part of Language package 2

[41] Turkish Part of Language package 4

[42] Trad.Chinese Part of Language package 2

[43] Bulgarian Part of Language package 3

[44] Srpski Part of Language package 3

[45] Romanian Part of Language package 3

[46] Magyar Part of Language package 3

[47] Czech Part of Language package 3

[48] Polski Part of Language package 4

[49] Russian Part of Language package 3

[50] Thai Part of Language package 2

[51] Bahasa Indonesia Part of Language package 2

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 31


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

0-02 Motor Speed Unit


Option: Function:
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.
The display showing depends on settings in par.0-02 Motor Speed Unit and par. 0-03 Regional
Settings. The default setting of par.0-02 Motor Speed Unit and par. 0-03 Regional Settings depends
on which region of the world the frequency converter is supplied to, but can be re-programmed as
required.

3 NB!
Changing the Motor Speed Unit will reset certain parameters to their initial value.
It is recommended to select the motor speed unit first, before modifying other
parameters.

[0] RPM Selects display of motor speed variables and parameters (i.e. references, feedbacks and limits) in
terms of motor speed (RPM).

[1] * Hz Selects display of motor speed variables and parameters (i.e. references, feedbacks and limits) in
terms of output frequency to the motor (Hz).

0-03 Regional Settings


Option: Function:
[0] * International Activates par.1-20 Motor Power [kW] for setting the motor power in kW and sets the default value
of par.1-23 Motor Frequency to 50 Hz.

[1] US Activates par.1-62 Slip Compensation for setting the motor power in HP and sets the default value
of par.1-23 Motor Frequency to 60 Hz.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

0-04 Operating State at Power-up (Hand)


Option: Function:
Selects the operating mode upon reconnection of the frequency converter to mains voltage after
power down in Hand (local) operation mode.

[0] Resume Restarts the frequency converter maintaining the same local reference and the same start/stop
settings (applied by [HAND ON/OFF]) as before the frequency converter was powered down.

[1] * Forced stop, ref=old Restarts the frequency converter with a saved local reference, after mains voltage reappears and
after pressing [HAND ON].

[2] Forced stop, ref=0 Resets the local reference to 0 upon restarting the frequency converter.

3.2.3 0-1* Set-up Operations

Define and control the individual parameter setups.


The frequency converter has four parameter setups that can be programmed independently of each other. This makes the frequency converter very
flexible and able to solve advanced control functionality problems, often saving the cost of external control equipment. For example these can be used
to program the frequency converter to operate according to one control scheme in one setup (e.g. motor 1 for horizontal movement) and another control
scheme in another setup (e.g. motor 2 for vertical movement). Alternatively they can be used by an OEM machine builder to identically program all their
factory fitted frequency converters for different machine types within a range to have the same parameters and then during production/commissioning
simply select a specific setup depending on which machine the frequency converter is installed on.
The active setup (i.e. the setup in which the frequency converter is currently operating) can be selected in par.0-10 Active Set-up and is displayed in the
LCP. Using Multi set-up it is possible to switch between setups with the frequency converter running or stopped, via digital input or serial communication
commands. If it is necessary to change setups whilst running, ensure par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to is programmed as required. Using par.0-11 Edit Set-
up it is possible to edit parameters within any of the setups whilst continuing the frequency converter operation in its Active Setup which can be a different
setup to that being edited. Using par.0-51 Set-up Copy it is possible to copy parameter settings between the setups to enable quicker commissioning if
similar parameter settings are required in different setups.

32 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

0-10 Active Set-up


Option: Function:
Select the set-up to control the frequency converter functions.

[0] Factory setup Cannot be changed. It contains the Danfoss data set, and can be used as a data source when
returning the other set-ups to a known state.

[1] * Set-up 1 Set-up 1 [1] to Set-up 4 [4] are the four separate parameter set-ups within which all parameters
can be programmed.

[2] Set-up 2
3
[3] Set-up 3

[4] Set-up 4

[9] Multi Set-up Remote selection of set-ups using digital inputs and the serial communication port. This set-up uses
the settings from par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to. Stop the frequency converter before making
changes to open- and closed loop functions

Use par.0-51 Set-up Copy to copy a set-up to one or all other set-ups. Stop the frequency converter before switching between set-ups where parameters
marked ‘not changeable during operation’ have different values. To avoid conflicting settings of the same parameter within two different set-ups, link the
set-ups together using par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to. Parameters which are ‘not changeable during operation’ are marked FALSE in the parameter lists
in the section Parameter Lists.

0-11 Edit Set-up


Option: Function:
Select the set-up to be edited (i.e. programmed) during operation; either the active set-up or one
of the inactive set-ups.

[0] Factory setup Cannot be edited but it is useful as a data source to return the other set-ups to a known state.

[1] * Set-up 1 Set-up 1 [1] to Set-up 4 [4] can be edited freely during operation, independently of the active set-
up.

[2] Set-up 2

[3] Set-up 3

[4] Set-up 4

[9] Active Set-up Can also be edited during operation. Edit the chosen set-up from a range of sources: LCP, FC RS485,
FC USB or up to five fieldbus sites.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 33


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

0-12 This Set-up Linked to


Option: Function:
To enable conflict-free changes from one set-up to another during operation, link set-ups containing
parameters which are not changeable during operation. The link will ensure synchronising of the
‘not changeable during operation’ parameter values when moving from one set-up to another during
operation. ‘Not changeable during operation’ parameters can be identified by the label FALSE in the
parameter lists in the section Parameter Lists.

par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to is used by Multi set-up in par.0-10 Active Set-up. Multi set-up is used
to move from one set-up to another during operation (i.e. while the motor is running).
Example:
Use Multi set-up to shift from Set-up 1 to Set-up 2 whilst the motor is running. Programme in Set-
up 1 first, then ensure that Set-up 1 and Set-up 2 are synchronised (or ‘linked’). Synchronisation
can be performed in two ways:
1. Change the edit set-up to Set-up 2 [2] in par.0-11 Edit Set-up and set par.0-12 This Set-up Linked
to to Set-up 1 [1]. This will start the linking (synchronising) process.
130BP075.10

OR

2. While still in Set-up 1, copy Set-up 1 to Set-up 2. Then set par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to to Set-
up 2 [2]. This will start the linking process.

34 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

130BP076.10
3

After the link is complete, par.0-13 Readout: Linked Set-ups will read {1,2} to indicate that all ‘not
changeable during operation’ parameters are now the same in Set-up 1 and Set-up 2. If there are
changes to a ‘not changeable during operation’ parameter, e.g. par.1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs), in
Set-up 2, they will also be changed automatically in Set-up 1. A switch between Set-up 1 and Set-
up 2 during operation is now possible.

[0] * Not linked

[1] Set-up 1

[2] Set-up 2

[3] Set-up 3

[4] Set-up 4

0-13 Readout: Linked Set-ups


Array [5]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View a list of all the set-ups linked by means of par. 0-12 This Set-up Linked to. The parameter has
one index for each parameter set-up. The parameter value displayed for each index represents
which setups are linked to that parameter setup.

Index LCP value


0 {0}
1 {1,2}
2 {1,2}
3 {3}
4 {4}

Table 3.2: Example: Set-up 1 and Set-up 2 are linked

0-14 Readout: Edit Set-ups / Channel


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-2147483648 - 2147483647 N/A] View the setting of par.0-11 Edit Set-up for each of the four different communication channels.
When the number is displayed in hex, as it is in the LCP, each number represents one channel.
Numbers 1-4 represent a set-up number; ‘F’ means factory setting; and ‘A’ means active set-up.
The channels are, from right to left: LCP, FC-bus, USB, HPFB1-5.
Example: The number AAAAAA21h means that the FC bus selected Set-up 2 in par.0-11 Edit Set-
up, the LCP selected Set-up 1 and all others used the active set-up.

3.2.4 0-2* LCP Display

Define the variables displayed in the Graphical Local Control Panel.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 35


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

NB!
Please refer to par. 0-37 Display Text 1, par. 0-38 Display Text 2 and par. 0-39 Display Text 3 for information on how to write display
texts

0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small


Option: Function:

3 [0] None
Select a variable for display in line 1, left position.

No display value selected.

[953] Profibus Warning Word

[1005] Readout Transmit Error Counter

[1006] Readout Receive Error Counter

[1007] Readout Bus Off Counter

[1013] Warning Parameter

[1230] Warning Parameter

[1472] VLT Alarm Word

[1473] VLT Warning Word

[1474] VLT Ext. Status Word

[1501] Running Hours

[1502] kWh Counter

[1600] Control Word Present control word

[1601] Reference [Unit] Total reference (sum of digital/analog/preset/bus/freeze ref./catch up and slow-down) in selected
unit.

[1602] Reference % Total reference (sum of digital/analog/preset/bus/freeze ref./catch up and slow-down) in percent.

[1603] Status Word Present status word.

[1605] Main Actual Value [%] Actual value as a percentage.

[1609] Custom Readout

[1610] Power [kW] Actual power consumed by the motor in kW.

[1611] Power [hp] Actual power consumed by the motor in HP.

[1612] Motor Voltage Voltage supplied to the motor.

[1613] Frequency Motor frequency, i.e. the output frequency from the frequency converter in Hz

[1614] Motor Current Phase current of the motor measured as effective value.

[1615] Frequency [%] Motor frequency, i.e. the output frequency from the frequency converter in percent.

[1616] Torque [Nm]

[1617] * Speed [RPM] Speed in RPM (revolutions per minute) i.e. the motor shaft speed in closed loop.

[1618] Motor Thermal Thermal load on the motor, calculated by the ETR function.

[1619] KTY sensor temperature

[1620] Motor Angle

[1622] Torque [%]

[1625] Torque [Nm] High

[1630] DC Link Voltage Intermediate circuit voltage in the frequency converter.

[1632] Brake Energy /s

[1633] Brake Energy /2 min

36 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1634] Heatsink Temp. Present heat sink temperature of the frequency converter. The cut-out limit is 95 ±5 oC; cutting
back in occurs at 70 ±5° C.

[1635] Inverter Thermal Percentage load of the inverters.

[1636] Inv. Nom. Current Nominal current of the frequency converter.

[1637] Inv. Max. Current Maximum current of the frequency converter.

[1638] SL Controller State

[1639] Control Card Temp. Temperature of the control card.


3
[1650] External Reference Sum of the external reference as a percentage, i.e. the sum of analog/pulse/bus.

[1651] Pulse Reference Frequency in Hz connected to the digital inputs (18, 19 or 32, 33).

[1652] Feedback [Unit] Reference value from programmed digital input(s).

[1653] Digi Pot Reference

[1660] Digital Input Signal states form the 6 digital terminals (18, 19, 27, 29, 32 and 33). Input 18 corresponds to the
bit at the far left. Signal low = 0; Signal high = 1.

[1661] Terminal 53 Switch Setting Setting of input terminal 54. Current = 0; Voltage = 1.

[1662] Analog Input 53 Actual value at input 53 either as a reference or protection value.

[1663] Terminal 54 Switch Setting Setting of input terminal 54. Current = 0; Voltage = 1.

[1664] Analog Input 54 Actual value at input 54 either as reference or protection value.

[1665] Analog Output 42 [mA] Actual value at output 42 in mA. Use par.6-50 Terminal 42 Output to select the value to be shown.

[1666] Digital Output [bin] Binary value of all digital outputs.

[1667] Freq. Input #29 [Hz] Actual value of the frequency applied at terminal 29 as an impulse input.

[1668] Freq. Input #33 [Hz] Actual value of the frequency applied at terminal 33 as an impulse input.

[1669] Pulse Output #27 [Hz] Actual value of impulses applied to terminal 27 in digital output mode.

[1670] Pulse Output #29 [Hz] Actual value of impulses applied to terminal 29 in digital output mode.

[1671] Relay Output [bin]

[1672] Counter A Application dependent (e.g. SLC Control)

[1673] Counter B Application dependent (e.g. SLC Control)

[1674] Prec. Stop Counter Display the actual counter value.

[1675] Analog In X30/11

[1676] Analog In X30/12

[1677] Analog Out X30/8 [mA]

[1678] Analog Out X45/1 [mA]

[1679] Analog Out X45/3 [mA]

[1680] Fieldbus CTW 1 Control word (CTW) received from the Bus Master.

[1682] Fieldbus REF 1 Main reference value sent with control word from the Bus Master.

[1684] Comm. Option STW Extended fieldbus communication option status word.

[1685] FC Port CTW 1 Control word (CTW) received from the Bus Master.

[1686] FC Port REF 1 Status word (STW) sent to the Bus Master.

[1690] Alarm Word One or more alarms in a Hex code.

[1691] Alarm Word 2 One or more alarms in a Hex code.

[1692] Warning Word One or more warnings in a Hex code.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 37


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1693] Warning Word 2 One or more warnings in a Hex code.

[1694] Ext. Status Word One or more status conditions in a Hex code.

[1890] Process PID Error

[1891] Process PID Output

[1892] Process PID Clamped Output

[1893] Process PID Gain Scaled Output

3 [3019]

[3401]
Wobble Delta Freq. Scaled

PCD 1 Write to MCO

[3402] PCD 2 Write to MCO

[3403] PCD 3 Write to MCO

[3404] PCD 4 Write to MCO

[3405] PCD 5 Write to MCO

[3406] PCD 6 Write to MCO

[3407] PCD 7 Write to MCO

[3408] PCD 8 Write to MCO

[3409] PCD 9 Write to MCO

[3410] PCD 10 Write to MCO

[3421] PCD 1 Read from MCO

[3422] PCD 2 Read from MCO

[3423] PCD 3 Read from MCO

[3424] PCD 4 Read from MCO

[3425] PCD 5 Read from MCO

[3426] PCD 6 Read from MCO

[3427] PCD 7 Read from MCO

[3428] PCD 8 Read from MCO

[3429] PCD 9 Read from MCO

[3430] PCD 10 Read from MCO

[3440] Digital Inputs

[3441] Digital Outputs

[3450] Actual Position

[3451] Commanded Position

[3452] Actual Master Position

[3453] Slave Index Position

[3454] Master Index Position

[3455] Curve Position

[3456] Track Error

[3457] Synchronizing Error

[3458] Actual Velocity

[3459] Actual Master Velocity

[3460] Synchronizing Status

[3461] Axis Status

[3462] Program Status

[3464] MCO 302 Status

[3465] MCO 302 Control

[3470] MCO Alarm Word 1

[3471] MCO Alarm Word 2

38 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[9913] Idle time

[9914] Paramdb requests in queue

[9920] HS Temp. (PC1)

[9921] HS Temp. (PC2)

[9922] HS Temp. (PC3)

[9923] HS Temp. (PC4)

[9924] HS Temp. (PC5)

[9925] HS Temp. (PC6) 3


[9926] HS Temp. (PC7)

[9927] HS Temp. (PC8)

0-21 Display Line 1.2 Small


Option: Function:
[1614] * Motor Current Select a variable for display in line 1, middle position. The options are the same as listed for par.
0-20.

0-22 Display Line 1.3 Small


Option: Function:
[1610] * Power [kW] Select a variable for display in line 1, right position. The options are the same as listed for par. 0-20.

0-23 Display Line 2 Large


Option: Function:
[1613] * Frequency Select a variable for display in line 2. The options are the same as listed for par. 0-20.

0-24 Display Line 3 Large


Option: Function:
[1602] * Reference % Select a variable for display in line 3. The options are the same as listed for par. 0-20.

0-25 My Personal Menu


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A]

3.2.5 0-3*LCP Custom Readout

It is possible to customize the display elements for various purposes: *Custom Readout. Value proportional to speed (Linear, squared or cubed depending
on unit selected in par. 0-30 Custom Readout Unit) *Display Text. Text string stored in a parameter.

Custom Readout
The calculated value to be displayed is based on settings in par. 0-30 Custom Readout Unit, par. 0-31 Custom Readout Min Value (linear only), par.
0-32 Custom Readout Max Value, par. 4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM], par.4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] and actual speed.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 39


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

The relation will depend on the type of unit selected in par. 0-30 Custom Readout Unit:

Unit Type Speed Relation


Dimensionless Linear
Speed
Flow, volume
Flow, mass
Velocity
Length
Temperature
Pressure Quadratic
Power Cubic

0-30 Unit for User-defined Readout


Option: Function:
It is possible to program a value to be shown in the display of the LCP. The value will have a linear,
squared or cubed relation to speed. This relation will depend on the unit selected (see table above).
The actual calculated value can be read in par.16-09 Custom Readout, and/or shown in the display
be selecting Custom Readout [16-09] in par.0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small to par. 0-24 Display Line 3
Large.

[0] * None

[1] %

[5] PPM

[10] 1/min

[11] rpm

[12] Pulse/s

[20] l/s

[21] l/min

[22] l/h

[23] m³/s

[24] m³/min

[25] m³/h

[30] kg/s

[31] kg/min

[32] kg/h

40 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[33] t/min

[34] t/h

[40] m/s

[41] m/min

[45] m

[60] °C

[70] mbar

[71] bar 3
[72] Pa

[73] kPa

[74] m WG

[80] kW

[120] GPM

[121] gal/s

[122] gal/min

[123] gal/h

[124] CFM

[125] ft³/s

[126] ft³/min

[127] ft³/h

[130] lb/s

[131] lb/min

[132] lb/h

[140] ft/s

[141] ft/min

[145] ft

[160] °F

[170] psi

[171] lb/in²

[172] in WG

[173] ft WG

[180] HP

0-31 Min Value of User-defined Readout


Range: Function:
0.00 Cus- [-999999.99 - par. 0-32 Custom- This parameter sets the min. value of the custom defined readout (occurs at zero speed). Only
tomReadou- ReadoutUnit] possible to set different from 0 is when selecting a linear unit in par.0-30 Unit for User-defined
tUnit* Readout. For Quadratic and Cubic units the minimum value will be 0.

0-32 Custom Readout Max Value


Range: Function:
100.00 Cus- [par. 0-31 - 999999.99 CustomRea- This parameter sets the max value to be shown when the speed of the motor has reached the set
tomReadou- doutUnit] value for par. 4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM] or par.4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] (depends
tUnit* on setting in par. 0-02).

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 41


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.2.6 LCP Keypad, 0-4*

Enable, disable and password protect individual keys on the LCP.

0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCP


Option: Function:
[0] Disabled No function

[1] * Enabled [Hand on] Key enabled

3 [2] Password Avoid unauthorized start in Hand mode. If par.0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCPis included in the My
Personal Menu, then define the password in par. 0-65 Personal Menu Password. Otherwise define
the password in par.0-60 Main Menu Password.

0-41 [Off] Key on LCP


Option: Function:
[0] * Disabled Avoids accidental stop of the frequency converter.

[1] * Enabled

[2] Password Avoids unauthorised stop. If par.0-41 [Off] Key on LCP is included in the Quick Menu, then define
the password in par.0-65 Quick Menu Password.

[3] Hand Off/On

[4] Hand Off/On w. Passw.

0-42 [Auto on] Key on LCP


Option: Function:
[0] * Disabled avoid accidental start of the frequency converter in Auto mode.

[1] * Enabled

[2] Password Avoids unauthorised start in Auto mode. If par.0-42 [Auto on] Key on LCP is included in the Quick
Menu, then define the password in par.0-65 Quick Menu Password.

[3] Hand Off/On

[4] Hand Off/On w. Passw.

0-43 [Reset] Key on LCP


Option: Function:
[0] * Disabled Avoids accidental alarm reset.

[1] * Enabled

[2] Password Avoids unauthorised resetting. If par.0-43 [Reset] Key on LCP is included in the Quick Menu, then
define the password in par.0-65 Quick Menu Password.

[3] Hand Off/On

[4] Hand Off/On w. Passw.

3.2.7 0-5* Copy / Save

Copy parameter settings between set-ups and to/from the LCP.

0-50 LCP Copy


Option: Function:
[0] * No copy

[1] All to LCP Copies all parameters in all set-ups from the frequency converter memory to the LCP memory.

[2] All from LCP Copies all parameters in all set-ups from the LCP memory to the frequency converter memory.

42 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[3] Size indep. from LCP copy only the parameters that are independent of the motor size. The latter selection can be used
to programme several frequency converters with the same function without disturbing motor data.

[4] File from MCO to LCP

[5] File from LCP to MCO

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

0-51 Set-up Copy


Option:
[0] * No copy
Function:
No function
3
[1] Copy to set-up 1 Copies all parameters in the present Programming Set-up (defined in par. 0-11 Programming Set-
up) to Set-up 1.

[2] Copy to set-up 2 Copies all parameters in the present Programming Set-up (defined in par. 0-11 Programming Set-
up) to Set-up 2.

[3] Copy to set-up 3 Copies all parameters in the present Programming Set-up (defined in par. 0-11 Programming Set-
up) to Set-up 3.

[4] Copy to set-up 4 Copies all parameters in the present Programming Set-up (defined in par. 0-11 Programming Set-
up) to Set-up 4.

[9] Copy to all Copies the parameters in the present set-up over to each of the set-ups 1 to 4.

3.2.8 0-6* Password

Define password access to menus.

0-60 Main Menu Password


Range: Function:
100 N/A* [0 - 999 N/A] Define the password for access to the Main Menu via the [Main Menu] key. If par. 0-61 Access to
Main Menu w/o Password is set to Full access [0], this parameter will be ignored.

0-61 Access to Main Menu w/o Password


Option: Function:
[0] * Full access Disables password defined in par.0-60 Main Menu Password.

[1] LCP: Read only Prevent unauthorized editing of Main Menu parameters.

[2] LCP: No access Prevent unauthorized viewing and editing of Main Menu parameters.

[3] Bus: Read only Read-only functions for parameters on fieldbus and/or FC standard bus.

[4] Bus: No access No access to parameters is allowed via fieldbus and/or FC standard bus.

[5] All: Read only Read-only function for parameters on LCP, fieldbus or FC standard bus.

[6] All: No access No access from LCP, fieldbus or FC standard bus is allowed.

If Full access [0] is selected then par.0-60 Main Menu Password, par. 0-65 Personal Menu Password and par. 0-66 Access to Personal Menu w/o Pass-
word will be ignored.

0-65 Quick Menu Password


Range: Function:
200 N/A* [-9999 - 9999 N/A] Define the password for access to the Quick Menu via the [Quick Menu] key. If par.0-66 Access to
Quick Menu w/o Password is set to Full access [0], this parameter will be ignored.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 43


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

0-66 Access to Quick Menu w/o Password


Option: Function:
[0] * Full access Disables the password defined in par.0-65 Quick Menu Password.

[1] LCP: Read only Prevents unauthorised editing of Quick Menu parameters.

[2] LCP: No access Prevents unauthorised viewing and editing of Quick Menu parameters.

[3] Bus: Read only Read only functions for Quick Menu parameters on fieldbus and/ or FC standard bus.

3 [4] Bus: No access No access to Quick Menu parameters is allowed via fieldbus and/ or FC standard bus.

[5] All: Read only read only function for Quick Menu parameters on LCP, fieldbus or FC standard bus.

[6] All: No access No access from LCP, fieldbus or FC standard bus is allowed.

If par. 0-61 Access to Main Menu w/o Password is set to Full access [0] then this parameter will be ignored.

0-67 Bus Password Access


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] Writing to this parameter enables users to unlock the frequency converter from bus/ MCT10.

44 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.3 Parameters: Load and Motor


3.3.1 1-0* General Settings

Define whether the frequency converter operates in speed mode or torque mode; and whether the internal PID control should be active or not.

1-00 Configuration Mode


Option: Function:
Select the application control principle to be used when a Remote Reference (i.e. via analog input
3
or fieldbus) is active. A Remote Reference can only be active when par.3-13 Reference Site is set
to [0] or [1].

[0] * Speed open loop Enables speed control (without feedback signal from motor) with automatic slip compensation for
almost constant speed at varying loads.
Compensations are active but can be disabled in the Load/Motor par. group 1-0*.

[1] Speed closed loop Enables encoder feedback from motor. Obtain full holding torque at 0 RPM.
For increased speed accuracy, provide a feedback signal and set the speed PID control.

[2] Torque Connects the encoder speed feedback signal to the encoder input. Only possible with “Flux with
motor feedback” option, par.1-01 Motor Control Principle.

[3] Process Enables the use of process control in the frequency converter. The process control parameters are
set in par. groups 7-2* and 7-3*.

[4] Torque open loop Enables the use of torque open loop in VVC+ mode (par.1-01 Motor Control Principle). The torque
PID parameters are set in par. group 7-1*.

[5] Wobble

[6] Surface Winder

[7] Extended PID Speed OL

[8] Extended PID Speed CL

1-01 Motor Control Principle


Option: Function:
Select which motor control principle to employ.

[0] * U/f special motor mode, for parallel connected motors in special motor applications. When U/f is se-
lected the characteristic of the control principle can be edited in par.1-55 U/f Characteristic - U and
par.1-56 U/f Characteristic - F.

[1] VVC+

[2] Flux sensorless Flux Vector control without encoder feedback, for simple installation and robustness against sudden
load changes.

[3] Flux w/ motor feedb very high accuracy speed and torque control, suitable for the most demanding applications.

The best shaft performance is normally achieved using either of the two Flux Vector control modes Flux sensorless [2] and Flux with encoder feedback
[3].

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source


Option: Function:
Select the interface at which to receive feedback from the motor.

[0] Motor feedb. P1-02

[1] * 24V encoder A and B channel encoder, which can be connected to the digital input terminals 32/33 only. Termi-
nals 32/33 must be programmed to No operation.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 45


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[2] MCB 102 Encoder module option which can be configured in par. group 17-1*
This parameter appears in FC 302 only.

[3] MCB 103 Optional resolver interface module which can be configured in parameter group 17-5*

[5] MCO Encoder 2 encoder interface 2 of the optional programmable motion controller MCO 305.

[6] Analog input 53

[7] Analog input 54

3 [8]

[9]
Frequency input 29

Frequency input 33

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-03 Torque Characteristics


Option: Function:
Select the torque characteristic required.
VT and AEO are both energy saving operations.

[0] * Constant torque Motor shaft output provides constant torque under variable speed control.

[1] Variable torque Motor shaft output provides variable torque under variable speed control. Set the variable torque
level in par.14-40 VT Level.

[2] Auto Energy Optim. Automatically optimises energy consumption by minimising magnetisation and frequency via par.
14-41 AEO Minimum Magnetisation and par.14-42 Minimum AEO Frequency.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-04 Overload Mode


Option: Function:
[0] * High torque Allows up to 160% over torque.

[1] Normal torque For oversized motor - allows up to 110% over torque.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-05 Local Mode Configuration


Option: Function:
Select which application configuration mode (par.1-00 Configuration Mode), i.e. application control
principle, to use when a Local (LCP) Reference is active. A Local Reference can be active only when
par.3-13 Reference Site is set to [0] or [2]. By default the local reference is active in Hand Mode
only.

[0] Speed open loop

[1] Speed closed loop

[2] * As mode par 1-00

3.3.2 1-1* Motor selection

Parameter group for setting general motor data.


This parameter group cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-10 Motor Construction


Option: Function:
Select the motor construction type.

[0] * Asynchron For asynchronous motors.

[1] PM, non salient SPM

46 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Motor construction can either be asynchronous or permanent magnet (PM) motor.

3.3.3 1-2* Motor Data

Parameter group 1-2* comprises input data from the nameplate on the connected motor.
Parameters in parameter group 1-2* cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3
NB!
Changing the value of these parameters affects the setting of other parameters.

1-20 Motor Power [kW]


Range: Function:
4.00 kW* [0.09 - 3000.00 kW] Enter the nominal motor power in kW according to the motor nameplate data. The default value
corresponds to the nominal rated output of the unit.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running. This parameter is visible in LCP if
par.0-03 Regional Settings is International [0].

NB!
Four sizes down, one size up from nominal VLT rating.

1-21 Motor Power [HP]


Range: Function:
4.00 hp* [0.09 - 3000.00 hp] Enter the nominal motor power in HP according to the motor nameplate data. The default value
corresponds to the nominal rated output of the unit. This parameter is visible in LCP if par.
0-03 Regional Settings is US [1]

1-22 Motor Voltage


Range: Function:
500. V* [10. - 1000. V] Enter the nominal motor voltage according to the motor nameplate data. The default value corre-
sponds to the nominal rated output of the unit.

1-23 Motor Frequency


Range: Function:
50. Hz* [20 - 1000 Hz] Min - Max motor frequency: 20 - 1000 Hz.
Select the motor frequency value from the motor nameplate data. If a value different from 50 Hz
or 60 Hz is selected, it is necessary to adapt the load independent settings in par.1-50 Motor Mag-
netisation at Zero Speed to par.1-53 Model Shift Frequency. For 87 Hz operation with 230/400 V
motors, set the nameplate data for 230 V/50 Hz. Adapt par.4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM] and
par.3-03 Maximum Reference to the 87 Hz application.

1-24 Motor Current


Range: Function:
7.20 A* [0.10 - 10000.00 A] Enter the nominal motor current value from the motor nameplate data. The data are used for cal-
culating torque, motor protection etc.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 47


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1-25 Motor Nominal Speed


Range: Function:
1420. RPM* [10 - 60000 RPM] Enter the nominal motor speed value from the motor nameplate data. The data are used for cal-
culating motor compensations.

NB!
Motor speed must always be lower than synchronous speed

3
1-26 Motor Cont. Rated Torque
Range: Function:
0 Nm* [0.1 - 10000.0 Nm] Enter the value from the motor nameplate data. The default value corresponds to the nominal rated
output. This parameter is available when par.1-10 Motor Construction is set to PM, non salient
SPM [1], i.e. the parameter is valid for PM and non-salient SPM motors only.

1-29 Automatic Motor Adaptation (AMA)


Option: Function:
The AMA function optimises dynamic motor performance by automatically optimising the advanced
motor parameters (par.1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs) to par.1-35 Main Reactance (Xh)) at motor
standstill.

Activate the AMA function by pressing [Hand on] after selecting [1] or [2]. See also the section
Automatic Motor Adaptation in the Design Guide. After a normal sequence, the display will read:
"Press [OK] to finish AMA". After pressing the [OK] key the frequency converter is ready for oper-
ation.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[0] * Off

[1] Enable complete AMA Performs AMA of the stator resistance RS, the rotor resistance Rr, the stator leakage reactance X1,
the rotor leakage reactance X2 and the main reactance Xh. Do not select this option if an LC filter is
used between the frequency converter and the motor.
FC 301: The Complete AMA does not include Xh measurement for FC 301. Instead, the Xh value is
determined from the motor database. RS is the best adjustment method (see 1-3* Adv. Motor Da-
ta).

[2] Enable reduced AMA Performs a reduced AMA of the stator resistance Rs in the system only.

Note:

• For the best adaptation of the frequency converter, run AMA on a cold motor.

• AMA cannot be performed while the motor is running.

• AMA cannot be performed on permanent magnet motors.

NB!
It is important to set motor par. 1-2* correctly, since these form part of the AMA algorithm. An AMA must be performed to achieve
optimum dynamic motor performance. It may take up to 10 min, depending on the power rating of the motor.

NB!
Avoid generating external torque during AMA.

48 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

NB!
If one of the settings in par. 1-2* is changed, par.1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs) to par.1-39 Motor Poles, the advanced motor parameters,
will return to default setting.

NB!
AMA will work problem-free on 1 motor size down, typically work on 2 motor sizes down, rarely work on 3 sizes down and never work
on 4 sizes down. Please keep in mind that the accuracy of the measured motor data will be poorer when you operate on motors smaller
than nominal VLT size. 3

3.3.4 1-3* Adv. Motor Data

Parameters for advanced motor data. The motor data in par.1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs) to par.1-39 Motor Poles must match the relevant motor in order
to run the motor optimally. The default settings are figures based on common motor parameter values from standard motors. If the motor parameters
are not set correctly, a malfunction of the frequency converter system may occur. If the motor data is not known, running an AMA (Automatic Motor
Adaptation) is recommended. See the Automatic Motor Adaptation section in the Design Guide. The AMA sequence will adjust all motor parameters except
the moment of inertia of the rotor and the iron loss resistance (par.1-36 Iron Loss Resistance (Rfe)).
Par. 1-3* and par. 1-4* cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Illustration 3.1: Motor equivalent diagram for an asynchro-


nous motor

1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs)


Range: Function:
1.4000 [0.0140 - 140.0000 Ohm] Set the stator resistance value. Enter the value from a motor data sheet or perform an AMA on a
Ohm* cold motor.

1-31 Rotor Resistance (Rr)


Range: Function:
1.0000 [0.0100 - 100.0000 Ohm] Fine-tuning Rr will improve shaft performance. Set the rotor resistance value using one of these
Ohm* methods:

1. Run an AMA on a cold motor. The frequency converter will measure the value from the
motor. All compensations are reset to 100%.

2. Enter the Rr value manually. Obtain the value from the motor supplier.

3. Use the Rr default setting. The frequency converter establishes the setting on the basis of
the motor nameplate data.

1-33 Stator Leakage Reactance (X1)


Range: Function:
4.0000 [0.0400 - 400.0000 Ohm] Set the stator leakage reactance of the motor using one of these methods:
Ohm*

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 49


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1. Run an AMA on a cold motor. The frequency converter will measure the value from the
motor.

2. Enter the X1 value manually. Obtain the value from the motor supplier.

3. Use the X1 default setting. The frequency converter establishes the setting on the basis of
the motor name plate data.

1-34 Rotor Leakage Reactance (X2)

3
Range: Function:
4.0000 [0.0400 - 400.0000 Ohm] Set the rotor leakage reactance of the motor using one of these methods:
Ohm* 1. Run an AMA on a cold motor. The frequency converter will measure the value from the
motor.

2. Enter the X2 value manually. Obtain the value from the motor supplier.

3. Use the X2 default setting. The frequency converter establishes the setting on the basis of
the motor name plate data.

1-35 Main Reactance (Xh)


Range: Function:
100.0000 [1.0000 - 10000.0000 Ohm] Set the main reactance of the motor using one of these methods:
Ohm*
1. Run an AMA on a cold motor. The frequency converter will measure the value from the
motor.

2. Enter the Xh value manually. Obtain the value from the motor supplier.

3. Use the Xh default setting. The frequency converter establishes the setting on the basis of
the motor name plate data.

1-36 Iron Loss Resistance (Rfe)


Range: Function:
10000.000 [0 - 10000.000 Ohm] Enter the equivalent iron loss resistance (RFe) value to compensate for iron loss in the motor.
Ohm* The RFe value cannot be found by performing an AMA.
The RFe value is especially important in torque control applications. If RFe is unknown, leave par.
1-36 Iron Loss Resistance (Rfe) on default setting.

1-37 d-axis Inductance (Ld)


Range: Function:
0 mH* [0 - 1000.0 mH] Enter the value of the d-axis inductance. Obtain the value from the permanent magnet motor data
sheet.
This parameter is only active when par.1-10 Motor Construction has the value PM, non-salient
SPM [1] (Permanent Magnet Motor).
For a selection with one decimal, use this parameter. For a selection with three decimals, use par.
30-80 d-axis Inductance (Ld).
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

1-39 Motor Poles


Range: Function:
4. N/A* [2 - 100 N/A] Enter the number of motor poles.

Poles ~nn@ 50 Hz ~nn@60 Hz


2 2700 - 2880 3250 - 3460
4 1350 - 1450 1625 - 1730
6 700 - 960 840 - 1153

The table shows the number of poles for normal speed ranges of various motor types. Define motors designed for other frequencies separately. The
motor pole value is always an even number, because it refers to the total number of poles, not pairs of poles. The frequency converter creates the initial
setting of par.1-39 Motor Poles based on par.1-23 Motor Frequency and par.1-25 Motor Nominal Speed.

50 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

1-40 Back EMF at 1000 RPM


Range: Function:
500. V* [10. - 9000 V] Set the nominal back EMF for the motor when running at 1000 RPM. This parameter is only active
when par.1-10 Motor Construction is set to PM motor [1] (Permanent Magnet Motor).
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

NB!
When using PM motors, it is recommended to use brake resistors.
3
1-41 Motor Angle Offset
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-32768 - 32767 N/A] Enter the correct offset angle between the PM motor and the index position (single-turn) of the
attached encoder or resolver. The value range of 0 - 32768 corresponds to 0 - 2 * pi (radians). To
obtain the offset angle value: After frequency converter start-up apply DC-hold and enter the value
of par.16-20 Motor Angle into this parameter.
This parameter is only active when par.1-10 Motor Construction is set to PM, non-salient SPM [1]
(Permanent Magnet Motor).

3.3.5 1-5* Load Indep. Setting

Parameters for setting the load-independent motor settings.

1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 300 %] Use this parameter along with par.1-51 Min Speed Normal Magnetising [RPM] to obtain a different
thermal load on the motor when running at low speed.
Enter a value which is a percentage of the rated magnetizing current. If the setting is too low, the
torque on the motor shaft may be reduced.

1-51 Min Speed Normal Magnetising [RPM]


Range: Function:
15. RPM* [10 - 300 RPM] Set the required speed for normal magnetising current. If the speed is set lower than the motor slip
speed, par.1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed and par.1-51 Min Speed Normal Magnetising
[RPM] are of no significance.
Use this parameter along with par.1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed. See drawing for par.
1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed.

1-52 Min Speed Normal Magnetising [Hz]


Range: Function:
12.5 Hz* [0 - 250.0 Hz] Set the required frequency for normal magnetising current. If the frequency is set lower than the
motor slip frequency, par.1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed is inactive.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 51


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

Use this parameter along with par.1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed. See drawing for par.
1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed.

1-53 Model Shift Frequency


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [4.0 - 0 Hz] Flux Model shift
Enter the frequency value for shift between two models for determining motor speed. Choose the
value based on settings in par.1-00 Configuration Mode and par.1-01 Motor Control Principle. There

3 are two options: shift between Flux model 1 and Flux model 2; or shift between Variable Current
mode and Flux model 2. This parameter is available for FC 302 only.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Flux Model 1 – Flux model 2


This model is used when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to Speed closed loop [1] or Torque [2]
and par.1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to Flux w/motor feedback [3]. With this parameter it is
possible to make an adjustment of the shifting point where FC 302 changes between Flux model 1
and Flux model 2, which is useful in some sensitive speed and torque control applications.

Illustration 3.4: par.1-00 Configuration Mode = [1] Speed closed loop or [2] Torque
and par.1-01 Motor Control Principle = [3] Flux w/motor feedback

Variable Current - Flux model - Sensorless


This model is used when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to Speed open loop [0] and par.
1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to Flux sensorless [2].
In speed open loop in flux mode, the speed is determined from the current measurement.
Below fnorm x 0.1, the frequency converter runs on a Variable Current model. Above fnorm x 0.125
the frequency converter runs on a Flux model.

Illustration 3.5: par.1-00 Configuration Mode = [0] Speed open loop, par.1-01 Motor
Control Principle = [2] Flux sensorless

1-55 U/f Characteristic - U


Range: Function:
0 V* [0.0 - 1000.0 V] Enter the voltage at each frequency point to manually form a U/f characteristic matching the motor.

52 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

The frequency points are defined in par.1-56 U/f Characteristic - F.


This parameter is an array parameter [0-5] and is only accessible when par.1-01 Motor Control
Principle is set to U/f [0].

1-56 U/f Characteristic - F


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0 - 1000.0 Hz] Enter the frequency points to manually form a U/f-characteristic matching the motor.
The voltage at each point is defined in par.1-55 U/f Characteristic - U.
This parameter is an array parameter [0-5] and is only accessible when par.1-01 Motor Control
Principle is set to U/f [0].
3

3.3.6 1-6* Load Depend. Setting

Parameters for adjusting the load-dependent motor settings.

1-60 Low Speed Load Compensation


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 300 %] Enter the % value to compensate voltage in relation to load when the motor is running at low speed
and obtain the optimum U/f characteristic. The motor size determines the frequency range within
which this parameter is active.

Motor size Change over


0.25 kW - 7.5 kW < 10 Hz

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 53


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1-61 High Speed Load Compensation


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 300 %] Enter the % value to compensate voltage in relation to load when the motor is running at high speed
and obtain the optimum U/f characteristic. The motor size determines the frequency range within
which this parameter is active.

Motor size Change-over


0.25 kW - 7.5 kW > 10 Hz
3
1-62 Slip Compensation
Range: Function:
100. %* [-500 - 500 %] Enter the % value for slip compensation, to compensate for tolerances in the value of nM,N. Slip
compensation is calculated automatically, i.e. on the basis of the rated motor speed nM,N.
This function is not active when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to Speed closed loop [1] or
Torque [2] Torque control with speed feedback or when par.1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to
U/f [0] special motor mode.

1-63 Slip Compensation Time Constant


Range: Function:
0.10 s* [0.05 - 5.00 s] Enter the slip compensation reaction speed. A high value results in slow reaction, and a low value
results in quick reaction. If low-frequency resonance problems arise, use a longer time setting.

1-64 Resonance Dampening


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 500 %] Enter the resonance dampening value. Set par.1-64 Resonance Dampening and par.1-65 Resonance
Dampening Time Constant to help eliminate high-frequency resonance problems. To reduce reso-
nance oscillation, increase the value of par.1-64 Resonance Dampening.

1-65 Resonance Dampening Time Constant


Range: Function:
5 ms* [5 - 50 ms] Set par.1-64 Resonance Dampening and par.1-65 Resonance Dampening Time Constant to help
eliminate high-frequency resonance problems. Enter the time constant that provides the best damp-
ening.

1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed


Range: Function:
100 %* [1. - 200. %] Enter the minimum motor current at low speed, see par.1-53 Model Shift Frequency. Increasing this
current improves motor torque at low speed.
par.1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed is enabled when par.1-00 Configuration Mode = Speed open
loop [0] only. The frequency converter runs with constant current through motor for speeds below
10 Hz.
For speeds above 10 Hz, the motor flux model in the frequency converter controls the motor. par.
4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and / or par.4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode automatically adjust
par.1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed. The parameter with the highest value adjusts par.1-66 Min.
Current at Low Speed. The current setting in par.1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed is composed of
the torque generating current and the magnetizing current.
Example: Set par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode to 100% and set par.4-17 Torque Limit Generator
Mode to 60%. par.1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed automatically adjusts to about 127%, depending
on the motor size.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

1-67 Load Type


Option: Function:
[0] * Passive load For conveyers, fan and pump applications.

54 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1] Active load For hoisting applications. When Active Load [1] is selected, set par.1-66 Min. Current at Low
Speed to a level which corresponds to maximum torque.

This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

1-68 Minimum Inertia


Range: Function:
0.0048 [0.0001 - par. 1-69 kgm] Enter the minimum moment of inertia of the mechanical system. par.1-68 Minimum Inertia and par.

3
kgm* 1-69 Maximum Inertia are used for pre-adjustment of the Proportional Gain in the speed control,
see par.30-83 Speed PID Proportional Gain.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while motor is running.

1-69 Maximum Inertia


Range: Function:
0.0048 [par. 1-68 - 0.4800 kgm] Enter the maximum moment of inertia of the mechanical system. par.1-68 Minimum Inertia and
kgm* par.1-69 Maximum Inertia are used for pre-adjustment of the Proportional Gain in the speed control,
see par.7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while motor is running.

3.3.7 1-7* Start Adjustments

Parameters for setting special motor start features.

1-71 Start Delay


Range: Function:
0.0 s* [0.0 - 10.0 s] This parameter refers to the start function selected in par.1-72 Start Function.
Enter the time delay required before commencing acceleration.

1-72 Start Function


Option: Function:
Select the start function during start delay. This parameter is linked to par.1-71 Start Delay.

[0] DC Hold/delay time Energizes motor with a DC holding current (par.2-00 DC Hold Current) during the start delay time.

[1] DC Brake/delay time Energizes motor with a DC braking current (par.2-01 DC Brake Current) during the start delay time.

[2] * Coast/delay time Releases shaft coasted converter during the start delay time (inverter off).

[3] Start speed cw Only possible with VVC+Advanced Vector Control.


Connect the function described in par.1-74 Start Speed [RPM] and par.1-76 Start Current in the
start delay time.
Regardless of the value applied by the reference signal, the output speed applies the setting of the
start speed in par.1-74 Start Speed [RPM] or par.1-75 Start Speed [Hz] and the output current
corresponds to the setting of the start current in par.1-76 Start Current. This function is typically
used in hoisting applications without counterweight and especially in applications with a Cone-mo-
tor, where the start is clockwise, followed by rotation in the reference direction.

[4] Horizontal operation Only possible with VVC+Advanced Vector Control.


For obtaining the function described in par.1-74 Start Speed [RPM] and par.1-76 Start Current during
the start delay time. The motor rotates in the reference direction. If the reference signal equals zero
(0), par.1-74 Start Speed [RPM] is ignored and the output speed equals zero (0). The output current
corresponds to the setting of the start current in par.1-76 Start Current.

[5] VVC+/Flux clockwise for the function described in par.1-74 Start Speed [RPM] only. The start current is calculated auto-
matically. This function uses the start speed in the start delay time only. Regardless of the value
set by the reference signal, the output speed equals the setting of the start speed in par.1-74 Start

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 55


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

Speed [RPM].Start speed/current clockwise [3] and VVCplus/Flux clockwise [5] are typically used
in hoisting applications. Start speed/current in reference direction [4] is particularly used in appli-
cations with counterweight and horizontal movement.

[6] Hoist Mech. Brake Rel For utilizing mechanical brake control functions, par.2-24 Stop Delay to par.2-28 Gain Boost Fac-
tor. This parameter is only active when par.1-01 Motor Control Principle is set to [3] Flux w/ motor
feedback (FC 302 only).

1-73 Flying Start


3 Option: Function:
This function makes it possible to catch a motor which is spinning freely due to a mains drop-out.

[0] * Disabled No function

[1] Enabled

[2] Enabled Always

This parameter cannot be adjusted while motor is running.

NB!
This function is not recommended for hoisting applications.

1-74 Start Speed [RPM]


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - 600 RPM] Set a motor start speed. After the start signal, the output speed leaps to set value. Set the start
function in par.1-72 Start Function to [3], [4] or [5], and set a start delay time in par.1-71 Start
Delay.

1-75 Start Speed [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0.0 - 500.0 Hz] Set a motor start speed. After the start signal, the output speed leaps to set value. Set the start
function in par.1-72 Start Function to [3], [4] or [5], and set a start delay time in par.1-71 Start
Delay.

1-76 Start Current


Range: Function:
0.00 A* [0.00 - par. 1-24 A] Some motors, e.g. cone rotor motors, need extra current/starting speed to disengage the rotor. To
obtain this boost, set the required current in par.1-76 Start Current. Set par.1-74 Start Speed
[RPM]. Set par.1-72 Start Function to [3] or [4], and set a start delay time in par.1-71 Start De-
lay.

This parameter can be used for hoist applications (cone rotor).

3.3.8 1-8* Stop Adjustments

Parameters for setting special stop features for the motor.

1-80 Function at Stop


Option: Function:
Select the frequency converter function after a stop command or after the speed is ramped down
to the settings in par.1-81 Min Speed for Function at Stop [RPM].

[0] * Coast Leaves motor in free mode. The motor is disconnected from the from the frequency converter.

[1] DC hold Energizes motor with a DC holding current (see par.2-00 DC Hold Current).

56 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[2] Motor check Checks if a motor has been connected.

[3] Pre-magnetizing Builds up a magnetic field while the motor is stopped. The motor can now produce a quick torque
build-up at start. Asynchronous motors only.

[4] DC Voltage U0

1-81 Min Speed for Function at Stop [RPM]


Range: Function:
3. RPM* [0 - 600 RPM] Set the speed at which to activate par. 1-80 Function at Stop.
3
1-82 Min Speed for Function at Stop [Hz]
Range: Function:
0.1 Hz* [0.0 - 20.0 Hz] Set the output frequency at which to activate par. 1-80 Function at Stop.

1-83 Precise Stop Function


Option: Function:
[0] * Precise ramp stop Achieves high repetitive precision at the stopping point.

[1] Cnt stop with reset Runs the frequency converter from receipt of a pulse start signal until the number of pulses pro-
grammed by the user in par.1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value has been received at input terminal
29 or input terminal 33.
An internal stop signal will activate the normal ramp down time (par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down
Time, par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time, par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time or par.3-72 Ramp 4
Ramp Down Time). The counter function is activated (starts timing) at the edge of the start signal
(when it changes from stop to start). After each precise stop the number of pulses counted during
ramp down 0 rpm is reset.

[2] Cnt stop w/o reset Same as [1] but the number of pulses counted during ramp down to 0 rpm is deducted from the
counter value in par.1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value.

[3] Speed comp stop Stops at precisely the same point, regardless of the present speed, the stop signal is delayed in-
ternally when the present speed is lower than the maximum speed (set in par.4-19 Max Output
Frequency).

[4] Com cnt stop w/rst Same as [3] but after each precise stop the number of pulses counted during ramp down 0 rpm is
reset.

[5] Comp cnt stop w/o r Same as [3] but the number of pulses counted during ramp down to 0 rpm is deducted from the
counter value in par.1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value


Range: Function:
100000 N/ [0 - 999999999 N/A] Enter the counter value to be used in the integrated precise stop function, par.1-83 Precise Stop
A* Function.
The maximum permissible frequency at terminal 29 or 33 is 110 kHz.

1-85 Precise Stop Speed Compensation Delay


Range: Function:
10 ms* [0 - 100 ms] Enter the delay time for sensors, PLCs, etc. for use in par.1-83 Precise Stop Function. In speed
compensated stop mode, the delay time at different frequencies has a major influence on the stop
function.

3.3.9 1-9* Motor Temperature

Parameters for setting the temperature protection features for the motor.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 57


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1-90 Motor Thermal Protection


Option: Function:
The frequency converter determines the motor temperature for motor protection in two different
ways:

• Via a thermistor sensor connected to one of the analog or digital inputs (par.1-93 Ther-
mistor Source).

• Via calculation (ETR = Electronic Terminal Relay) of the thermal load, based on the actual

3 load and time. The calculated thermal load is compared with the rated motor current
IM,N and the rated motor frequency fM,N. The calculations estimate the need for a lower
load at lower speed due to less cooling from the fan incorporated in the motor.

[0] * No protection Continuously overloaded motor, when no warning or trip of the frequency converter is required.

[1] Thermistor warning Activates a warning when the connected thermistor or KTY-sensor in the motor reacts in the event
of motor over-temperature.

[2] Thermistor trip Stops (trips) frequency converter when connected thermistor in motor reacts in the event of motor
over-temperature.

The thermistor cut-out value must be > 3 kΩ.

Integrate a thermistor (PTC sensor) in the motor for winding protection.

[3] ETR warning 1 Please see detailed description below

[4] ETR trip 1

[5] ETR warning 2

[6] ETR trip 2

[7] ETR warning 3

[8] ETR trip 3

[9] ETR warning 4

[10] ETR trip 4

Motor protection can be implemented using a range of techniques: PTC or KTY sensor (see also section KTY Sensor Connection) in motor windings;
mechanical thermal switch (Klixon type); or Electronic Thermal Relay (ETR).

Using a digital input and 24 V as power supply:


Example: The frequency converter trips when the motor temperature is too high
Parameter set-up:
Set par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection to Thermistor Trip [2]
Set par.1-93 Thermistor Source to Digital Input [6]

58 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3
Using a digital input and 10 V as power supply:
Example: The frequency converter trips when the motor temperature is too high.
Parameter set-up:
Set par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection to Thermistor Trip [2]
Set par.1-93 Thermistor Source to Digital Input [6]

Using an analog input and 10 V as power supply:


Example: The frequency converter trips when the motor temperature is too high.
Parameter set-up:
Set par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection to Thermistor Trip [2]
Set par.1-93 Thermistor Source to Analog Input 54 [2]

Input Supply Voltage Threshold


Digital/analog Volt Cut-out Values
Digital 24 V < 6.6 kΩ - > 10.8 kΩ
Digital 10 V < 800Ω - > 2.7 kΩ
Analog 10 V < 3.0 kΩ - > 3.0 kΩ

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 59


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

NB!
Check that the chosen supply voltage follows the specification of the used thermistor element.

Select ETR Warning 1-4, to activate a warning on the display when the motor is overloaded.
Select ETR Trip 1-4 to trip the frequency converter when the motor is overloaded.
Programme a warning signal via one of the digital outputs. The signal appears in the event of a warning and if the frequency converter trips (thermal

3 warning).
ETR (Electronic Terminal Relay) functions 1-4 will calculate the load when the set-up where they were selected is active. For example ETR starts calculating
when setup 3 is selected. For the North American market: The ETR functions provide class 20 motor overload protection in accordance with NEC.

1-91 Motor External Fan


Option: Function:
[0] * No No external fan is required, i.e. the motor is derated at low speed.

[1] Yes Applies an external motor fan (external ventilation), so no derating of the motor is required at low
speed. The graph below is followed if the motor current is lower than nominal motor current (see
par. 1-24 Motor Current). If the motor current exceeds nominal current, the operation time still
decreases as if no fan were installed.
 

1-93 Thermistor Source


Option: Function:
Select the input to which the thermistor (PTC sensor) should be connected. An analog input option
[1] or [2] cannot be selected if the analog input is already in use as a reference source (selected in
par. 3-15 Reference 1 Source, par. 3-16 Reference 2 Source or par. 3-17 Reference 3 Source).
When using MCB112, choice [0] None must always be selected.

60 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[0] * None

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[3] Digital input 18

[4] Digital input 19

[5] Digital input 32

[6] Digital input 33

3
NB!
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

NB!
Digital inputs should be set to “No operation” - see par. 5-1*.

3.3.10 KTY Sensor Connection

(FC 302 only)

KTY sensors are used especially in Permanent Magnet Servo Motors (PM motors) for dynamic adjusting of motor parameters as stator resistance (par.
1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs)) for PM motors and also rotor resistance (par.1-31 Rotor Resistance (Rr)) for asynchronous motors, depending on winding
temperature. The calculation is:

Rs = Rs20° C x (1 + αcu x ΔT ) Ω where αcu = 0.00393

KTY sensors can be used for motor protecting (par.1-97 KTY Threshold level).
FC 302 can handle three types of KTY sensors, defined in par.1-95 KTY Sensor Type. The actual sensor temperature can be read out from par.
16-19 KTY sensor temperature.

NB!
If the temperature of the motor is utilized through a thermistor or KTY sensor the PELV is not complied with in case of short circuits
between motor windings and sensor. In order to comply with PELV the sensor must be extra isolated.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 61


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1-95 KTY Sensor Type


Option: Function:
Select the used type of KTY sensor. This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

[0] * KTY Sensor 1 1 kΩ at 100o C

[1] KTY Sensor 2 1 kΩ at 25o C

[2] KTY Sensor 3 2 kΩ at 25o C

3 1-96 KTY Thermistor Resource


Option: Function:
Selecting analog input terminal 54 to be used as KTY sensor input. Terminal 54 cannot be selected
as KTY source if otherwise used as reference (see par.3-15 Reference Resource 1 to par.
3-17 Reference Resource 3).

This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

NB!
Connection of KTY-sensor between term. 54 and 55 (GND). See picture in section
KTY Sensor Connection.

[0] * None

[2] Analog input 54

1-97 KTY Threshold level


Range: Function:
80 C* [-40 - 140 C] Select the KTY sensor threshold level for motor thermal protection.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

62 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.4 Parameters: Brakes


3.4.1 2-** Brakes

Parameter group for setting brake features in the frequency converter.

3.4.2 2-0* DC-Brakes 3


Parameter group for configuring the DC brake and DC hold functions.

2-00 DC Hold Current


Range: Function:
50 %* [0 - 160. %] Enter a value for holding current as a percentage of the rated motor current IM,N set in par.
1-24 Motor Current. 100% DC holding current corresponds to IM,N.
This parameter holds the motor function (holding torque) or pre-heats the motor.
This parameter is active if DC hold is selected in par.1-72 Start Function [0] or par.1-80 Function at
Stop [1].

NB!
The maximum value depends on the rated motor current.
NB!
Avoid 100 % current for too long. It may damage the motor.

2-01 DC Brake Current


Range: Function:
50 %* [0 - 1000. %] Enter a value for current as a percentage of the rated motor current IM,N, see par.1-24 Motor Cur-
rent. 100% DC braking current corresponds to IM,N.
DC brake current is applied on a stop command, when the speed is lower than the limit set in par.
2-03 DC Brake Cut In Speed [RPM]; when the DC Brake Inverse function is active; or via the serial
communication port. The braking current is active during the time period set in par.2-02 DC Braking
Time.

NB!
The maximum value depends on the rated motor current.
NB!
Avoid 100 % current for too long. It may damage the motor.

2-02 DC Braking Time


Range: Function:
10.0 s* [0.0 - 60.0 s] Set the duration of the DC braking current set in par. 2-01 DC Brake Current, once activated.

2-03 DC Brake Cut In Speed [RPM]


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Set the DC brake cut-in speed for activation of the DC braking current set in par.2-01 DC Brake
Current, upon a stop command.

2-04 DC Brake Cut In Speed [Hz]


Range: Function:
0.0 Hz* [0.0 - par. 4-14 Hz] Set the DC brake cut-in speed for activation of the DC braking current set in par.2-01 DC Brake
Current, upon a stop command.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 63


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.4.3 2-1* Brake Energy Funct.

Parameter group for selecting dynamic braking parameters. Only valid for drives with brake chopper.

2-10 Brake Function


Option: Function:
[0] * Off No brake resistor is installed.

[1] Resistor brake A brake resistor is incorporated in the system, for dissipation of surplus brake energy as heat. Con-

3 necting a brake resistor allows a higher DC link voltage during braking (generating operation). The
Resistor brake function is only active in frequency converters with an integral dynamic brake.

[2] AC brake Is selected to improve braking without using a brake resistor. This parameter controls an overmag-
netization of the motor when running with a generatoric load. This function can improve the OVC-
function. Increasing the electrical losses in the motor allows the OVC function to increase the braking
torque without exceeding the over voltage limit. Please note that AC brake is not as effective as
dynamic breaking with resistor.
AC brake is for VVC+ and flux mode in both open and closed loop.

2-11 Brake Resistor (ohm)


Range: Function:
50.00 [5.00 - 65535.00 Ohm] Set the brake resistor value in Ohms. This value is used for monitoring the power to the brake
Ohm* resistor in par. 2-13 Brake Power Monitoring. This parameter is only active in frequency converters
with an integral dynamic brake.
Use this parameter for values without decimals. For a selection with two decimals, use par 30-81.

2-12 Brake Power Limit (kW)


Range: Function:
5.000 kW* [0.001 - 2000.000 kW] Set the monitoring limit of the brake power transmitted to the resistor.
The monitoring limit is a product of the maximum duty cycle (120 sec.) and the maximum power
of the brake resistor at that duty cycle. See the formula below.

For 200 - 240 V units: 3902 × dutytime


Presistor =
R × 120
For 380 - 480 V units 7782 × dutytime
Presistor =
R × 120
For 380 - 500 V units 8102 × dutytime
Presistor =
R × 120
For 575 - 600 V units 9432 × dutytime
Presistor =
R × 120

This parameter is only active in frequency converters with an integral dynamic brake.

2-13 Brake Power Monitoring


Option: Function:
This parameter is only active in frequency converters with an integral dynamic brake.
This parameter enables monitoring of the power to the brake resistor. The power is calculated on
the basis of the resistance (par.2-11 Brake Resistor (ohm)), the DC link voltage, and the resistor
duty time.

[0] * Off No brake power monitoring required.

[1] Warning Activates a warning on the display when the power transmitted over 120 s exceeds 100% of the
monitoring limit (par.2-12 Brake Power Limit (kW) ).
The warning disappears when the transmitted power falls below 80% of the monitoring limit.

[2] Trip Trips frequency converter and displays an alarm when the calculated power exceeds 100% of the
monitoring limit.

[3] Warning and trip

64 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

If power monitoring is set to Off [0] or Warning [1], the brake function remains active, even if the monitoring limit is exceeded. This may lead to thermal
overload of the resistor. It is also possible to generate a warning via a relay/digital outputs. The measuring accuracy of the power monitoring depends
on the accuracy of the resistance of the resistor (better than ± 20%).

2-15 Brake Check


Option: Function:
Select type of test and monitoring function to check the connection to the brake resistor, or whether
a brake resistor is present, and then display a warning or an alarm in the event of a fault.

NB!
The brake resistor disconnection function is tested during power-up. However the
3
brake IGBT test is performed when there is no braking. A warning or trip discon-
nects the brake function.

The testing sequence is as follows:

1. The DC link ripple amplitude is measured for 300 ms without braking.

2. The DC link ripple amplitude is measured for 300 ms with the brake turned on.

3. If the DC link ripple amplitude while braking is lower than the DC link ripple amplitude
before braking + 1 %: Brake check has failed by returning a warning or alarm.

4. If the DC link ripple amplitude while braking is higher than the DC link ripple amplitude
before braking + 1 %: Brake check is OK.

[0] * Off Monitors brake resistor and brake IGBT for a short-circuit during operation. If a short-circuit occurs,
warning 25 appears.

[1] Warning Monitors brake resistor and brake IGBT for a short-circuit, and runs a test for brake resistor dis-
connection during power-up.

[2] Trip Monitors for a short-circuit or disconnection of the brake resistor, or a short-circuit of the brake
IGBT. If a fault occurs, the frequency converter cuts out while displaying an alarm (trip locked).

[3] Stop and trip Monitors for a short-circuit or disconnection of the brake resistor, or a short-circuit of the brake
IGBT. If a fault occurs, the frequency converter ramps down to coast and then trips. A trip lock
alarm is displayed (e.g. warning 25, 27 or 28).

[4] AC brake Monitors for a short-circuit or disconnection of the brake resistor, or a short-circuit of the brake
IGBT. If a fault occurs, the frequency converter performs a controlled ramp down. This option is
available for FC 302 only.

[5] Trip Lock

NB!
Remove a warning arising in connection with Off [0] or Warning [1] by cycling the mains supply. The fault must be corrected first. For
Off [0] or Warning [1], the frequency converter keeps running even if a fault is located.

This parameter is only active in frequency converters with an integral dynamic brake.

2-16 AC brake Max. Current


Range: Function:
100.0 %* [0.0 - 1000.0 %] Enter the maximum permissible current when using AC brake to avoid overheating of motor wind-
ings. The AC brake function is available in Flux mode only (FC 302 only).

2-17 Over-voltage Control


Option: Function:
Over-voltage control (OVC) reduces the risk of the frequency converter tripping due to an over
voltage on the DC link caused by generative power from the load.

[0] * Disabled No OVC required.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 65


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1] Enabled (not at stop) Activates OVC except when using a stop signal to stop the frequency converter.

[2] Enabled Activates OVC.

NB!
OVC must not be enabled in hoisting applications.

3
3.4.4 2-18 Brake Check Condition

2-18 Brake Check Condition


Option: Function:
[0] * At Power Up Brake check will be performed at power up

[1] After Coast Situations Brake check will be performed after coast situations

3.4.5 2-2* Mechanical Brake

Parameters for controlling operation of an electro-magnetic (mechanical) brake, typically required in hoisting applications.
To control a mechanical brake, a relay output (relay 01 or relay 02) or a programmed digital output (terminal 27 or 29) is required. Normally this output
must be closed during periods when the frequency converter is unable to ‘hold’ the motor, e.g. due to an excessive load. Select Mechanical Brake
Control [32] for applications with an electro-magnetic brake in par.5-40 Function Relay, par. 5-30 Terminal 27 Digital Output, or par. 5-31 Terminal 29
Digital Output. When selecting Mechanical brake control [32], the mechanical brake is closed from start up until the output current is above the level
selected in par.2-20 Release Brake Current. During stop, the mechanical brake activates when the speed falls below the level specified in par.2-21 Activate
Brake Speed [RPM]. If the frequency converter enters an alarm condition or an over-current or over-voltage situation, the mechanical brake immediately
cuts in. This is also the case during safe stop.

NB!
Protection mode and trip delay features (par.14-25 Trip Delay at Torque Limit and par.14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault) may delay
the activation of the mechanical brake in an alarm condition. These features must be disabled in hoisting applications.

66 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

2-20 Release Brake Current


Range: Function:
par. 16-37 [0.00 - par. 16-37 A] Set the motor current for release of the mechanical brake, when a start condition is present. The
A* upper limit is specified in par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current.

2-21 Activate Brake Speed [RPM]


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - 30000 RPM] Set the motor speed for activation of the mechanical brake, when a stop condition is present. The
upper speed limit is specified in par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

2-22 Activate Brake Speed [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0.0 - 5000.0 Hz] Set the motor frequency for activation of the mechanical brake, when a stop condition is present.

2-23 Activate Brake Delay


Range: Function:
0.0 s* [0.0 - 5.0 s] Enter the brake delay time of the coast after ramp-down time. The shaft is held at zero speed with
full holding torque. Ensure that the mechanical brake has locked the load before the motor enters
coast mode. See Mechanical Brake Control section in the Design Guide.

2-24 Stop Delay


Range: Function:
0.0 s* [0.0 - 5.0 s] Set the time interval from the moment when the motor is stopped until the brake closes. This pa-
rameter is a part of the stopping function.

2-25 Brake Release Time


Range: Function:
0.20 s* [0.00 - 5.00 s] This value defines the time it takes for the mechanical brake to open/ close. This parameter must
act as a time-out when brake feedback is activated.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 67


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

2-26 Torque Ref


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0 - 0 %] The value defines the torque applied against the closed mechanical brake, before release

2-27 Torque Ramp Time


Range: Function:
0.2 s* [0.0 - 5.0 s] The value defines the duration of the torque ramp in clockwise direction.

3 2-28 Gain Boost Factor


Range: Function:
1.00 N/A* [1.00 - 4.00 N/A] Only active in flux closed loop. The function ensures a smooth transition from torque control mode
to speed control mode when the motor takes over the load from the brake.

Illustration 3.6: Brake release sequence for hoist mechanical brake control
I) Activate brake delay: The frequency converter starts again from the mechanical brake engaged position.
II) Stop delay: When the time between successive starts is shorter than the setting in par.2-24 Stop Delay, the frequency converter starts
without applying the mechanical brake (e.g. reversing).

68 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.5 Parameters: Reference/Ramps


3.5.1 3-** Reference/Reference Limits/Ramps

Parameters for reference handling, definition of limitations, and configuration of the reaction of the frequency converter to changes.

3.5.2 3-0* Reference Limits 3


Parameters for setting the reference unit, limits and ranges.

3-00 Reference Range


Option: Function:
Select the range of the reference signal and the feedback signal. Signal values can be positive only,
or positive and negative. The minimum limit may have a negative value, unless Speed closed loop
[1] control or Process [3] is selected in par.1-00 Configuration Mode.

[0] Min - Max Select the range of the reference signal and the feedback signal. Signal values can be positive only,
or positive and negative. The minimum limit may have a negative value, unless Speed closed loop
[1] control or Process [3] is selected in par.1-00 Configuration Mode.

[1] * -Max - +Max For both positive and negative values (both directions, relative to par.4-10 Motor Speed Direction).

3-01 Reference/Feedback Unit


Option: Function:
Select the unit to be used in Process PID Control references and feedbacks.

[0] * None

[1] %

[2] RPM

[3] Hz

[4] Nm

[5] PPM

[10] 1/min

[12] Pulse/s

[20] l/s

[21] l/min

[22] l/h

[23] m³/s

[24] m³/min

[25] m³/h

[30] kg/s

[31] kg/min

[32] kg/h

[33] t/min

[34] t/h

[40] m/s

[41] m/min

[45] m

[60] °C

[70] mbar

[71] bar

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 69


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[72] Pa

[73] kPa

[74] m WG

[80] kW

[120] GPM

[121] gal/s

[122] gal/min

3 [123] gal/h

[124] CFM

[125] ft³/s

[126] ft³/min

[127] ft³/h

[130] lb/s

[131] lb/min

[132] lb/h

[140] ft/s

[141] ft/min

[145] ft

[150] lb ft

[160] °F

[170] psi

[171] lb/in²

[172] in WG

[173] ft WG

[180] HP

3-02 Minimum Reference


Range: Function:
0 Referen- [-999999.999 - par. 3-03 Referen- Enter the Minimum Reference. The Minimum Reference is the lowest value obtainable by summing
ceFeedback-ceFeedbackUnit] all references.
Unit* Minimum Reference is active only when par.3-00 Reference Range is set to Min.- Max. [0].
The Minimum Reference unit matches:

• The choice of configuration in par.1-00 Configuration Mode Configuration Mode: for Speed
closed loop [1], RPM; for Torque [2], Nm.

• The unit selected in par.3-01 Reference/Feedback Unit.

3-03 Maximum Reference


Range: Function:
1500.000 [par. 3-02 - 999999.999 Referen- Enter the Maximum Reference. The Maximum Reference is the highest value obtainable by summing
Reference- ceFeedbackUnit] all references.
FeedbackU- The Maximum Reference unit matches:
nit* • The choice of configuration in par.1-00 Configuration Mode: for Speed closed loop [1],
RPM; for Torque [2], Nm.

• The unit selected in par.3-00 Reference Range.

3-04 Reference Function


Option: Function:
[0] * Sum Sums both external and preset reference sources.

[1] External/Preset Use either the preset or the external reference source.

70 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Shift between external and preset via a command on a digital input.

3.5.3 3-1* References

Parameters for setting up the reference sources.


Select the preset reference(s). Select Preset ref. bit 0 / 1 / 2 [16], [17] or [18] for the corresponding digital inputs in parameter group 5.1*.

3-10 Preset Reference


Array [8]
Range: 0-7
3
Range: Function:
0.00 %* [-100.00 - 100.00 %] Enter up to eight different preset references (0-7) in this parameter, using array programming. The
preset reference is stated as a percentage of the value RefMAX (par.3-03 Maximum Reference) If a
RefMIN different from 0 (par.3-02 Minimum Reference) is programmed, the preset reference is cal-
culated as a percentage of the full reference range, i.e. on the basis of the difference between
RefMAX and RefMIN. Afterwards, the value is added to RefMIN. When using preset references, select
Preset ref. bit 0 / 1 / 2 [16], [17] or [18] for the corresponding digital inputs in parameter group
5-1*.

Preset ref. bit 2 1 0


Preset ref. 0 0 0 0
Preset ref. 1 0 0 1
Preset ref. 2 0 1 0
Preset ref. 3 0 1 1
Preset ref. 4 1 0 0
Preset ref. 5 1 0 1
Preset ref. 6 1 1 0
Preset ref. 7 1 1 1

3-11 Jog Speed [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0.0 - par. 4-14 Hz] The jog speed is a fixed output speed at which the frequency converter is running when the jog
function is activated.
See also par.3-80 Jog Ramp Time.

3-12 Catch up/slow Down Value


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Enter a percentage (relative) value to be either added to or deducted from the actual reference for
Catch up or Slow down respectively. If Catch up is selected via one of the digital inputs
(par. 5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input to par. 5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input), the percentage (relative)
value is added to the total reference. If Slow down is selected via one of the digital inputs

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 71


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

(par. 5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input to par. 5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input), the percentage (relative)
value is deducted from the total reference. Obtain extended functionality with the DigiPot function.
See parameter group 3-9* Digital Potentiometer.

3-13 Reference Site


Option: Function:
Select which reference site to activate.

3 [0] *

[1]
Linked to Hand / Auto

Remote
Use local reference when in Hand mode; or remote reference when in Auto mode.

Use remote reference in both Hand mode and Auto mode.

[2] Local Use local reference in both Hand mode and Auto mode.

NB!
When set to Local [2], the frequency converter will start with this setting again
following a 'power down'.

3-14 Preset Relative Reference


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [-100.00 - 100.00 %] The actual reference, X, is increased or decreased with the percentage Y, set in par.3-14 Preset
Relative Reference. This results in the actual reference Z. Actual reference (X) is the sum of the
inputs selected in par. 3-15 Reference 1 Source, par. 3-16 Reference 2 Source, par. 3-17 Reference
3 Source and par. 8-02 Control Source.

3-15 Reference Resource 1


Option: Function:
Select the reference input to be used for the first reference signal. par.3-15 Reference Resource
1, par.3-16 Reference Resource 2 and par.3-17 Reference Resource 3 define up to three different
reference signals. The sum of these reference signals defines the actual reference.

[0] No function

[1] * Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[7] Frequency input 29

[8] Frequency input 33

72 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[11] Local bus reference

[20] Digital pot.meter

[21] Analog input X30-11 (General Purpose I/O Option Module)

[22] Analog input X30-12 (General Purpose I/O Option Module)

3-16 Reference Resource 2


Option: Function:
Select the reference input to be used for the second reference signal. par.3-15 Reference Resource
1, par.3-16 Reference Resource 2 and par.3-17 Reference Resource 3 define up to three different
3
reference signals. The sum of these reference signals defines the actual reference.

[0] No function

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[7] Frequency input 29

[8] Frequency input 33

[11] Local bus reference

[20] * Digital pot.meter

[21] Analog input X30-11

[22] Analog input X30-12

3-17 Reference Resource 3


Option: Function:
Select the reference input to be used for the third reference signal. par.3-15 Reference Resource
1, par.3-16 Reference Resource 2 and par.3-17 Reference Resource 3 define up to three different
reference signals. The sum of these reference signals defines the actual reference.

[0] No function

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[7] Frequency input 29

[8] Frequency input 33

[11] * Local bus reference

[20] Digital pot.meter

[21] Analog input X30-11

[22] Analog input X30-12

3-18 Relative Scaling Reference Resource


Option: Function:
Select a variable value to be added to the fixed value (defined in par.3-14 Preset Relative Refer-
ence). The sum of the fixed and variable values (labelled Y in the illustration below) is multiplied
with the actual reference (labelled X in the illustration below). This product is then added to the
actual reference (X+X*Y/100) to give the resultant actual reference.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[0] * No function

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 73


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[7] Frequency input 29

[8] Frequency input 33

[11] Local bus reference

[20] Digital pot.meter

[21] Analog input X30-11

3 [22] Analog input X30-12

3-19 Jog Speed [RPM]


Range: Function:
150. RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Enter a value for the jog speed nJOG, which is a fixed output speed. The frequency converter runs
at this speed when the jog function is activated. The maximum limit is defined in par.4-13 Motor
Speed High Limit [RPM].
See also par.3-80 Jog Ramp Time.

3.5.4 Ramps
3-4* Ramp 1

For each of four ramps (par. 3-4*, par. 3-5*, par. 3-6* and par. 3-7*) configure the ramp parameters: ramp type, ramping times (duration of acceleration
and deceleration) and level of jerk compensation for S ramps.

Start by setting the linear ramping times corresponding to the figures.

If S-ramps are selected then set the level of non-linear jerk compensation required. Set jerk compensation by defining the proportion of ramp-up and
ramp-down times where acceleration and deceleration are variable (i.e. increasing or decreasing). The S-ramp acceleration and deceleration settings are
defined as a percentage of the actual ramp time.

74 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3-40 Ramp 1 Type


Option: Function:
Select the ramp type, depending on requirements for acceleration/deceleration.
A linear ramp will give constant acceleration during ramping. An S-ramp will give non-linear accel-
eration, compensating for jerk in the application.

[0] * Linear

[1] S-ramp Const Jerk Acceleration with lowest possible jerk.

[2] S-ramp Const Time S-ramp based on the values set in par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time and par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp
Down Time.

NB!
If S-ramp [1] is selected and the reference during ramping is changed the ramp time may be prolonged in order to realize a jerk free
movement which may result in a longer start or stop time.
Additional adjustment of the S-ramp ratios or switching initiators may be necessary.

3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-up time, i.e. the acceleration time from 0 RPM to the synchronous motor speed
nS. Choose a ramp-up time such that the output current does not exceed the current limit in par.
4-18 Current Limit during ramping. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 sec. in speed mode. See
ramp-down time in par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time.

tacc s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 41 =
ref RPM

3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-down time, i.e. the deceleration time from the synchronous motor speed ns to 0
RPM. Choose a ramp-down time such that no over-voltage arises in the inverter due to regenerative
operation of the motor, and such that the generated current does not exceed the current limit set
in par.4-18 Current Limit. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 s in speed mode. See ramp-up time
in par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time.

tdec s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 42 =
ref RPM

3-45 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks occurring in the application.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 75


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3-46 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-47 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start

3
Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time) where the
deceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-48 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time) where the
deceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3.5.5 3-5* Ramp 2

Choosing ramp parameters, see 3-4*.

3-50 Ramp 2 Type


Option: Function:
Select the ramp type, depending on requirements for acceleration/deceleration. A linear ramp will
give constant acceleration during ramping. An S-ramp will give non-linear acceleration, compen-
sating for jerk in the application.

[0] * Linear

[1] S-ramp Const Jerk Acceleration with lowest possible jerk

[2] S-ramp Const Time S-ramp based on the values set in par.3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time and par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp
down Time

NB!
If S-ramp [1] is selected and the reference during ramping is changed the ramp time may be prolonged in order to realize a jerk free
movement which may result in a longer start or stop time.
Additional adjustment of the S-ramp ratios or switching initiators may be necessary.

3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-up time, i.e. the acceleration time from 0 RPM to the rated motor speed ns. Choose
a ramp-up time such that the output current does not exceed the current limit in par.4-18 Current
Limit during ramping. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 sec. in speed mode. See ramp-down time
in par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time.

tacc s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 51 =
ref RPM

3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-down time, i.e. the deceleration time from the rated motor speed ns to 0 RPM.
Choose a ramp-down time such that no over-voltage arises in the inverter due to regenerative
operation of the motor, and such that the generated current does not exceed the current limit set

76 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

in par.4-18 Current Limit. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 s in speed mode. See ramp-up time
in par.3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time.

tdec s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 52 =
ref RPM

3-55 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.
3
3-56 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End
Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-57 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time) where the
deceleration torque increases The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-58 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time) where the
deceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3.5.6 3-6* Ramp 3

Configure ramp parameters, see 3-4*.

3-60 Ramp 3 Type


Option: Function:
Select the ramp type, depending on requirements for acceleration and deceleration. A linear ramp
will give constant acceleration during ramping. An S-ramp will give non-linear acceleration, com-
pensating for jerk in the application.

[0] * Linear

[1] S-ramp Const Jerk Accelerates with lowest possible jerk.

[2] S-ramp Const Time S-ramp based on the values set in par.3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time and par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp
down Time

NB!
If S-ramp [1] is selected and the reference during ramping is changed the ramp time may be prolonged in order to realize a jerk free
movement which may result in a longer start or stop time.
Additional adjustment of the S-ramp ratios or switching initiators may be necessary.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 77


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-up time, i.e. the acceleration time from 0 RPM to the rated motor speed ns. Choose
a ramp-up time such that the output current does not exceed the current limit in par.4-18 Current
Limit during ramping. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 sec. in speed mode. See ramp-down time
in par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time.

3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time


3 Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-down time, i.e. the deceleration time from the rated motor speed ns to 0 RPM.
Choose a ramp-down time such that no over-voltage arises in the inverter due to regenerative
operation of the motor, and such that the generated current does not exceed the current limit set
in par.4-18 Current Limit. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 s in speed mode. See ramp-up time
in par.3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time.

tdec s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 62 =
ref RPM

3-65 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-66 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-67 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time) where the
deceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-68 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-downdecel time (par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time) where
the deceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compen-
sation achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3.5.7 3-7* Ramp 4

Configure ramp parameters, see 3-4*.

3-70 Ramp 4 Type


Option: Function:
Select the ramp type, depending on requirements for acceleration and deceleration. A linear ramp
will give constant acceleration during ramping. An S-ramp will give non-linear acceleration, com-
pensating for jerk in the application

[0] * Linear

[1] S-ramp Const Jerk Accelerates with lowest possible jerk.

78 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[2] S-ramp Const Time S-ramp based on the values set in par.3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time and par.3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp
Down Time.

NB!
If S-ramp [1] is selected and the reference during ramping is changed the ramp time may be prolonged in order to realize a jerk free
movement which may result in a longer start or stop time.
Additional adjustment of the S-ramp ratios or switching initiators may be necessary.

3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time 3


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-up time, i.e. the acceleration time from 0 RPM to the rated motor speed ns. Choose
a ramp-up time such that the output current does not exceed the current limit in par.4-18 Current
Limit during ramping. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 sec. in speed mode. See ramp-down time
in par.3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time.

tacc s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 71 =
ref RPM

3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp-down time, i.e. the deceleration time from the rated motor speed ns to 0 RPM.
Choose a ramp-down time such that no over-voltage arises in the inverter due to regenerative
operation of the motor, and such that the generated current does not exceed the current limit set
in par.4-18 Current Limit. The value 0.00 corresponds to 0.01 s in speed mode. See ramp-up time
in par.3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time.

tdec s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 72 =
ref RPM

3-75 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-76 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-up time (par.3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time) in which the
acceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-77 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time) where the
deceleration torque increases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-78 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par.3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time) where the
deceleration torque decreases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation
achieved, and thus the lower the torque jerks in the application.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 79


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.5.8 3-8* Other Ramps

Configure parameters for special ramps e.g. Jog or Quick Stop.

3-80 Jog Ramp Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the jog ramp time, i.e. the acceleration/deceleration time between 0 RPM and the rated motor
frequency ns. Ensure that the resultant output current required for the given jog ramp time does

3 not exceed the current limit in par.4-18 Current Limit. The jog ramp time starts upon activation of
a jog signal via the control panel, a selected digital input, or the serial communication port.

tjog s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 80 =
Δ log speed ( par . 3 − 19) RPM

3-81 Quick Stop Ramp Time


Range: Function:
3.00 s* [0.01 - 3600.00 s] Enter the quick–stop ramp-down time, i.e. the deceleration time from the synchronous motor speed
to 0 RPM. Ensure that no resultant over-voltage will arise in the inverter due to regenerative oper-
ation of the motor required to achieve the given ramp-down time. Ensure also that the generated
current required to achieve the given ramp-down time does not exceed the current limit (set in par.
4-18 Current Limit). Quick-stop is activated by means of a signal on a selected digital input, or via
the serial communication port.

tQstop s x ns RPM
Par . 3 − 81 =
Δ jog ref ( par . 3 − 19) RPM

80 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3-82 Quick Stop Ramp Type


Option: Function:
Select the ramp type, depending on requirements for acceleration and deceleration. A linear ramp
will give constant acceleration during ramping. An S-ramp will give non-linear acceleration, com-
pensating for jerk in the application.

[0] * Linear

[1] S-ramp Const Jerk

[2] S-ramp Const Time 3


3-83 Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start
Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par. 3-42) where the deceleration torque increa-
ses. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation achieved, and thus the
lower the torque jerks in the application.

3-84 Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End


Range: Function:
50 %* [1 - 99. %] Enter the proportion of the total ramp-down time (par. 3-42) where the deceleration torque de-
creases. The larger the percentage value, the greater the jerk compensation achieved, and thus the
lower the torque jerks in the application.

3.5.9 3-9* Digital Pot.Meter

The digital potentiometer function allows the user to increase or decrease the actual reference by adjusting the set-up of the digital inputs using the
functions Increase, Decrease or Clear. To activate the function, at least one digital input must be set up to Increase or Decrease.

3-90 Step Size


Range: Function:
0.10 %* [0.01 - 200.00 %] Enter the increment size required for INCREASE/DECREASE, as a percentage of the synchronous
motor speed, ns. If INCREASE/ DECREASE is activated the resulting reference will be increased /
decreased by the amount set in this parameter.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 81


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3-91 Ramp Time


Range: Function:
1.00 s* [0.00 - 3600.00 s] Enter the ramp time, i.e. the time for adjustment of the reference from 0% to 100% of the specified
digital potentiometer function (Increase, Decrease or Clear).
If Increase/ Decrease is activated for longer than the ramp delay period specified in par.3-95 Ramp
Delay the actual reference will be ramped up / down according to this ramp time. The ramp time is
defined as the time used to adjust the reference by the step size specified in par.3-90 Step Size.

3 3-92 Power Restore


Option: Function:
[0] * Off Resets the Digital Potentiometer reference to 0% after power up.

[1] On Restores the most recent Digital Potentiometer reference at power up.

3-93 Maximum Limit


Range: Function:
100 %* [-200 - 200 %] Set the maximum permissible value for the resultant reference. This is advisable if the Digital Po-
tentiometer is used for fine tuning of the resulting reference.

3-94 Minimum Limit


Range: Function:
-100 %* [-200 - 200 %] Set the minimum permissible value for the resultant reference. This is advisable if the Digital Po-
tentiometer is used for fine tuning of the resulting reference.

3-95 Ramp Delay


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] Enter the delay required from activation of the digital potentiometer function until the frequency
converter starts to ramp the reference. With a delay of 0 ms, the reference starts to ramp as soon
as INCREASE/ DECREASE is activated. See also par.3-91 Ramp Time.

82 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.6 Parameters: Limits/Warnings


3.6.1 4-** Limits and Warnings

Parameter group for configuring limits and warnings.

3.6.2 4-1* Motor Limits 3


Define torque, current and speed limits for the motor, and the reaction of the frequency converter when the limits are exceeded.
A limit may generate a message on the display. A warning will always generate a message on the display or on the fieldbus. A monitoring function may
initiate a warning or a trip, upon which the frequency converter will stop and generate an alarm message.

4-10 Motor Speed Direction


Option: Function:
Select the motor speed direction(s) required. Use this parameter to prevent unwanted reversing.
When par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to Process [3], par.4-10 Motor Speed Direction is set to
Clockwise [0] as default. The setting in par.4-10 Motor Speed Direction does not limit options for
setting par.4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM].
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[0] * Clockwise

[1] Counter clockwise

[2] Both directions

4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM]


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Enter the minimum limit for motor speed. The Motor Speed Low Limit can be set to correspond to
the manufacturer’s recommended minimum motor speed. The Motor Speed Low Limit must not
exceed the setting in par.4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM].

4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0.0 - par. 4-14 Hz] Enter the minimum limit for motor speed. The Motor Speed Low Limit can be set to correspond to
the minimum output frequency of the motor shaft. The Motor Speed Low Limit must not exceed the
setting in par.4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz].

4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM]


Range: Function:
3600. RPM* [par. 4-11 - 60000. RPM] Enter the maximum limit for motor speed. The Motor Speed High Limit can be set to correspond to
the manufacturer’s maximum rated motor speed. The Motor Speed High Limit must exceed the
setting in par.4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM].

NB!
Max. output frequency cannot exceed 10% of the inverter switching frequency (par.14-01 Switching Frequency).

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 83


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz]


Range: Function:
50/60.0 [par. 4-12 - par. 4-19 Hz] Enter the maximum limit for motor speed. The Motor Speed High Limit can be set to correspond to
Hz* the manufacturer’s recommended maximum of the motor shaft. The Motor Speed High Limit must
exceed the in par. 4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz]. Only par. 4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit
[RPM] or par. 4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz] will be displayed depending on other parameters in
the Main Menu and depending on default settings dependant on global location.

3 NB!
Max. output frequency cannot exceed 10% of the inverter switching frequency (par. 14-01 Switching Frequency).

4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode


Range: Function:
160.0 %* [0.0 - 1000.0 %] This is a true torque limit function that can run into the oversynchronous range above nominal motor
speed.
Motor magnetisation drop is automatically compensated by a current increase.

Changing par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to Speed open loop [0], par.1-66 Min. Current
at Low Speed is automatically readjusted.

4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode


Range: Function:
100.0 %* [0.0 - 1000.0 %] This is a true torque limit function that can run into the oversynchronous range above nominal motor
speed.
Motor magnetisation drop is automatically compensated by a current increase.

4-18 Current Limit


Range: Function:
160.0 %* [1.0 - 1000.0 %] This is a true current limit function that continues in the oversynchronous range, however due to
field weakening the motor torque at current limit will drop accordingly when the voltage increase
stops above the synchronised speed of the motor.

4-19 Max Output Frequency


Range: Function:
132.0 Hz* [1.0 - 1000.0 Hz] Provides a final limit on the output frequency for improved safety in applications where you want
to avoid accidental over-speeding. This limit is final in all configurations (independent of the setting
in par.1-00 Configuration Mode).

NB!
Max. output frequency cannot exceed 10% of the inverter switching frequency (par.14-01 Switching Frequency).

par.4-19 Max Output Frequency cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

4-20 Torque Limit Factor Source


Option: Function:
Select an analog input for scaling the settings in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and par.
4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode from 0% to 100% (or inverse). The signal levels corresponding

84 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

to 0% and 100% are defined in the analog input scaling, e.g. par. group 6-1*. This parameter is
only active when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is in Speed Open Loop or Speed Closed Loop.

[0] * No function

[2] Analog in 53

[4] Analog in 53 inv

[6] Analog in 54

[8] Analog in 54 inv

[10] Analog in X30-11 3


[12] Analog in X30-11 inv

[14] Analog in X30-12

[16] Analog in X30-12 inv

4-21 Speed Limit Factor SourceOption


Option: Function:
Select an analog input for scaling the settings in par. 4-19 from 0% to 100% (or vice versa). The
signal levels corresponding to 0% and 100% are defined in the analog input scaling, e.g. par. group
6-1*. This parameter is only active when par. 1-00 Configuration Mode is in Torque Mode.

[0] * No function

[2] Analog input 53

[4] Analog input 53 inv

[6] Analog input 54

[8] Analog input 54 inv

[10] Analog input X30-11

[12] Analog input X30-11 inv

[14] Analog input X30-12

[16] Analog input X30-12 inv

3.6.3 4-3* Motor Feedback Monitoring

The parameter group includes monitoring and handling of motor feedback devices as encoders, resolvers etc.

4-30 Motor Feedback Loss Function


Option: Function:
Select which reaction the frequency converter should take if a feedback fault is detected. The se-
lected action is to take place when the feedback signal differs from the output speed where its range
is specified in par.4-31 Motor Feedback Speed Error during its time frame set in par.4-32 Motor
Feedback Loss Timeout.

[0] Disabled

[1] Warning

[2] * Trip

[3] Jog

[4] Freeze Output

[5] Max Speed

[6] Switch to Open Loop

[7] Select Setup 1

[8] Select Setup 2

[9] Select Setup 3

[10] Select Setup 4

[11] stop & trip

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 85


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

4-31 Motor Feedback Speed Error


Range: Function:
300 RPM* [1 - 600 RPM] Select the max allowed tracking error in speed from the calculated and the actual mechanical shaft
output speed.

4-32 Motor Feedback Loss Timeout


Range: Function:
0.05 s* [0.00 - 60.00 s] Set the timeout value allowing the speed error set in par.4-31 Motor Feedback Speed Error to be
exceeded.

4-34 Tracking Error Function


Option: Function:
Select how the drive should react when a tracking error is detected, i.e. when the motor speed
differs from the output of the ramp.

[0] * Disable

[1] Warning

[2] Trip

[3] Trip after stop

4-35 Tracking Error


Range: Function:
10 RPM* [1 - 600 RPM] Enter the maximum permissible speed error between the motor speed and the output of the ramp
when not ramping. In open loop the motor speed is estimated and in closed loop it is the feedback
from encoder/resolver.

4-36 Tracking Error Timeout


Range: Function:
1.00 s* [0.00 - 60.00 s] Enter the time-out period during which an error greater than the value set in par. 4-35 Tracking
Error is permissible.

4-37 Tracking Error Ramping


Range: Function:
100 RPM* [1 - 600 RPM] Enter the maximum permissible speed error between the motor speed and the output of the ramp
when ramping. In open loop the motor speed is estimated and in closed loop it is the feedback from
encoder/resolver.

86 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

4-38 Tracking Error Ramping Timeout


Range: Function:
1.00 s* [0.00 - 60.00 s] Enter the time-out period during which an error greater than the value set in par. 4-37 Tracking
Error while Ramping is permissible.

4-39 Tracking Error After Ramping Timeout


Range: Function:
5.00 s* [0.00 - 60.00 s] Enter the time-out period after ramping where parameter 4-37 and 4-38 are still active.
3
3.6.4 4-5* Adjustable Warnings

This is where adjustable warning limits for current, speed, reference and feedback can be defined. Warnings that are shown on the display can be
programmed as an output or sent via serial bus.

Warnings are shown on display, programmed output or serial bus.

4-50 Warning Current Low


Range: Function:
0.00 A* [0.00 - par. 4-51 A] Enter the ILOW value. When the motor current falls below this limit, the display reads Current Low.
The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC 302
only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only). Refer to the drawing in this section.

4-51 Warning Current High


Range: Function:
par. 16-37 [par. 4-50 - par. 16-37 A] Enter the IHIGH value. When the motor current exceeds this limit, the display reads Current High.
A* The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC 302
only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only). Refer to the drawing in this section.

4-52 Warning Speed Low


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - par. 4-53 RPM] Enter the nLOW value. When the motor speed exceeds this limit, the display reads Speed Low. The
signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC 302 only)
and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only).

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 87


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

4-53 Warning Speed High


Range: Function:
par. 4-13 [par. 4-52 - par. 4-13 RPM] Enter the nHIGH value. When the motor speed exceeds this limit, the display reads Speed High. The
RPM* signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC 302 only)
and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only). Programme the upper signal limit of the motor speed,
nHIGH, within the normal working range of the frequency converter. Refer to the drawing in this
section.

3 4-54 Warning Reference Low


Range: Function:
-999999.99 [-999999.999 - par. 4-55 N/A] Enter the lower reference limit. When the actual reference falls below this limit, the display indicates
9 N/A* Ref Low. The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29
(FC 302 only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only).

4-55 Warning Reference High


Range: Function:
999999.999 [par. 4-54 - 999999.999 N/A] Enter the upper reference limit. When the actual reference exceeds this limit, the display reads Ref
N/A* High. The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC
302 only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only).

4-56 Warning Feedback Low


Range: Function:
-999999.99 [-999999.999 - par. 4-57 Referen- Enter the lower feedback limit. When the feedback falls below this limit, the display reads Feedb
9 Referen- ceFeedbackUnit] Low. The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC
ceFeedback- 302 only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only).
Unit*

4-57 Warning Feedback High


Range: Function:
999999.999 [par. 4-56 - 999999.999 Referen- Enter the upper feedback limit. When the feedback exceeds this limit, the display reads Feedb High.
Reference- ceFeedbackUnit] The signal outputs can be programmed to produce a status signal on terminal 27 or 29 (FC 302
FeedbackU- only) and on relay output 01 or 02 (FC 302 only).
nit*

4-58 Missing Motor Phase Function


Option: Function:
Displays an alarm in the event of a missing motor phase.

Select 100 ms to have a short detection time and alarm in the event of a missing motor phase. 100
ms is recommended for hoisting applications.

[0] Disabled No alarm is displayed if a missing motor phase occurs.

[2] * Trip 1000 ms

NB!
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.6.5 4-6* Speed Bypass

Define the Speed Bypass areas for the ramps.


Some systems call for avoiding certain output frequencies or speeds, due to resonance problems in the system. A maximum of four frequency or speed
ranges can be avoided.

88 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

4-60 Bypass Speed From [RPM]


Array [4]

Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Some systems call for avoiding certain output speeds due to resonance problems in the system.
Enter the lower limits of the speeds to be avoided.

4-61 Bypass Speed From [Hz]


Array [4]

Range: Function:
3
0 Hz* [0.0 - par. 4-14 Hz] Some systems call for avoiding certain output speeds due to resonance problems in the system.
Enter the lower limits of the speeds to be avoided.

4-62 Bypass Speed To [RPM]


Array [4]

Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Some systems call for avoiding certain output speeds due to resonance problems in the system.
Enter the upper limits of the speeds to be avoided.

4-63 Bypass Speed To [Hz]


Array [4]

Range: Function:
0 Hz* [0.0 - par. 4-14 Hz] Some systems call for avoiding certain output speeds due to resonance problems in the system.
Enter the upper limits of the speeds to be avoided.

3.7 Parameters: Digital In/Out


3.7.1 5-** Digital In/Out

Parameter group for configuring the digital input and output.

3.7.2 5-0* Digital I/O Mode

Parameters for configuring the input and output using NPN and PNP.

5-00 Digital I/O Mode


Option: Function:
Digital inputs and programmed digital outputs are pre-programmable for operation either in PNP or
NPN systems.

[0] * PNP Action on positive directional pulses (↕). PNP systems are pulled down to GND.

[1] NPN Action on negative directional pulses (↕). NPN systems are pulled up to + 24 V, internally in the
frequency converter.

NB!
Once this parameter has been changed, it must be activated by performing a power cycle.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 89


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

5-01 Terminal 27 Mode


Option: Function:
[0] * Input Defines terminal 27 as a digital input.

[1] Output Defines terminal 27 as a digital output.

Please not that this parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is
running.

3 5-02 Terminal 29 Mode


Option: Function:
[0] * Input Defines terminal 29 as a digital input.

[1] Output Defines terminal 29 as a digital output.

This parameter is available for FC 302 only.


This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.7.3 5-1* Digital Inputs

Parameters for configuring the input functions for the input terminals.
The digital inputs are used for selecting various functions in the frequency converter. All digital inputs can be set to the following functions:

Digital input function Select Terminal


No operation [0] All *term 32, 33
Reset [1] All
Coast inverse [2] All *term 27
Coast and reset inverse [3] All
Quick stop inverse [4] All
DC-brake inverse [5] All
Stop inverse [6] All
Start [8] All *term 18
Latched start [9] All
Reversing [10] All *term 19
Start reversing [11] All
Enable start forward [12] All
Enable start reverse [13] All
Jog [14] All *term 29
Preset reference on [15] All
Preset ref bit 0 [16] All
Preset ref bit 1 [17] All
Preset ref bit 2 [18] All
Freeze reference [19] All
Freeze output [20] All
Speed up [21] All
Speed down [22] All
Set-up select bit 0 [23] All
Set-up select bit 1 [24] All
Precise stop inverse [26] 18, 19
Precises start, stop [27] 18, 19
Catch up [28] All
Slow down [29] All
Counter input [30] 29, 33
Pulse input [32] 29, 33
Ramp bit 0 [34] All
Ramp bit 1 [35] All
Mains failure inverse [36] All
Latched precise start [40] 18, 19
Latched precise stop inverse [41] 18, 19
DigiPot Increase [55] All
DigiPot Decrease [56] All
DigiPot Clear [57] All
Counter A (up) [60] 29, 33
Counter A (down) [61] 29, 33
Reset Counter A [62] All
Counter B (up) [63] 29, 33
Counter B (down) [64] 29, 33
Reset Counter B [65] All
Mech. Brake Feedb. [70] All
Mech. Brake Feedb. Inv. [71] All
PID enable [74]
MCO Specific [75]
PTC Card 1 [80] All

90 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

FC 300 standard terminals are 18, 19, 27, 29, 32 and 33. MCB 101 terminals are X30/2, X30/3 and X30/4.
Terminal 29 functions as an output only in FC 302.

Functions dedicated to only one digital input are stated in the associated parameter.

All digital inputs can be programmed to these functions:

[0] No operation No reaction to signals transmitted to the terminal.

[1]

[2]
Reset

Coast inverse
Resets frequency converter after a TRIP/ALARM. Not all alarms can be reset.

(Default Digital input 27): Coasting stop, inverted input (NC). The frequency converter leaves the
3
motor in free mode. Logic ‘0’ => coasting stop.

[3] Coast and reset inverse Reset and coasting stop Inverted input (NC). Leaves motor in free mode and resets frequency con-
verter. Logic ‘0’ => coasting stop and reset.

[4] Quick stop inverse Inverted input (NC). Generates a stop in accordance with quick-stop ramp time set in par.3-81 Quick
Stop Ramp Time. When motor stops, the shaft is in free mode. Logic ‘0’ => Quick-stop.

[5] DC-brake inverse Inverted input for DC braking (NC). Stops motor by energizing it with a DC current for a certain time
period. See par.2-01 DC Brake Current to par.2-03 DC Brake Cut In Speed [RPM]. The function is
only active when the value in par.2-02 DC Braking Time is different from 0. Logic ’0’ => DC braking.

[6] Stop inverse Stop Inverted function. Generates a stop function when the selected terminal goes from logical level
‘1’ to ‘0’. The stop is performed according to the selected ramp time (par.3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down
Time, par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time, par.3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time, par.3-72 Ramp 4
Ramp Down Time).

NB!
When the frequency converter is at the torque limit and has received a stop
command, it may not stop by itself. To ensure that the frequency converter stops,
configure a digital output to Torque limit & stop [27] and connect this digital
output to a digital input that is configured as coast.

[8] Start (Default Digital input 18): Select start for a start/stop command. Logic ‘1’ = start, logic ‘0’ = stop.

[9] Latched start The motor starts, if a pulse is applied for min. 2 ms. The motor stops when Stop inverse is activated.

[10] Reversing (Default Digital input 19). Change the direction of motor shaft rotation. Select Logic ‘1’ to reverse.
The reversing signal only changes the direction of rotation. It does not activate the start function.
Select both directions in par.4-10 Motor Speed Direction. The function is not active in process closed
loop.

[11] Start reversing Used for start/stop and for reversing on the same wire. Signals on start are not allowed at the same
time.

[12] Enable start forward Disengages the counterclockwise movement and allows for the clockwise direction.

[13] Enable start reverse Disengages the clockwise movement and allows for the counterclockwise direction.

[14] Jog (Default Digital input 29): Use to activate jog speed. See par.3-11 Jog Speed [Hz].

[15] Preset reference on Shifts between external reference and preset reference. It is assumed that External/preset [1] has
been selected in par.3-04 Reference Function. Logic '0' = external reference active; logic '1' = one
of the eight preset references is active.

[16] Preset ref bit 0 Preset ref. bit 0,1, and 2 enables a choice between one of the eight preset references according to
the table below.

[17] Preset ref bit 1 Same as Preset ref bit 0 [16].

[18] Preset ref bit 2 Same as Preset ref bit 0 [16].

Preset ref. bit 2 1 0


Preset ref. 0 0 0 0
Preset ref. 1 0 0 1
Preset ref. 2 0 1 0
Preset ref. 3 0 1 1
Preset ref. 4 1 0 0
Preset ref. 5 1 0 1
Preset ref. 6 1 1 0
Preset ref. 7 1 1 1

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 91


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[19] Freeze ref Freezes the actual reference, which is now the point of enable/condition for Speed up and Speed
down to be used. If Speed up/down is used, the speed change always follows ramp 2 (par.
3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time and par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time) in the range 0 - par.
3-03 Maximum Reference.

[20] Freeze output Freezes the actual motor frequency (Hz), which is now the point of enable/condition for Speed up
and Speed down to be used. If Speed up/down is used, the speed change always follows ramp 2
(par.3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time and par.3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time) in the range 0 - par.
1-23 Motor Frequency.

3 NB!
When Freeze output is active, the frequency converter cannot be stopped via a
low ‘start [8]’ signal. Stop the frequency converter via a terminal programmed
for Coasting inverse [2] or Coast and reset, inverse.

[21] Speed up Select Speed up and Speed down if digital control of the up/down speed is desired (motor poten-
tiometer). Activate this function by selecting either Freeze reference or Freeze output. When Speed
up/ down is activated for less than 400 msec. the resulting reference will be increased/ decreased
by 0.1 %. If Speed up/ down is activated for more than 400 msec. the resulting reference will follow
the setting in ramping up/ down parameter 3-x1/ 3-x2.

Shut down Catch up


Unchanged speed 0 0
Reduced by %-value 1 0
Increased by %-value 0 1
Reduced by %-value 1 1

[22] Speed down Same as Speed up [21].

[23] Set-up select bit 0 Select Set-up select bit 0 or Select Set-up select bit 1 to select one of the four set-ups. Set par.
0-10 Active Set-up to Multi Set-up.

[24] Set-up select bit 1 (Default Digital input 32): Same as Set-up select bit 0 [23].

[26] Precise stop inv. Prolongs stop signal to give a precise stop independent of speed.
Sends an inverted stop signal when the precise stop function is activated in par.1-83 Precise Stop
Function.
Precise stop inverse function is available for terminals 18 or 19.

[27] Precise start, stop Use when Precise ramp stop [0] is selected in par 1-83.

[28] Catch up Increases reference value by percentage (relative) set in par.3-12 Catch up/slow Down Value.

[29] Slow down Reduces reference value by percentage (relative) set in par.3-12 Catch up/slow Down Value.

[30] Counter input Precise stop function in par.1-83 Precise Stop Function acts as Counter stop or speed compensated
counter stop with or without reset. The counter value must be set in par.1-84 Precise Stop Counter
Value.

[32] Pulse input Use pulse sequence as either reference or feedback. Scaling is done in par. group 5-5*.

[34] Ramp bit 0 Enables a choice between one of the 4 ramps available, according to the table below.

[35] Ramp bit 1 Same as Ramp bit 0.

92 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Preset ramp bit 1 0


Ramp 1 0 0
Ramp 2 0 1
Ramp 3 1 0
Ramp 4 1 1

[36] Mains failure inverse Activates par.14-10 Mains Failure. Mains failure inverse is active in the Logic .0. situation.

[41] Latched Precise Stop inverse Sends a latched stop signal when the precise stop function is activated in par.1-83 Precise Stop

[55] DigiPot Increase


Function. The Latched Precise stop inverse function is available for terminals 18 or 19.

INCREASE signal to the Digital Potentiometer function described in parameter group 3-9*
3
[56] DigiPot Decrease DECREASE signal to the Digital Potentiometer function described in parameter group 3-9*

[57] DigiPot Clear Clears the Digital Potentiometer reference described in parameter group 3-9*

[60] Counter A (Terminal 29 or 33 only) Input for increment counting in the SLC counter.

[61] Counter A (Terminal 29 or 33 only) Input for decrement counting in the SLC counter.

[62] Reset Counter A Input for reset of counter A.

[63] Counter B (Terminal 29 or 33 only) Input for increment counting in the SLC counter.

[64] Counter B (Terminal 29 or 33 only) Input for decrement counting in the SLC counter.

[65] Reset Counter B Input for reset of counter B.

[70] Mech. Brake Feedback Brake feedback for hoisting applications

[71] Mech. Brake Feedback inv. Inverted brake feedback for hoisting applications

[74] PID enable

[75] MCO Specific

[80] PTC Card 1 All Digital Inputs can be set to PTC Card 1 [80]. However, only one Digital Input must be set to this
choice.

5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[8] * Start Functions are described under 5-1*

5-11 Terminal 19 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[10] * Reversing Functions are described under 5-1*

5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[2] * Coast inverse Functions are described under 5-1*

5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input


Option: Function:
Select the function from the available digital input range and the additional options [60], [61], [63]
and [64]. Counters are used in Smart Logic Control functions.This parameter is available for FC 302
only.

[14] * Jog Functions are described under 5-1*

5-14 Terminal 32 Digital Input


Option: Function:
Select the function from the available digital input range and the additional options [60], [61], [63]
and [64]. Counters are used in Smart Logic Control functions.

[0] * No operation Functions are described under 5-1*

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 93


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input


Option: Function:
Select the function from the available digital input range and the additional options [60], [61], [63]
and [64]. Counters are used in Smart Logic Control functions.

[0] * No operation Functions are described under 5-1*

5-16 Terminal X30/2 Digital Input


Option: Function:
3 [0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB101 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-17 Terminal X30/3 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB101 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-18 Terminal X30/4 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB101 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-19 Terminal 37 Safe Stop


Option: Function:
[1] * Safe Stop Alarm Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated. Manual reset from LCP, digital input or
fieldbus.

[3] Safe Stop Warning Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated (term 37 off). When safe stop circuit is
reestablished, the frequency converter will continue without manual reset.

[4] PTC 1 Alarm Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated. Manual reset from LCP, digital input or
fieldbus. Choice 4 is only available when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card is connected.

[5] PTC 1 Warning Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated (term 37 off). When safe stop circuit is
reestablished, the frequency converter will continue without manual reset, unless a Digital Input set
to PTC Card 1 [80] is still enabled. Choice 5 is only available when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor
Card is connected.

[6] PTC 1 & Relay A This choice is used when the PTC option is gated together with a Stop button through a Safety relay
to T-37. Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated. Manual reset from LCP, digital
input or fieldbus. Choice 6 is only available when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card is connected.

[7] PTC 1 & Relay W This choice is used when the PTC option is gated together with a Stop button through a Safety relay
to T-37. Coasts frequency converter when safe stop is activated (term 37 off). When safe stop circuit
is reestablished, the frequency converter will continue without manual reset, unless a Digital Input
set to PTC Card 1 [80] is (still) enabled. Choice 7 is only available when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor
Card is connected.

[8] PTC 1 & Relay A/W This choice makes it possible to use a combination of Alarm and Warning. Choice 8 is only available
when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card is connected.

[9] PTC 1 & Relay W/A This choice makes it possible to use a combination of Alarm and Warning. Choice 9 is only available
when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card is connected.

Choises 4 - 9 are only available when the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card is connected.

NB!
When Auto Reset/ Warning is selected the frequency converter opens up for automatic restart.

94 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Overview of functions, alarms and warnings

Function No. PTC Relay


No Function [0] - -

Safe Stop Alarm [1]* - Safe Stop [A68]


Safe Stop Warning [3] - Safe Stop [W68]
PTC 1 Alarm [4] PTC 1 Safe Stop [A71] -
PTC 1 Warning [5] PTC 1 Safe Stop [W71] -
PTC 1 & Relay A [6] PTC 1 Safe Stop [A71] Safe Stop [A68]
PTC 1 & Relay W
PTC 1 & Relay A/W
PTC 1 & Relay W/A
[7]
[8]
[9]
PTC
PTC
PTC
1
1
1
Safe
Safe
Safe
Stop [W71]
Stop [A71]
Stop [W71]
Safe Stop [W68]
Safe Stop [W68]
Safe Stop [A68]
3
W means warning and A means alarm. For further information, see Alarms and Warnings in section Troubleshooting in the Design Guide or the Operating
Instructions
A dangerous failure related to Safe Stop will give Alarm: Dangerous Failure [A72].

Please refer to the section Description of Alarm Word, Warning Word and extended Status Word in the chapter Troubleshooting.

5-20 Terminal X46/1 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-21 Terminal X46/3 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-22 Terminal X46/5 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-23 Terminal X46/7 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-24 Terminal X46/9 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-25 Terminal X46/11 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

5-26 Terminal X46/13 Digital Input


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is installed in the frequency converter. Func-
tions are described under 5-1*

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 95


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.7.4 5-3* Digital Outputs

Parameters for configuring the output functions for the output terminals. The 2 solid-state digital outputs are common for terminals 27 and 29. Set the
I/O function for terminal 27 in par.5-01 Terminal 27 Mode, and set the I/O function for terminal 29 in par.5-02 Terminal 29 Mode. These parameters
cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[0] No operation Default for all digital outputs and relay outputs

3
[1] Control ready The control board receives supply voltage.

[2] Drive ready The frequency converter is ready for operation and applies a supply signal on the control board.

[3] Drive ready / remote control The frequency converter is ready for operation and is in Auto On mode.

[4] Enable / no warning Ready for operation. No start or stop command is been given (start/disable). There are no warnings.

[5] VLT running Motor is running.

[6] Running / no warning Output speed is higher than the speed set in par.1-81 Min Speed for Function at Stop [RPM]. The
motor is running and there are no warnings.

[7] Run in range / no warning Motor is running within the programmed current and speed ranges set in par.4-50 Warning Current
Low to par.4-53 Warning Speed High. There are no warnings.

[8] Run on reference / no warning Motor runs at reference speed.

[9] Alarm An alarm activates the output. There are no warnings.

[10] Alarm or warning An alarm or a warning activates the output.

[11] At torque limit The torque limit set in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode or par. 1-17 has been exceeded.

[12] Out of current range The motor current is outside the range set in par.4-18 Current Limit.

[13] Below current, low Motor current is lower than set in par.4-50 Warning Current Low.

[14] Above current, high Motor current is higher than set in par.4-51 Warning Current High.

[15] Out of range Output frequency is outside the frequency range set in par.4-50 Warning Current Low and par.
4-51 Warning Current High.

[16] Below speed, low Output speed is lower than the setting in par.4-52 Warning Speed Low.

[17] Above speed, high Output speed is higher than the setting in par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

[18] Out of feedback range Feedback is outside the range set in par.4-56 Warning Feedback Low and par.4-57 Warning Feed-
back High.

[19] Below feedback low Feedback is below the limit set in par.4-56 Warning Feedback Low.

[20] Above feedback high Feedback is above the limit set in par.4-57 Warning Feedback High.

[21] Thermal warning The thermal warning turns on when the temperature exceeds the limit in the motor, the frequency
converter, the brake resistor, or the thermistor.

[22] Ready, no thermal warning Frequency converter is ready for operation and there is no over-temperature warning.

[23] Remote, ready, no thermal warning Frequency converter is ready for operation and is in Auto On mode. There is no over-temperature
warning.

[24] Ready, no over-/ under voltage Frequency converter is ready for operation and the mains voltage is within the specified voltage
range (see General Specifications section).

[25] Reverse Reversing. Logic ‘1’ when CW rotation of the motor. Logic ‘0’ when CCW rotation of the motor. If
the motor is not rotating the output will follow the reference.

[26] Bus OK Active communication (no time-out) via the serial communication port.

[27] Torque limit and stop Use in performing a coasting stop and in torque limit condition. If the frequency converter has
received a stop signal and is at the torque limit, the signal is Logic ‘0’.

[28] Brake, no brake warning Brake is active and there are no warnings.

[29] Brake ready, no fault Brake is ready for operation and there are no faults.

[30] Brake fault (IGBT) Output is Logic ‘1’ when the brake IGBT is short-circuited. Use this function to protect the frequency
converter if there is a fault on the brake modules. Use the output/relay to cut out the main voltage
from the frequency converter.

[31] Relay 123 Relay is activated when Control Word [0] is selected in parameter group 8-**.

96 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[32] Mechanical brake control Enables control of an external mechanical brake, see description in the section Control of Mechanical
Brake, and par. group 2-2*

[33] Safe stop activated (FC 302 only) Indicates that the safe stop on terminal 37 has been activated.

[40] Out of ref range

[41] Below reference low

[42] Above reference high

[45] Bus Ctrl Controls output via bus. The state of the output is set in par.5-90 Digital & Relay Bus Control. The

[46] Bus Ctrl On at timeout


output state is retained in the event of bus time-out.

Controls output via bus. The state of the output is set in par.5-90 Digital & Relay Bus Control. In
3
the event of bus time-out the output state is set high (On).

[47] Bus Ctrl Off at timeout Controls output via bus. The state of the output is set in par.5-90 Digital & Relay Bus Control. In
the event of bus time-out the output state is set low (Off).

[51] MCO controlled

[55] Pulse output

[60] Comparator 0 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 0 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[61] Comparator 1 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 1 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[62] Comparator 2 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 2 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[63] Comparator 3 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 3 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[64] Comparator 4 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 4 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[65] Comparator 5 See par. group 13-1*. If Comparator 5 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[70] Logic Rule 0 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 0 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[71] Logic Rule 1 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 1 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[72] Logic Rule 2 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 2 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[73] Logic Rule 3 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 3 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[74] Logic Rule 4 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 4 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[75] Logic Rule 5 See par. group 13-4*. If Logic Rule 5 is evaluated as TRUE, the output will go high. Otherwise, it
will be low.

[80] SL Digital Output A See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The output will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [38]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The output will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [32] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

[81] SL Digital Output B See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The input will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [39]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The input will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [33] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

[82] SL Digital Output C See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The input will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [40]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The input will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [34] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

[83] SL Digital Output D See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The input will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [41]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The input will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [35] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 97


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[84] SL Digital Output E See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The input will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [42]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The input will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [36] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

[85] SL Digital Output F See par.13-52 SL Controller Action. The input will go high whenever the Smart Logic Action [43]
Set dig. out. A high is executed. The input will go low whenever the Smart Logic Action [37] Set
dig. out. A low is executed.

[120] Local reference active Output is high when par.3-13 Reference Site = [2] Local or when par.3-13 Reference Site = [0]
Linked to hand auto at the same time as the LCP is in Hand on mode.
3 [121] Remote reference active Output is high when par.3-13 Reference Site = Remote [1] or Linked to hand/auto [0] while the
LCP is in [Auto on] mode.

[122] No alarm Output is high when no alarm is present.

[123] Start command active Output is high when there is an active Start command (i.e. via digital input bus connection or [Hand
on] or [Auto on]), and no Stop or Start command is active.

[124] Running reverse Output is high when the frequency converter is running counter clockwise (the logical product of
the status bits ‘running’ AND ‘reverse’).

[125] Drive in hand mode Output is high when the frequency converter is in Hand on mode (as indicated by the LED light
above [Hand on]).

[126] Drive in auto mode Output is high when the frequency converter is in Hand on mode (as indicated by the LED light
above [Auto on]).

5-30 Terminal 27 Digital Output


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation Functions are described under 5-3*

5-31 Terminal 29 Digital Output


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation Functions are described under 5-3*
This parameter only applies to FC 302

5-32 Term X30/6 Digi Out (MCB 101)


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 101 is mounted in the frequency converter.
Functions are described under 5-3*

5-33 Term X30/7 Digi Out (MCB 101)


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation This parameter is active when option module MCB 101 is mounted in the frequency converter.
Functions are described under 5-3*

3.7.5 5-4* Relays

Parameters for configuring the timing and the output functions for the relays.

5-40 Function Relay


Array [9]
(Relay 1 [0], Relay 2 [1], Relay 3 [2], Relay 4 [3], Relay 5 [4], Relay 6 [5], Relay 6 [5], Relay 7 [6], Relay 8 [7], Relay 9 [8])

Option: Function:
[0] * No operation

[1] Control ready

[2] Drive ready

[3] Drive rdy/rem ctrl

[4] Enable / no warning

[5] VLT running

98 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[6] Running / no warning

[7] Run in range/no warn

[8] Run on ref/no warn

[9] Alarm

[10] Alarm or warning

[11] At torque limit

[12] Out of current range

[13] Below current, low 3


[14] Above current, high

[15] Out of speed range

[16] Below speed, low

[17] Above speed, high

[18] Out of feedb. range

[19] Below feedback, low

[20] Above feedback, high

[21] Thermal warning

[22] Ready,no thermal W

[23] Remote,ready,no TW

[24] Ready, Voltage OK

[25] Reverse

[26] Bus OK

[27] Torque limit & stop

[28] Brake, no brake war

[29] Brake ready, no fault

[30] Brake fault (IGBT)

[31] Relay 123

[32] Mech brake ctrl

[33] Safe stop active

[36] Control word bit 11

[37] Control word bit 12

[38] Motor feedback error

[39] Tracking error

[40] Out of ref range

[41] Below reference, low

[42] Above ref, high

[43] Extended PID Limit

[45] Bus ctrl.

[46] Bus ctrl, 1 if timeout

[47] Bus ctrl, 0 if timeout

[51] MCO controlled

[60] Comparator 0

[61] Comparator 1

[62] Comparator 2

[63] Comparator 3

[64] Comparator 4

[65] Comparator 5

[70] Logic rule 0

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 99


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[71] Logic rule 1

[72] Logic rule 2

[73] Logic rule 3

[74] Logic rule 4

[75] Logic rule 5

[80] SL digital output A

[81] SL digital output B

3 [82] SL digital output C

[83] SL digital output D

[84] SL digital output E

[85] SL digital output F

[120] Local ref active

[121] Remote ref active

[122] No alarm

[123] Start command activ

[124] Running reverse

[125] Drive in hand mode

[126] Drive in auto mode

5-41 On Delay, Relay


Array [8](Relay 1 [0], Relay 2 [1], Relay 3 [2], Relay 4 [3], Relay 5 [4], Relay 6 [5], Relay 7 [6], Relay 8 [7], Relay 9 [8])

Range: Function:
0.01 s* [0.01 - 600.00 s] Enter the delay of the relay cut-in time. Select one of available mechanical relays and MCO 105 in
an array function. See par. 5-40 Function Relay. Relay 3-6 are included in MCB 112 (ATEX).

5-42 Off Delay, Relay


Array [8] (Relay 1 [0], Relay 2 [1], Relay 3 [2], Relay 4 [3], Relay 5 [4], Relay 6 [5], Relay 7 [6], Relay 8 [7], Relay 9 [8])

Range: Function:
0.01 s* [0.01 - 600.00 s] Enter the delay of the relay cut-out time. Select one of available mechanical relays and MCO 105 in
an array function. See par. 5-40 Function Relay.

100 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3
If the selected Event condition changes before the on- or off delay timer expires, the relay output is unaffected.

3.7.6 5-5* Pulse Input

The pulse input parameters are used to define an appropriate window for the impulse reference area by configuring the scaling and filter settings for the
pulse inputs. Input terminals 29 or 33 act as frequency reference inputs. Set terminal 29 (par. 5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input) or terminal 33
(par. 5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input) to Pulse input [32]. If terminal 29 is used as an input, then set par.5-01 Terminal 27 Mode to Input [0].

5-50 Term. 29 Low Frequency


Range: Function:
100 Hz* [0 - 110000 Hz] Enter the low frequency limit corresponding to the low motor shaft speed (i.e. low reference value)
in par.5-52 Term. 29 Low Ref./Feedb. Value. Refer to the diagram in this section.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

5-51 Term. 29 High Frequency


Range: Function:
100 Hz* [0 - 110000 Hz] Enter the high frequency limit corresponding to the high motor shaft speed (i.e. high reference
value) in par.5-53 Term. 29 High Ref./Feedb. Value.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

5-52 Term. 29 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0.000 Ref- [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the low reference value limit for the motor shaft speed [RPM]. This is also the lowest feedback
erenceFeed-enceFeedbackUnit] value, see also par.5-57 Term. 33 Low Ref./Feedb. Value. Set terminal 29 to digital input (par.
backUnit* 5-02 Terminal 29 Mode =input [0] (default) and par. 5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input = applicable
value).
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

5-53 Term. 29 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
1500.000 [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the high reference value [RPM] for the motor shaft speed and the high feedback value, see
Reference- enceFeedbackUnit] also par.5-58 Term. 33 High Ref./Feedb. Value. Select terminal 29 as a digital input (par.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 101


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

FeedbackU- 5-02 Terminal 29 Mode =input [0] (default) and par. 5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input = applicable
nit* value).
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

5-54 Pulse Filter Time Constant #29


Range: Function:
100 ms* [1 - 1000 ms] Enter the pulse filter time constant. The pulse filter dampens oscillations of the feedback signal,
which is an advantage if there is a lot of noise in the system. A high time constant value results in

3 better dampening but also increases the time delay through the filter. This parameter is available
for FC 302 only.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

5-55 Term. 33 Low Frequency


Range: Function:
100 Hz* [0 - 110000 Hz] Enter the low frequency corresponding to the low motor shaft speed (i.e. low reference value) in
par.5-57 Term. 33 Low Ref./Feedb. Value.

5-56 Term. 33 High Frequency


Range: Function:
100 Hz* [0 - 110000 Hz] Enter the high frequency corresponding to the high motor shaft speed (i.e. high reference value) in
par. 5-58 Term. 33 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

5-57 Term. 33 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A] Enter the low reference value [RPM] for the motor shaft speed. This is also the low feedback value,
see also par. 5-52 Term. 29 Low Ref./Feedb. Value.

5-58 Term. 33 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
1500.000 [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the high reference value [RPM] for the motor shaft speed. See also par.5-53 Term. 29 High
Reference- enceFeedbackUnit] Ref./Feedb. Value.
FeedbackU-
nit*

5-59 Pulse Filter Time Constant #33


Range: Function:
100 ms* [1 - 1000 ms] Enter the pulse filter time constant. The low-pass filter reduces the influence on and dampens os-
cillations on the feedback signal from the control.
This is an advantage, e.g. if there is a great amount on noise in the system. This parameter cannot
be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.7.7 5-6* Pulse Outputs

These parameters are to configure pulse outputs with their functions and scaling. Terminal 27 and 29 are allocated to pulse output via par.5-01 Terminal
27 Mode and par.5-02 Terminal 29 Mode, respectively.

102 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Options for readout output variables:

Parameters for configuring the scaling and output functions of pulse outputs. The pulse outputs are
designated to terminals 27 or 29. Select terminal 27 output in par.5-01 Terminal 27 Mode and
terminal 29 output in par.5-02 Terminal 29 Mode.

[0] No operation

[45] Bus control

[48] Bus control time-out

[51] MCO controlled

[100] Output frequency

[101] Reference

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current

[104] Torque relative to limit

[105] Torque relative to rated

[106] Power

[107] Speed

[108] Torque

[109] Max Out Freq

5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation Select the desired display output for terminal 27.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[45] Bus ctrl.

[48] Bus ctrl., timeout

[51] MCO controlled

[100] Output frequency

[101] Reference

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current

[104] Torque rel to limit

[105] Torq relate to rated

[106] Power

[107] Speed

[108] Torque

[109] Max Out Freq

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 103


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[119] Torque % lim

5-62 Pulse Output Max Freq #27


Range: Function:
5000. Hz* [0 - 32000 Hz] Set the maximum frequency for terminal 27, corresponding to the output variable selected in par.
5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3 5-63 Terminal 29 Pulse Output Variable


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation Select the desired display output for terminal 29. This parameter is available for FC 302 only.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[45] Bus ctrl.

[48] Bus ctrl., timeout

[51] MCO controlled

[100] Output frequency

[101] Reference

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current

[104] Torque rel to limit

[105] Torq relate to rated

[106] Power

[107] Speed

[108] Torque

[109] Max Out Freq

[119] Torque % lim

5-65 Pulse Output Max Freq #29


Range: Function:
5000 Hz* [0 - 32000 Hz] Set the maximum frequency for terminal 29 corresponding to the output variable set in
par. 5-63 Terminal 29 Pulse Output Variable.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

104 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

5-66 Terminal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable


Option: Function:
[0] * No operation Select the variable for read-out on terminal X30/6.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.
This parameter is active when option module MCB 101 is installed in the frequency converter.

[45] Bus ctrl.

[48] Bus ctrl., timeout

[100] Output freq. 0-100 3


[101] Reference Min-Max

[102] Feedback +-200%

[103] Motor cur. 0-Imax

[104] Torque 0-Tlim

[105] Torque 0-Tnom

[106] Power 0-Pnom

[107] Speed 0-HighLim

[113] Ext. Closed Loop 1

[114] Ext. Closed Loop 2

[115] Ext. Closed Loop 3

5-68 Pulse Output Max Freq #X30/6


Range: Function:
5000. Hz* [0 - 32000 Hz] Select the maximum frequency on terminal X30/6 referring to the output variable in par.5-66 Ter-
minal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable. This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.
This parameter is active when option module MCB 101 is mounted in the frequency converter.

3.7.8 5-7* 24 V Encoder Input

Parameters for configuring the 24 V encoder.


Connect the 24 V encoder to terminal 12 (24 V DC supply), terminal 32 (Channel A), terminal 33 (Channel B), and terminal 20 (GND). The digital inputs
32/33 are active for encoder inputs when 24 V encoder is selected in par.1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source and par.7-00 Speed PID Feedback Source.
The encoder used is a dual channel (A and B) 24 V type. Max input frequency: 110 kHz.

Encoder Connection to the frequency converter

24 V incremental encoder. Max. cable length 5 m.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 105


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

5-70 Term 32/33 Pulses per Revolution


Range: Function:
1024 N/A* [1 - 4096 N/A] Set the encoder pulses per revolution on the motor shaft. Read the correct value from the encoder.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

5-71 Term 32/33 Encoder Direction


Option: Function:

3 [0] * Clockwise
Change the detected encoder rotation direction without changing the wiring to the encoder.

Sets channel A 90° (electrical degrees) behind channel B upon clockwise rotation of the encoder
shaft.

[1] Counter clockwise Sets channel A 90° (electrical degrees) ahead of channel B upon clockwise rotation of the encoder
shaft.

This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.7.9 5-9*Bus Controlled

This parameter group selects digital and relay outputs via a fieldbus setting.

5-90 Digital & Relay Bus Control


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 2147483647 N/A] This parameter holds the state of the digital outputs and relays that is controlled by bus.
A logical '1' indicates that the output is high or active.
A logical '0' indicates that the output is low or inactive.

Bit 0 Digital Output Terminal 27


Bit 1 Digital Output Terminal 29
Bit 2 Digital Output Terminal X 30/6
Bit 3 Digital Output Terminal X 30/7
Bit 4 Relay 1 output terminal
Bit 5 Relay 2 output terminal
Bit 6 Option B Relay 1 output terminal
Bit 7 Option B Relay 2 output terminal
Bit 8 Option B Relay 3 output terminal
Bit 9-15 Reserved for future terminals
Bit 16 Option C Relay 1 output terminal
Bit 17 Option C Relay 2 output terminal
Bit 18 Option C Relay 3 output terminal
Bit 19 Option C Relay 4 output terminal
Bit 20 Option C Relay 5 output terminal
Bit 21 Option C Relay 6 output terminal
Bit 22 Option C Relay 7 output terminal
Bit 23 Option C Relay 8 output terminal
Bit 24-31 Reserved for future terminals

5-93 Pulse Out #27 Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal 27 when the terminal is configured as
'Bus Controlled' in par.5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable [45].

5-94 Pulse Out #27 Timeout Preset


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal 27 when the terminal is configured as
'Bus Ctrl Timeout' in par.5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable [48]. And a time-out is detected.

106 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

5-95 Pulse Out #29 Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal 29 when the terminal is configured as
'Bus Controlled' in par.5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable [45].
This parameter only applies for FC 302.

5-96 Pulse Out #29 Timeout Preset

3
Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal 29 when the terminal is configured as
'Bus Ctrl Timeout' in par.5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable [48]. And a time-out is detected.
This parameter only applies for FC 302.

3.7.10 5-97 Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control

5-97 Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal X30/6 when the terminal is configured
as 'Bus Controlled' in par. 5-66, Terminal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable [45].

3.7.11 5-98 Pulse Out #X30/6 Timeout Preset

5-98 Pulse Out #X30/6 Timeout Preset


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Set the output frequency transferred to the output terminal X30/6 when the terminal is configured
as 'Bus Ctrl Timeout' in par. 5-66, Terminal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable [48]. And a time-out is
detected.

3.8 Parameters: Analog In/Out


3.8.1 6-** Analog In/Out

Parameter group for configuration of the analog input and output.

3.8.2 6-0* Analog I/O Mode

The analog inputs can freely be allocated to be either voltage (FC 301: 0..10 V, FC 302: 0..+/- 10V) or current (FC 301/FC 302: 0/4..20 mA) input.

NB!
Thermistors may be connected to either an analog or a digital input.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 107


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-00 Live Zero Timeout Time


Range: Function:
10 s* [1 - 99 s] Enter the Live Zero Time-out time period. Live Zero Time-out Time is active for analog inputs, i.e.
terminal 53 or terminal 54, used as reference or feedback sources. If the reference signal value
associated with the selected current input falls below 50% of the value set in par. 6-10 Terminal 53
Low Voltage, par. 6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current, par. 6-20 Terminal 54 Low Voltage or
par. 6-22 Terminal 54 Low Current for a time period longer than the time set in par.6-00 Live Zero
Timeout Time, the function selected in par. 6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function will be activated.
3
6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function
Option: Function:
Select the time-out function. The function set in par.6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function will be acti-
vated if the input signal on terminal 53 or 54 is below 50% of the value in par.6-10 Terminal 53
Low Voltage, par.6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current, par.6-20 Terminal 54 Low Voltage or par.
6-22 Terminal 54 Low Current for a time period defined in par.6-00 Live Zero Timeout Time. If
several time-outs occur simultaneously, the frequency converter prioritises the time-out functions
as follows:

1. par.6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function

2. Par. 5-74

3. par.8-04 Control Word Timeout Function

[0] * Off

[1] Freeze output Frozen at the present value

[2] Stop Overruled to stop

[3] Jogging Overruled to jog speed

[4] Max. speed Overruled to max. speed

[5] Stop and trip Overruled to stop with subsequent trip

[20] Coast

[21] Coast and trip

3.8.3 6-1* Analog Input 1

Parameters for configuring the scaling and limits for analog input 1 (terminal 53).

108 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

6-10 Terminal 53 Low Voltage


Range: Function:
0.07 V* [-10.00 - par. 6-11 V] Enter the low voltage value. This analog input scaling value should correspond to the minimum
reference value, set in par.6-14 Terminal 53 Low Ref./Feedb. Value. See also the section Reference
Handling.

6-11 Terminal 53 High Voltage

3
Range: Function:
10.00 V* [par. 6-10 - 10.00 V] Enter the high voltage value. This analog input scaling value should correspond to the high refer-
ence/feedback value set in par. 6-15 Terminal 53 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current


Range: Function:
0.14 mA* [0.00 - par. 6-13 mA] Enter the low current value. This reference signal should correspond to the minimum reference
value, set in par.3-02 Minimum Reference. The value must be set at >2 mA in order to activate the
Live Zero Time-out Function in par.6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function.

6-13 Terminal 53 High Current


Range: Function:
20.00 mA* [par. 6-12 - 20.00 mA] Enter the high current value corresponding to the high reference/feedback set in par. 6-15 Terminal
53 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-14 Terminal 53 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A] Enter the analog input scaling value that corresponds to the low voltage/low current set in
par. 6-10 Terminal 53 Low Voltage and par. 6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current.

6-15 Terminal 53 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
1500.000 [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the analog input scaling value that corresponds to the maximum reference feedback value set
Reference- enceFeedbackUnit] in par.6-11 Terminal 53 High Voltage and par.6-13 Terminal 53 High Current.
FeedbackU-
nit*

6-16 Terminal 53 Filter Time Constant


Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 10.000 s] Enter the time constant. This is a first-order digital low pass filter time constant for suppressing
electrical noise in terminal 53. A high time constant value improves dampening but also increases
the time delay through the filter.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.8.4 6-2* Analog Input 2

Parameters for configuring the scaling and limits for analog input 2 (terminal 54).

6-20 Terminal 54 Low Voltage


Range: Function:
0.07 V* [-10.00 - par. 6-21 V] Enter the low voltage value. This analog input scaling value should correspond to the minimum
reference value, set in par.3-02 Minimum Reference. See also the section Reference Handling.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 109


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-21 Terminal 54 High Voltage


Range: Function:
10.00 V* [par. 6-20 - 10.00 V] Enter the high voltage value. This analog input scaling value should correspond to the high refer-
ence/feedback value set in par. 6-25 Terminal 54 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-22 Terminal 54 Low Current


Range: Function:

3 0.14 mA* [0.00 - par. 6-23 mA] Enter the low current value. This reference signal should correspond to the minimum reference
value, set in par.3-02 Minimum Reference. The value must be set at >2 mA in order to activate the
Live Zero Time-out Function in par.6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function.

6-23 Terminal 54 High Current


Range: Function:
20.00 mA* [par. 6-22 - 20.00 mA] Enter the high current value corresponding to the high reference/feedback value set in
par. 6-25 Terminal 54 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-24 Terminal 54 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0 Referen- [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the analog input scaling value that corresponds to the minimum reference feedback value set
ceFeedback-enceFeedbackUnit] in par.3-02 Minimum Reference.
Unit*

6-25 Terminal 54 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
1500.000 [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- Enter the analog input scaling value that corresponds to the maximum reference feedback value set
Reference- enceFeedbackUnit] in par.3-03 Maximum Reference.
FeedbackU-
nit*

6-26 Terminal 54 Filter Time Constant


Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 10.000 s] Enter the time constant. This is a first-order digital low pass filter time constant for suppressing
electrical noise in terminal 54. A high time constant value improves dampening but also increases
the time delay through the filter.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.8.5 6-3* Analog Input 3 MCB 101

Parameter group for configuring the scale and limits for analog input 3 (X30/11) placed on option module MCB 101.

6-30 Terminal X30/11 Low Voltage


Range: Function:
0.07 V* [0.00 - par. 6-31 V] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the low reference/feedback value (set in par.
6-34 Term. X30/11 Low Ref./Feedb. Value).

6-31 Terminal X30/11 High Voltage


Range: Function:
10.00 V* [par. 6-30 - 10.00 V] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the high reference/feedback value (set in par.
6-35 Term. X30/11 High Ref./Feedb. Value).

110 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

6-34 Term. X30/11 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the low voltage value (set in par.6-30 Terminal
X30/11 Low Voltage).

6-35 Term. X30/11 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
100.000 N/ [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A]
A*
Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the high voltage value (set in par.6-31 Terminal
X30/11 High Voltage). 3
6-36 Term. X30/11 Filter Time Constant
Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 10.000 s] A 1st order digital low pass filter time constant for suppressing electrical noise on terminal X30/11.
par.6-36 Term. X30/11 Filter Time Constant cannot be changed while the motor is running.

3.8.6 6-4* Analog Input 4 MCB 101

Parameter group for configuring the scale and limits for analog input 4 (X30/12) placed on option module MCB 101.

6-40 Terminal X30/12 Low Voltage


Range: Function:
0.07 V* [0.00 - par. 6-41 V] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the low reference/feedback value set in par.
6-44 Term. X30/12 Low Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-41 Terminal X30/12 High Voltage


Range: Function:
10.00 V* [par. 6-40 - 10.00 V] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the high reference/feedback value set in par.
6-45 Term. X30/12 High Ref./Feedb. Value.

6-44 Term. X30/12 Low Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A] Sets the analog output scaling value to correspond to the low voltage value set in par.6-40 Terminal
X30/12 Low Voltage.

6-45 Term. X30/12 High Ref./Feedb. Value


Range: Function:
100.000 N/ [-999999.999 - 999999.999 N/A] Sets the analog input scaling value to correspond to the high voltage value set in par.6-41 Terminal
A* X30/12 High Voltage.

6-46 Term. X30/12 Filter Time Constant


Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 10.000 s] A 1st order digital low pass filter time constant for suppressing electrical noise on terminal X30/12.
par.6-46 Term. X30/12 Filter Time Constant cannot be changed while the motor is running.

3.8.7 6-5* Analog Output 1

Parameters for configuring the scaling and limits for analog output 1, i.e. Terminal 42. Analog outputs are current outputs: 0/4 – 20 mA. Common terminal
(terminal 39) is the same terminal and has the same electrical potential for analog common and digital common connection. Resolution on analog output
is 12 bit.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 111


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-50 Terminal 42 Output


Option: Function:
Select the function of Terminal 42 as an analog current output. Depending on the selection the
output is either a 0-20 mA or 4-20 mA output. The current value can be read out in LCP in par.
16-65 Analog Output 42 [mA].

[0] * No operation When no signal on the analog output.

[52] MCO 0-20mA


3 [53] MCO 4-20mA

[100] Output frequency 0 Hz = 0 mA; 100 Hz = 20 mA.

[101] Reference par.3-00 Reference Range [Min - Max] 0% = 0 mA; 100% = 20 mA


par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max - Max] -100% = 0 mA; 0% = 10 mA; +100% = 20 mA

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current Value is taken from par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to
20 mA.

Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.

20 mA x 22 A
= 11.46 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par.6-52 Terminal 42 Output
Max Scale is:

I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[104] Torque rel to limit The torque setting is related to setting in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode

[105] Torq relate to rated The torque is related to the motor torque setting.

[106] Power Taken from par.1-20 Motor Power [kW].

[107] Speed Taken from par.3-03 Maximum Reference. 20 mA = value in par.3-03 Maximum Reference

[108] Torque Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[109] Max Out Freq In relation to par.4-19 Max Output Frequency.

[113] PID Clamped Output

[119] Torque % lim

[130] Output freq. 4-20mA 0 Hz = 4 mA, 100 Hz = 20 mA

[131] Reference 4-20mA par.3-00 Reference Range [Min-Max] 0% = 4 mA; 100% = 20 mA


par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max-Max] -100% = 4mA; 0% = 12 mA; +100% = 20 mA

[132] Feedback 4-20mA

[133] Motor cur. 4-20mA Value is taken from par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to
20 mA.

Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.

16 mA x 22 A
+ 4 mA = 13.17 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par.6-62 Terminal X30/8
Max. Scale is:

I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[134] Torq.% lim 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to setting in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode.

112 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[135] Torq.% nom 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to the motor torque setting.

[136] Power 4-20mA Taken from par.1-20 Motor Power [kW]

[137] Speed 4-20mA Taken from par.3-03 Maximum Reference. 20 mA = Value in par.3-03 Maximum Reference.

[138] Torque 4-20mA Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[139] Bus ctrl. 0-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal
functions in the frequency converter.

[140] Bus ctrl. 4-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal 3
functions in the frequency converter.

[141] Bus ctrl 0-20mA t.o. par.4-54 Warning Reference Low defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-
out.

[142] Bus ctrl 4-20mA t.o. par.4-54 Warning Reference Low defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-
out.

[149] Torque % lim 4-20mA Torque % Lim 4-20mA: Torque reference. par.3-00 Reference Range [Min-Max] 0% = 4 mA; 100%
= 20mA
par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max - Max] -100% = 4 mA; 0% = 12mA; +100% = 20mA

[150] Max Out Fr 4-20mA In relation to par.4-19 Max Output Frequency.

6-51 Terminal 42 Output Min Scale


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 200.00 %] Scale for the minimum output (0 or 4 mA) of the analogue signal at terminal 42.
Set the value to be the percentage of the full range of the variable selected in par. 6-50 Terminal
42 Output.

6-52 Terminal 42 Output Max Scale


Range: Function:
100.00 %* [0.00 - 200.00 %] Scale the maximum output of the selected analog signal at terminal 42. Set the value to the maxi-
mum value of the current signal output. Scale the output to give a current lower than 20 mA at full
scale; or 20 mA at an output below 100% of the maximum signal value. If 20 mA is the desired
output current at a value between 0 - 100% of the full-scale output, programme the percentage
value in the parameter, i.e. 50% = 20 mA. If a current between 4 and 20 mA is desired at maximum
output (100%), calculate the percentage value as follows:

20 mA / desired maximum current x 100 % 20


i .e . 10 mA : x 100 = 200 %
10


6-53 Terminal 42 Output Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Holds the level of Output 42 if controlled by bus.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 113


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-54 Terminal 42 Output Timeout Preset


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Holds the preset level of Output 42.
In case of a bus timeout and a timeout function is selected in par. 6-50 Terminal 42 Output the
output will preset to this level.

3 3.8.8 6-55 Terminal 42 Output Filter

6-55 Terminal 42 Output Filter


Option: Function:
[0] * Off

[1] On The following readout analogue parameters from selection in par. 6-50 have a filter selected when
par. 6-55 is on:

Selection 0-20 mA 4-20 mA


Motor current (0 - Imax) [103] [133]
Torque limit (0 - Tlim) [104] [134]
Rated torque (0 - Tnom) [105] [135]
Power (0 - Pnom) [106] [136]
Speed (0 - Speedmax) [107] [137]

3.8.9 6-6* Analog Output 2 MCB 101

Analog outputs are current outputs: 0/4 - 20 mA. Common terminal (terminal X30/8) is the same terminal and electrical potential for analog common
connection. Resolution on analog output is 12 bit.

6-60 Terminal X30/8 Output


Option: Function:
Select the function of Terminal X30/8 as an analog current output. Depending on the selection the
output is either a 0-20 mA or 4-20 mA output. The current value can be read out in LCP in par.
16-65 Analog Output 42 [mA].

[0] * No operation When no signal on the analog output.

[52] MCO 0-20mA

[100] Output frequency 0 Hz = 0 mA; 100 Hz = 20 mA.

[101] Reference par.3-00 Reference Range [Min - Max] 0% = 0 mA; 100% = 20 mA


par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max - Max] -100% = 0 mA; 0% = 10 mA; +100% = 20 mA

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current Value is taken from par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to
20 mA.

Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.

20 mA x 22 A
= 11.46 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par.6-62 Terminal X30/8
Max. Scale is:

I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[104] Torque rel to limit The torque setting is related to setting in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode.

114 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[105] Torq relate to rated The torque is related to the motor torque setting.

[106] Power Taken from par.1-20 Motor Power [kW].

[107] Speed Taken from par.3-03 Maximum Reference. 20 mA = value in par.3-03 Maximum Reference

[108] Torque Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[109] Max Out Freq In relation to par.4-19 Max Output Frequency.

3
[113] PID Clamped Output

[119] Torque % lim

[130] Output freq. 4-20mA 0 Hz = 4 mA, 100 Hz = 20 mA

[131] Reference 4-20mA par.3-00 Reference Range [Min-Max] 0% = 4 mA; 100% = 20 mA


par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max-Max] -100% = 4mA; 0% = 12 mA; +100% = 20 mA

[132] Feedback 4-20mA

[133] Motor cur. 4-20mA Value is taken from par.16-37 Inv. Max. Current. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to
20 mA.

Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.

16 mA x 22 A
= 9.17 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par.6-62 Terminal X30/8
Max. Scale is:

I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[134] Torq.% lim 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to setting in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode.

[135] Torq.% nom 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to the motor torque setting.

[136] Power 4-20mA Taken from par.1-20 Motor Power [kW]

[137] Speed 4-20mA Taken from par.3-03 Maximum Reference. 20 mA = Value in par.3-03 Maximum Reference.

[138] Torque 4-20mA Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[139] Bus ctrl. 0-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal
functions in the frequency converter.

[140] Bus ctrl. 4-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal
functions in the frequency converter.

[141] Bus ctrl 0-20mA t.o. par.4-54 Warning Reference Low defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-
out.

[142] Bus ctrl 4-20mA t.o. par.4-54 Warning Reference Low defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-
out.

[149] Torque % lim 4-20mA Torque % Lim 4-20mA: Torque reference. par.3-00 Reference Range [Min-Max] 0% = 4 mA; 100%
= 20mA
par.3-00 Reference Range [-Max - Max] -100% = 4 mA; 0% = 12mA; +100% = 20mA

[150] Max Out Fr 4-20mA In relation to par.4-19 Max Output Frequency.

6-61 Terminal X30/8 Min. Scale


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 200.00 %] Scales the minimum output of the selected analog signal on terminal X30/8. Scale the minimum
value as a percentage of the maximum signal value, i.e. 0 mA (or 0 Hz) is desired at 25% of the
maximum output value and 25% is programmed. The value can never be higher than the corre-
sponding setting in par. 6-62 Terminal X30/8 Max. Scale if value is below 100%.
This parameter is active when option module MCB 101 is mounted in the frequency converter.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 115


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-62 Terminal X30/8 Max. Scale


Range: Function:
100.00 %* [0.00 - 200.00 %] Scales the maximum output of the selected analog signal on terminal X30/8. Scale the value to the
desired maximum value of the current signal output. Scale the output to give a lower current than
20 mA at full scale or 20 mA at an output below 100% of the maximum signal value. If 20 mA is
the desired output current at a value between 0 - 100% of the ful-scale output, program the per-
centage value in the parameter, i.e. 50% = 20 mA. If a current between 4 and 20 mA is desired at
maximum output (100%), calculate the percentage value as follows:

3 20 mA / desired maximum current x 100 % 20 − 4


i .e . 10 mA : x 100 = 160 %
10

3.8.10 6-63 Terminal X30/8 Bus Control

6-63 Terminal X30/8 Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Holds the level of Output X30/8 if controlled by bus.

3.8.11 6-64 Terminal X30/8 Output Timeout Preset

6-64 Terminal X30/8 Output Timeout Preset


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [0.00 - 100.00 %] Holds the preset level of Output X30/8.
In case of a bus timeout and a timeout function is selected in par. 6-60, Terminal X30/8 Output,
the output will preset to this level.

3.8.12 6-7* Analog Output 3

Parameters for configuring the scaling and limits for analog output 3, Terminal X45/1 and X45/2. Analog outputs are current outputs: 0/4 – 20 mA.
Resolution on analog output is 11 bit.

6-70 Terminal X45/1 Output


Option: Function:
Select the function of Terminal X45/1 as an analog current output.

[0] No operation When no signal on the analog output.

[52] MCO 305 0-20 mA

[53] MCO 305 4-20 mA

[100] Output frequency 0-20 mA 0 Hz = 0 mA; 100 Hz = 20 mA.

[101] Reference 0-20 mA Par. 3-00 [Min - Max] 0% = 0 mA; 100% = 20 mA


Par. 3-00 [-Max - Max] -100% = 0 mA; 0% = 10 mA; +100% = 20 mA

[102] Feedback

[103] Motor current 0-20 mA Value is taken from par. 16-37. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to 20 mA.
Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.
20 mA x 22 A
= 11.46 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par. 6-52 is:
I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[104] Torque rel to lim 0-20 mA The torque setting is related to setting in par. 4-16

116 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[105] Torque rel to rated motor torque The torque is related to the motor torque setting.
0-20 mA

[106] Power 0-20 mA Taken from par. 1-20.

[107] Speed 0-20 mA Taken from par. 3-03. 20 mA = value in par. 3-03

[108] Torque ref. 0-20 mA Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[109] Max Out Freq 0-20 mA In relation to par. 4-19.

[130] Output freq. 4-20 mA 0 Hz = 4 mA, 100 Hz = 20 mA

[131] Reference 4-20 mA Par. 3-00 [Min-Max] 0% = 4 mA; 100% = 20 mA


Par. 3-00 [-Max-Max] -100% = 4mA; 0% = 12 mA; +100% = 20 mA
3
[132] Feedback 4-20 mA

[133] Motor cur. 4-20 mA Value is taken from par. 16-37. Inverter max. current (160% current) is equal to 20 mA.
Example: Inverter norm current (11 kW) = 24 A. 160 % = 38.4 A. Motor norm current = 22 A Read-
out 11.46 mA.
16 mA x 22 A
= 9.17 mA
38.4 A
In case the norm motor current is equal to 20 mA, the output setting of par. 6-52 is:
I VLT x 100
Max 38.4 x 100
= = 175 %
I Motor 22
Norm

[134] Torque % lim. 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to setting in par. 4-16.

[135] Torque % nom 4-20 mA The torque setting is related to the motor torque setting.

[136] Power 4-20 mA Taken from par. 1-20

[137] Speed 4-20 mA Taken from par. 3-03. 20 mA = Value in par. 3-03.

[138] Torque 4-20 mA Torque reference related to 160% torque.

[139] Bus ctrl. 0-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal
functions in the frequency converter.

[140] Bus ctrl. 4-20 mA An output value set from fieldbus process data. The output will work independently of internal
functions in the frequency converter.

[141] Bus ctrl. 0-20 mA, timeout Par. 4-54 defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-out.

[142] Bus ctrl. 4-20 mA, timeout Par. 4-54 defines the behaviour of the analog output in case of bus time-out.

[150] Max Out Freq 4-20 mA In relation to par. 4-19.

6-71 Terminal X45/1 Output Min Scale


Range: Function:
0.00%* [0.00 - 200.00%] Scale the minimum output of the selected analog signal at terminal X45/1, as a percentage of the
maximum signal value. E.g. if 0 mA (or 0 Hz) is desired at 25% of the maximum output value, then
programme 25%. Scaling values up to 100% can never be higher than the corresponding setting
in par. 6-72.

6-72 Terminal X45/1 Output Max Scale


Range: Function:
100%* [0.00 - 200.00%] Scale the maximum output of the selected analog signal at terminal X45/1. Set the value to the
maximum value of the current signal output. Scale the output to give a current lower than 20 mA
at full scale; or 20 mA at an output below 100% of the maximum signal value. If 20 mA is the desired
output current at a value between 0 - 100% of the full-scale output, programme the percentage
value in the parameter, i.e. 50% = 20 mA. If a current between 4 and 20 mA is desired at maximum
output (100%), calculate the percentage value as follows (example where desired max. output is
10 mA):

I RANGE mA 20 − 4 mA
x 100 % = x 100 % = 160 %
I DESIRED MAX mA 10 mA

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 117


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

6-73 Terminal X45/1 Output Bus Control


Range: Function:
0.00%* [0.00 - 100.00%] Holds the level of Analog Output 3 (terminal X45/1) if controlled by bus.

6-74 Terminal X45/1 Output Timeout Preset


Range: Function:
0.00%* [0.00 - 100.00%] Holds the preset level of Analog Output 3 (terminal X45/1).
In case of a bus timeout and a timeout function is selected in par. 6-70 the output will preset to this
level.

3.8.13 6-8* Analog Output 4

Parameters for configuring the scaling and limits for analog output 4. Terminal X45/3 and X45/4. Analog outputs are current outputs: 0/4 – 20 mA.
Resolution on analog output is 11 bit.

6-80 Terminal X45/3 Output


Option: Function:
Select the function of Terminal X45/3 as an analog current output.

[0] * No operation Same selections available as for par. 6-70

6-81 Terminal X45/3 Output Min Scale


Option: Function:
[0.00%] * 0.00 - 200.00% Scales the minimum output of the selected analog signal on terminal X45/3. Scale the minimum
value as a percentage of the maximum signal value, i.e. 0 mA (or 0 Hz) is desired at 25% of the
maximum output value and 25% is programmed. The value can never be higher than the corre-
sponding setting in par. 6-82 if value is below 100%.
This parameter is active when option module MCB 113 is mounted in the frequency converter.

6-82 Terminal X45/3 Output Max Scale


Option: Function:
[0.00%] * 0.00 - 200.00% Scales the maximum output of the selected analog signal on terminal X45/3. Scale the value to the
desired maximum value of the current signal output. Scale the output to give a lower current than
20 mA at full scale or 20 mA at an output below 100% of the maximum signal value. If 20 mA is
the desired output current at a value between 0 - 100% of the ful-scale output, program the per-
centage value in the parameter, i.e. 50% = 20 mA. If a current between 4 and 20 mA is desired at
maximum output (100%), calculate the percentage value as follows (example where desired max.
output is 10 mA):

I RANGE mA 20 − 4 mA
x 100 % = x 100 % = 160 %
I DESIRED MAX mA 10 mA

118 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

6-83 Terminal X45/3 Output Bus Control


Option: Function:
[0.00%] * 0.00 - 100.00% Holds the level of output 4 (X45/3) if controlled by bus.

6-84 Terminal X45/3 Output Timeout Preset


Option: Function:
[0.00%] * 0.00 - 100.00% Holds the present level of output 4 (X45/3). In case of a bus timeout and a timeout function is

3
selected in par. 6-80 the output will preset to this level.

3.9 Parameters: Controllers


3.9.1 7-** Controllers

Parameter group for configuring application controls.

3.9.2 7-0* Speed PID Ctrl.

Parameters for configuring the speed PID control.

7-00 Speed PID Feedback Source


Option: Function:
Select the encoder for closed loop feedback.
The feedback may come from a different encoder (typically mounted on the application itself) than
the motor mounted encoder feedback selected in par.1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

[0] * Motor feedb. P1-02

[1] 24V encoder

[2] MCB 102

[3] MCB 103

[5] MCO Encoder 2

[6] Analog input 53

[7] Analog input 54

[8] Frequency input 29

[9] Frequency input 33

NB!
If separate encoders are used (FC 302 only) the ramp settings parameters in the following groups: 3-4*, 3-5*, 3-6*, 3-7* and 3-8*
must be adjusted according to the gear ratio between the two encoders.

7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0.000 - 1.000 N/A] Enter the speed controller proportional gain. The proportional gain amplifies the error (i.e. the de-
viation between the feedback signal and the set-point). This parameter is used with par.
1-00 Configuration Mode Speed open loop [0] and Speed closed loop [1] control. Quick control is
obtained at high amplification. However if the amplification is too great, the process may become
unstable.
Use this parameter for values with three decimals. For a selection with four decimals, use par. 3-83.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 119


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

7-03 Speed PID Integral Time


Range: Function:
8.0 ms* [2.0 - 20000.0 ms] Enter the speed controller integral time, which determines the time the internal PID control takes
to correct errors. The greater the error, the more quickly the gain increases. The integral time causes
a delay of the signal and therefore a dampening effect, and can be used to eliminate steady state
speed error. Obtain quick control through a short integral time, though if the integral time is too
short, the process becomes unstable. An excessively long integral time disables the integral action,
leading to major deviations from the required reference, since the process regulator takes too long

3 to regulate errors. This parameter is used with Speed open loop [0] and Speed closed loop [1]
control, set in par.1-00 Configuration Mode.

7-04 Speed PID Differentiation Time


Range: Function:
30.0 ms* [0.0 - 200.0 ms] Enter the speed controller differentiation time. The differentiator does not react to constant error.
It provides gain proportional to the rate of change of the speed feedback. The quicker the error
changes, the stronger the gain from the differentiator. The gain is proportional with the speed at
which errors change. Setting this parameter to zero disables the differentiator. This parameter is
used with par.1-00 Configuration Mode Speed closed loop [1] control.

7-05 Speed PID Diff. Gain Limit


Range: Function:
5.0 N/A* [1.0 - 20.0 N/A] Set a limit for the gain provided by the differentiator. Since the differential gain increases at higher
frequencies, limiting the gain may be useful. For example, set up a pure D-link at low frequencies
and a constant D-link at higher frequencies. This parameter is used with par.1-00 Configuration
Mode Speed closed loop [1] control.

7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time


Range: Function:
10.0 ms* [1.0 - 100.0 ms] Set a time constant for the speed control low-pass filter. The low-pass filter improves steady-state
performance and dampens oscillations on the feedback signal. This is an advantage if there is a
great amount on noise in the system, see illustration below. For example, if a time constant (τ) of
100 ms is programmed, the cut-off frequency for the low-pass filter will be 1/0.1= 10 RAD/sec.,
corresponding to (10/2 x π) = 1.6 Hz. The PID regulator only regulates a feedback signal that varies
by a frequency of less than 1.6 Hz. If the feedback signal varies by a higher frequency than 1.6 Hz,
the PID regulator does not react.
Practical settings of par.7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time taken from the number of pulses per
revolutions from encoder:

Encoder PPR par.7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time


512 10 ms

1024 5 ms
2048 2 ms
4096 1 ms

Note that severe filtering can be detrimental to dynamic performance.


This parameter is used with par.1-00 Configuration Mode Speed closed loop [1] and Torque [2]
control.
The filter time in flux sensorless must be adjusted to 3-5 ms.

120 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

7-07 Speed PID Feedback Gear Ratio


Range: Function:
1.0000 N/ [0.0001 - 32.0000 N/A]
A*

7-08 Speed PID Feed Forward Factor


Range: Function:
0 %* [0 - 500 %] The reference signal bypasses the speed controller by the amount specified. This feature increases
the dynamic performance of the speed control loop.

3.9.3 7.1* Torque PI Control

Parameters for configuring the torque PI control in torque open loop (par.1-00 Configuration Mode).

7-12 Torque PI Proportional Gain


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 500 %] Enter the proportional gain value for the torque controller. Selection of a high value makes the
controller react faster. Too high a setting leads to controller instability.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 121


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

7-13 Torque PI Integration Time


Range: Function:
0.020 s* [0.002 - 2.000 s] Enter the integration time for the torque controller. Selection of a low value makes the controller
react faster. Too low a setting leads to control instability.

3.9.4 7-2* Process Ctrl. Feedb.

3 Select the feedback sources for the Process PID Control, and how this feedback should be handled.

7-20 Process CL Feedback 1 Resource


Option: Function:
The effective feedback signal is made up of the sum of up to two different input signals.
Select which frequency converter input should be treated as the source of the first of these signals.
The second input signal is defined in par.7-22 Process CL Feedback 2 Resource.

[0] * No function

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[3] Frequency input 29

[4] Frequency input 33

[7] Analog input X30/11

[8] Analog input X30/12

7-22 Process CL Feedback 2 Resource


Option: Function:
The effective feedback signal is made up of the sum of up to two different input signals. Select
which frequency converter input should be treated as the source of the second of these signals. The
first input signal is defined in par. 7-21.

[0] * No function

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[3] Frequency input 29

[4] Frequency input 33

[7] Analog input X30/11

[8] Analog input X30/12

3.9.5 7-3* Process PID Ctrl.

Parameters for configuring the Process PID control.

7-30 Process PID Normal/ Inverse Control


Option: Function:
Normal and inverse control are implemented by introducing a difference between the reference
signal and the feedback signal.

[0] * Normal Sets process control to increase the output frequency.

[1] Inverse Sets process control to reduce the output frequency.

7-31 Process PID Anti Windup


Option: Function:
[0] Off Ceases regulation of an error when the output frequency can no longer be adjusted.

122 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1] * On Continues regulation of an error even when the output frequency cannot be increased or decreased.

7-32 Process PID Start Speed


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [0 - 6000 RPM] Enter the motor speed to be attained as a start signal for commencement of PID control. When the
power is switched on, the frequency converter will commence ramping and then operate under
speed open loop control. Thereafter, when the Process PID start speed is reached, the frequency
converter will change over to Process PID control.

3
7-33 Process PID Proportional Gain
Range: Function:
0.01 N/A* [0.00 - 10.00 N/A] Enter the PID proportional gain. The proportional gain multiplies the error between the set point
and the feedback signal.

7-34 Process PID Integral Time


Range: Function:
10000.00 [0.01 - 10000.00 s] Enter the PID integral time. The integrator provides an increasing gain at a constant error between
s* the set point and the feedback signal. The integral time is the time needed by the integrator to reach
the same gain as the proportional gain.

7-35 Process PID Differentiation Time


Range: Function:
0.00 s* [0.00 - 10.00 s] Enter the PID differentiation time. The differentiator does not react to a constant error, but provides
a gain only when the error changes. The shorter the PID differentiation time, the stronger the gain
from the differentiator.

7-36 Process PID Diff. Gain Limit


Range: Function:
5.0 N/A* [1.0 - 50.0 N/A] Enter a limit for the differentiator gain (DG). If there is no limit, the DG will increase when there are
fast changes. Limit the DG to obtain a pure differentiator gain at slow changes and a constant
differentiator gain where fast changes occur.

7-38 Process PID Feed Forward Factor


Range: Function:
0 %* [0 - 500 %] Enter the PID feed forward (FF) factor. The FF factor sends a constant fraction of the reference
signal to bypass the PID control, so the PID control only affects the remaining fraction of the control
signal. Any change to this parameter will thus affect the motor speed. When the FF factor is activated
it provides less overshoot, and high dynamics when changing the set point. par.7-38 Process PID
Feed Forward Factor is active when par.1-00 Configuration Mode is set to [3] Process.

7-39 On Reference Bandwidth


Range: Function:
5 %* [0 - 200 %] Enter the On Reference bandwidth. When the PID Control Error (the difference between the refer-
ence and the feedback) is less than the set value of this parameter the On Reference status bit is
high, i.e. =1.

3.9.6 7-4* Advanced Process PID Ctrl.

7-40 Process PID I-part Reset


Option: Function:
[0] * No

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 123


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1] Yes Select Yes [1] to reset the I-part of the process PID controller. The selection will automatically revert
to No [0].

7-41 Process PID Output Neg. Clamp


Range: Function:
-100 %* [-100 - par. 7-42 %] Enter a negative limit for the process PID controller output.

7-42 Process PID Output Pos. Clamp


3 Range: Function:
100 %* [par. 7-41 - 100 %] Enter a positive limit for the process PID controller output.

7-43 Process PID Gain Scale at Min. Ref.


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 100 %] Enter a scaling percentage to apply to the process PID output when operating at the minimum
reference. The scaling percentage will be adjusted linearly between the scale at min. ref. (par. 7-43)
and the scale at max. ref. (par. 7-44).

7-44 Process PID Gain Scale at Max. Ref.


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 100 %] Enter a scaling percentage to apply to the process PID output when operating at the maximum
reference. The scaling percentage will be adjusted linearly between the scale at min. ref. (par. 7-43)
and the scale at max. ref. (par. 7-44).

7-45 Process PID Feed Fwd Resource


Option: Function:
[0] * No function Select which drive input should be used as the feed forward factor. The FF factor is added directly
to the output of the PID controller. This increases dynamic performance.

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[7] Frequency input 29

[8] Frequency input 33

[11] Local bus reference

[20] Digital pot.meter

[21] Analog input X30-11

[22] Analog input X30-12

7-46 Process PID Feed Fwd Normal/ Inv. Ctrl.


Option: Function:
[0] * Normal Select Normal [0] to set the feed forward factor to treat the FF resource as a positive value.

[1] Inverse Select Inverse [1] to treat the FF resource as a negative value.

7-49 Process PID Output Normal/ Inv. Ctrl.


Option: Function:
[0] * Normal Select Normal [0] to use the resulting output from the process PID controller as is.

[1] Inverse Select Inverse [1] to invert the resulting output from the process PID controller. This operation is
performed after the feed forward factor is applied.

124 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.9.7 7-5* Position PID Ctrl.

7-50 Process PID Extended PID


Option: Function:
[0] Disabled Disables the process PID controller.

[1] * Enabled Enables the process PID controller.

7-51 Process PID Feed Fwd Gain


Range: Function:
3
1.00 N/A* [0.00 - 100.00 N/A]

7-52 Process PID Feed Fwd Ramp up


Range: Function:
0.01 s* [0.01 - 10.00 s]

7-53 Process PID Feed Fwd Ramp down


Range: Function:
0.01 s* [0.01 - 10.00 s]

7-56 Process PID Ref. Filter Time


Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 1.000 s] Set a time constant for the reference first order low-pass filter. The low-pass filter improves steady-
state performance and dampens oscillations on the reference/feedback signals. However severe
filtering can be detrimental to dynamic performance.

7-57 Process PID Fb. Filter Time


Range: Function:
0.001 s* [0.001 - 1.000 s] Set a time constant for the feedback first order low-pass filter. The low-pass filter improves steady-
state performance and dampens oscillations on the reference/feedback signals. However severe
filtering can be detrimental to dynamic performance.

3.10 Parameters: Communications and Options


3.10.1 8-** Comm. and Options

Parameter group for configuring communications and options.

3.10.2 8-0* General Settings

General settings for communications and options.

8-01 Control Site


Option: Function:
The setting in this parameter overrides the settings in par.8-50 Coasting Select to par.8-56 Preset
Reference Select.

[0] * Digital and ctrl.word Control by using both digital input and control word.

[1] Digital only Control by using digital inputs only.

[2] Controlword only Control by using control word only.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 125


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

8-02 Control Word Source


Select the source of the control word: one of two serial interfaces or four installed options. During initial power-up, the frequency converter automatically
sets this parameter to Option A [3] if it detects a valid fieldbus option installed in slot A. If the option is removed, the frequency converter detects a
change in the configuration, sets par.8-02 Control Word Source back to default setting FC RS485, and the frequency converter then trips. If an option
is installed after initial power-up, the setting of par.8-02 Control Word Source will not change but the frequency converter will trip and display: Alarm
67 Option Changed.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Option: Function:
3 [0] None

[1] FC RS485

[2] FC USB

[3] * Option A

[4] Option B

[5] Option C0

[6] Option C1

[30] External Can

8-03 Control Word Timeout Time


Range: Function:
1.0 s* [0.1 - 18000.0 s] Enter the maximum time expected to pass between the reception of two consecutive telegrams. If
this time is exceeded, it indicates that the serial communication has stopped. The function selected
in par.8-04 Control Word Timeout Function will then be carried out. The time-out counter is triggered
by a valid control word.

8-04 Control Word Timeout Function


Select the time-out function. The time-out function activates when the control word fails to be updated within the time period specified in par.
8-03 Control Word Timeout Time.

Option: Function:
[0] * Off Resumes control via serial bus (Fieldbus or standard) using the most recent control word.

[1] Freeze output Freezes output frequency until communication resumes.

[2] Stop Stops with auto restart when communication resumes.

[3] Jogging Runs the motor at JOG frequency until communication resumes.

[4] Max. speed Runs the motor at maximum frequency until communication resumes.

[5] Stop and trip Stops the motor, then resets the frequency converter in order to restart: via the fieldbus, via the
reset button on the LCP or via a digital input.

[7] Select setup 1 Changes the set-up upon reestablishment of communication following a control word time-out. If
communication resumes causing the time-out situation to disappear, par.8-05 End-of-Timeout
Function defines whether to resume the set-up used before the time-out or to retain the set-up
endorsed by the time-out function.

[8] Select setup 2 See [7] Select setup 1

[9] Select setup 3 See [7] Select setup 1

[10] Select setup 4 See [7] Select setup 1

NB!
The following configuration is required in order to change the set-up after a time-out:
Set par.0-10 Active Set-up to [9] Multi set-up and select the relevant link in par.0-12 This Set-up Linked to.

126 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

8-05 End-of-Timeout Function


Option: Function:
Select the action after receiving a valid control word following a time-out. This parameter is active
only when par. 8-04 Control Timeout Function is set to [Set-up 1-4].

[0] Hold set-up Retains the set-up selected in par. 8-04 Control Timeout Function and displays a warning, until
par. 8-06 Reset Control Timeout toggles. Then the frequency converter resumes its original set-up.

[1] * Resume set-up Resumes the set-up active prior to the time-out.
3
8-06 Reset Control Word Timeout
This parameter is active only when Hold set-up [0] has been selected in par.8-05 End-of-Timeout Function.

Option: Function:
[0] * Do not reset Retains the set-up specified in par.8-04 Control Word Timeout Function, following a control word
time-out.

[1] Do reset Returns the frequency converter to the original set-up following a control word time-out. The fre-
quency converter performs the reset and then immediately reverts to the Do not reset [0] setting

8-07 Diagnosis Trigger


Option: Function:
This parameter enables and controls the frequency converter diagnosis function and permits ex-
pansion of the diagnosis data to 24 byte.

NB!
This is only valid for Profibus.

- Disable [0]: Do not send extended diagnosis data even if they appear in the frequency
converter.

- Trigger on alarms [1]: Send extended diagnosis data when one or more alarms appear in
alarm par. 16-90 Alarm Word or par.9-53 Profibus Warning Word.

- Trigger alarms/warn. [2]: Send extended diagnosis data if one or more alarms or warnings
appear in alarm par. 16-90 Alarm Word, par.9-53 Profibus Warning Word, or warning
par. 16-92 Warning Word.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 127


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

The content of the extended diagnosis frame is as follows:

Byte Content Description


0-5 Standard DP Diagnose Data Standard DP Diagnose Data
6 PDU length xx Header of extended diagnostic data
7 Status type = 0x81 Header of extended diagnostic data
8 Slot = 0 Header of extended diagnostic data
9 Status info = 0 Header of extended diagnostic data
10 - 13 VLT par. 16-92 Warning VLT warning word
Word
14 - 17 VLT par.16-03 Status Word VLT status word

3 18 - 21
22 - 23
VLT par. 16-90 Alarm Word VLT alarm word
VLT par.9-53 Profibus Warn- Communication warning word (Profibus)
ing Word

Enabling diagnosis may cause increased bus traffic. Diagnosis functions are not supported by all
fieldbus types.

[0] * Disable

[1] Trigger on alarms

[2] Trigger alarm/warn.

3.10.3 8-1* Ctrl. Word Settings

Parameters for configuring the option control word profile.

8-10 Control Word Profile


Select the interpretation of the control and status words corresponding to the installed fieldbus. Only the selections valid for the fieldbus installed in
slot A will be visible in the LCP display.
For guidelines in selection of FC profile [0] and PROFIdrive profile [1] please refer to the Serial communication via RS 485 Interface section.
For additional guidelines in the selection of PROFIdrive profile [1], ODVA [5] and CANopen DSP 402 [7], please refer to the Operating Instructions for
the installed fieldbus.

Option: Function:
[0] * FC profile

[1] PROFIdrive profile

[5] ODVA

[7] CANopen DSP 402

[8] MCO

8-13 Configurable Status Word STW


Option: Function:
This parameter enables configuration of bits 12 – 15 in the status word.

[0] No function

[1] * Profile Default Function corresponds to the profile default selected in par. 8-10 Control Profile.

[2] Alarm 68 Only Only set in case of an Alarm 68.

[3] Trip excl Alarm 68 Set in case of a trip, except if the trip is executed by an Alarm 68.

[16] T37 DI status The bit indicates the status of terminal 37.
“0” indicates T37 is low (safe stop)
“1” indicates T37 is high (normal)

8-14 Configurable Control Word CTW


Option: Function:
Selection of control word bit 10 if it is active low or active high

[0] None

[1] * Profile default

128 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[2] CTW Valid, active low

3.10.4 8-3* FC Port Settings

Parameters for configuring the FC Port.

8-30 Protocol
Option:
[0] * FC
Function:
3
[1] FC MC Select the protocol for the FC (standard) port.

[2] Modbus RTU

8-31 Address
Range: Function:
1. N/A* [1. - 126. N/A] Enter the address for the FC (standard) port.
Valid range: 1 - 126.

8-32 FC Port Baud Rate


Option: Function:
[0] 2400 Baud Baud rate selection for the FC (standard) port.

[1] 4800 Baud

[2] * 9600 Baud

[3] 19200 Baud

[4] 38400 Baud

[5] 57600 Baud

[6] 76800 Baud

[7] 115200 Baud

8-35 Minimum Response Delay


Range: Function:
10 ms* [1 - 10000. ms] Specify the minimum delay time between receiving a request and transmitting a response. This is
used for overcoming modem turnaround delays.

8-36 Max Response Delay


Range: Function:
10001. ms* [11. - 10001 ms] Specify the maximum permissible delay time between transmitting a request and receiving a re-
sponse. Exceeding this delay time will cause control word time-out.

8-37 Max Inter-Char Delay


Range: Function:
25.00 ms* [0.00 - 35.00 ms] Specify the maximum permissible time interval between receipt of two bytes. This parameter acti-
vates time-out if transmission is interrupted.
This parameter is active only when par.8-30 Protocol is set to FC MC [1] protocol.

8-40 Telegram selection


Option: Function:
[1] * Standard telegram 1

[101] PPO 1 Enables use of freely configurable telegrams or standard telegrams for the FC port.

[102] PPO 2

[103] PPO 3

[104] PPO 4

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 129


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[105] PPO 5

[106] PPO 6

[107] PPO 7

[108] PPO 8

[200] Custom telegram 1

3 3.10.5 8-5* Digital/Bus

Parameters for configuring the control word Digital/Bus merging.

8-50 Coasting Select


Option: Function:
Select control of the coasting function via the terminals (digital input) and/or via the bus.

[0] Digital input

[1] Bus Activates Start command via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally via one of the
digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of the digital inputs.

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-51 Quick Stop Select


Select control of the Quick Stop function via the terminals (digital input) and/or via the bus.

Option: Function:
[0] Digital input

[1] Bus

[2] Logic AND

[3] * Logic OR

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-52 DC Brake Select


Option: Function:
Select control of the DC brake via the terminals (digital input) and/or via the fieldbus.

[0] Digital input

[1] Bus Activates Start command via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally via one of the
digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of the digital inputs.

130 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-53 Start Select


Option: Function:
Select control of the frequency converter start function via the terminals (digital input) and/or via
the fieldbus. 3
[0] Digital input Activates Start command via a digital input.

[1] Bus Activates Start command via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally via one of the
digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activates Start command via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of the digital inputs.

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-54 Reversing Select


Option: Function:
[0] Digital input Select control of the frequency converter reverse function via the terminals (digital input) and/or
via the fieldbus.

[1] Bus Activates the Reverse command via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates the Reverse command via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally via
one of the digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activates the Reverse command via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of the digital
inputs.

NB!
This parameter is only active when par. 8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-55 Set-up Select


Option: Function:
Select control of the frequency converter set-up selection via the terminals (digital input) and/or via
the fieldbus.

[0] Digital input Activates the set-up selection via a digital input.

[1] Bus Activates the set-up selection via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates the set-up selection via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally via one
of the digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activate the set-up selection via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of the digital
inputs.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 131


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

8-56 Preset Reference Select


Option: Function:

3 Select control of the frequency converter Preset Reference selection via the terminals (digital input)
and/or via the fieldbus.

[0] Digital input Activates Preset Reference selection via a digital input.

[1] Bus Activates Preset Reference selection via the serial communication port or fieldbus option.

[2] Logic AND Activates Preset Reference selection via the fieldbus/serial communication port, AND additionally
via one of the digital inputs.

[3] * Logic OR Activates the Preset Reference selection via the fieldbus/serial communication port OR via one of
the digital inputs.

NB!
This parameter is active only when par.8-01 Control Site is set to [0] Digital and control word.

3.10.6 8-9* Bus Jog

Parameters for configuring the Bus Jog.

8-90 Bus Jog 1 Speed


Range: Function:
100 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Enter the jog speed. This is a fixed jog speed activated via the serial port or fieldbus option.

8-91 Bus Jog 2 Speed


Range: Function:
200 RPM* [0 - par. 4-13 RPM] Enter the jog speed. This is a fixed jog speed activated via the serial port or fieldbus option.

132 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.11 Parameters: Profibus


3.11.1 9-** Profibus

Parameter group for all Profibus-specific parameters.

9-00 Setpoint
Range:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A]
Function:
This parameter receives cyclical reference from a Master Class 2. If the control priority is set to
3
Master Class 2, the reference for the frequency converter is taken from this parameter, whereas the
cyclical reference will be ignored.

9-07 Actual Value


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] This parameter delivers the MAV for a Master Class 2. The parameter is valid if the control priority
is set to Master Class 2.

9-15 PCD Write Configuration


Array [10]

Option: Function:
Select the parameters to be assigned to PCD 3 to 10 of the telegrams. The number of available
PCDs depends on the telegram type. The values in PCD 3 to 10 will then be written to the selected
parameters as data values. Alternatively, specify a standard Profibus telegram in par.9-22 Telegram
Selection.

[0] * None

[302] Minimum Reference

[303] Maximum Reference

[312] Catch up/slow Down Value

[341] Ramp 1 Ramp up Time

[342] Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time

[351] Ramp 2 Ramp up Time

[352] Ramp 2 Ramp down Time

[380] Jog Ramp Time

[381] Quick Stop Ramp Time

[411] Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM]

[412] Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz]

[413] Motor Speed High Limit [RPM]

[414] Motor Speed High Limit [Hz]

[416] Torque Limit Motor Mode

[417] Torque Limit Generator Mode

[590] Digital & Relay Bus Control

[593] Pulse Out #27 Bus Control

[595] Pulse Out #29 Bus Control

[597] Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control

[653] Terminal 42 Output Bus Control

[663] Terminal X30/8 Bus Control

[673] Terminal X45/1 Bus Control

[683] Terminal X45/3 Bus Control

[890] Bus Jog 1 Speed

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 133


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[891] Bus Jog 2 Speed

[1293] Cable Error Length

[1680] Fieldbus CTW 1

[1682] Fieldbus REF 1

[3401] PCD 1 Write to MCO

[3402] PCD 2 Write to MCO

[3403] PCD 3 Write to MCO

3 [3404] PCD 4 Write to MCO

[3405] PCD 5 Write to MCO

[3406] PCD 6 Write to MCO

[3407] PCD 7 Write to MCO

[3408] PCD 8 Write to MCO

[3409] PCD 9 Write to MCO

[3410] PCD 10 Write to MCO

9-16 PCD Read Configuration


Array [10]

Option: Function:
Select the parameters to be assigned to PCD 3 to 10 of the telegrams. The number of available
PCDs depends on the telegram type. PCDs 3 to 10 contain the actual data values of the selected
parameters. For standard Profibus telegrams, see par.9-22 Telegram Selection.

[0] * None

[1472] VLT Alarm Word

[1473] VLT Warning Word

[1474] VLT Ext. Status Word

[1500] Operating Hours

[1501] Running Hours

[1502] kWh Counter

[1600] Control Word

[1601] Reference [Unit]

[1602] Reference %

[1603] Status Word

[1605] Main Actual Value [%]

[1609] Custom Readout

[1610] Power [kW]

[1611] Power [hp]

[1612] Motor Voltage

[1613] Frequency

[1614] Motor Current

[1615] Frequency [%]

[1616] Torque [Nm]

[1617] Speed [RPM]

[1618] Motor Thermal

[1619] KTY sensor temperature

[1620] Motor Angle

[1622] Torque [%]

[1625] Torque [Nm] High

[1630] DC Link Voltage

134 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1632] Brake Energy /s

[1633] Brake Energy /2 min

[1634] Heatsink Temp.

[1635] Inverter Thermal

[1638] SL Controller State

[1639] Control Card Temp.

[1650] External Reference

[1651] Pulse Reference 3


[1652] Feedback [Unit]

[1653] Digi Pot Reference

[1660] Digital Input

[1661] Terminal 53 Switch Setting

[1662] Analog Input 53

[1663] Terminal 54 Switch Setting

[1664] Analog Input 54

[1665] Analog Output 42 [mA]

[1666] Digital Output [bin]

[1667] Freq. Input #29 [Hz]

[1668] Freq. Input #33 [Hz]

[1669] Pulse Output #27 [Hz]

[1670] Pulse Output #29 [Hz]

[1671] Relay Output [bin]

[1672] Counter A

[1673] Counter B

[1674] Prec. Stop Counter

[1675] Analog In X30/11

[1676] Analog In X30/12

[1677] Analog Out X30/8 [mA]

[1678] Analog Out X45/1 [mA]

[1679] Analog Out X45/3 [mA]

[1684] Comm. Option STW

[1685] FC Port CTW 1

[1690] Alarm Word

[1691] Alarm Word 2

[1692] Warning Word

[1693] Warning Word 2

[1694] Ext. Status Word

[3421] PCD 1 Read from MCO

[3422] PCD 2 Read from MCO

[3423] PCD 3 Read from MCO

[3424] PCD 4 Read from MCO

[3425] PCD 5 Read from MCO

[3426] PCD 6 Read from MCO

[3427] PCD 7 Read from MCO

[3428] PCD 8 Read from MCO

[3429] PCD 9 Read from MCO

[3430] PCD 10 Read from MCO

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 135


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[3440] Digital Inputs

[3441] Digital Outputs

[3450] Actual Position

[3451] Commanded Position

[3452] Actual Master Position

[3453] Slave Index Position

[3454] Master Index Position

3 [3455] Curve Position

[3456] Track Error

[3457] Synchronizing Error

[3458] Actual Velocity

[3459] Actual Master Velocity

[3460] Synchronizing Status

[3461] Axis Status

[3462] Program Status

[3464] MCO 302 Status

[3465] MCO 302 Control

[3470] MCO Alarm Word 1

[3471] MCO Alarm Word 2

9-18 Node Address


Range: Function:
126 N/A* [0 - 126. N/A] Enter the station address in this parameter or alternatively in the hardware switch. In order to adjust
the station address in par.9-18 Node Address, the hardware switch must be set to 126 or 127 (i.e.
all switches set to ‘on’). Otherwise this parameter will display the actual setting of the switch.

9-22 Telegram Selection


Displays the Profibus telegram configuration.

Option: Function:
[1] Standard telegram 1

[101] PPO 1

[102] PPO 2

[103] PPO 3

[104] PPO 4

[105] PPO 5

[106] PPO 6

[107] PPO 7

[108] * PPO 8 Read only.

[200] Custom telegram 1

136 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

9-23 Parameters for Signals


Array [1000]
Read only

Option: Function:
This parameter contains a list of signals available for selection in par.9-15 PCD Write Configura-
tion and par.9-16 PCD Read Configuration.

[0] * None

[302] Minimum Reference 3


[303] Maximum Reference

[312] Catch up/slow Down Value

[341] Ramp 1 Ramp up Time

[342] Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time

[351] Ramp 2 Ramp up Time

[352] Ramp 2 Ramp down Time

[380] Jog Ramp Time

[381] Quick Stop Ramp Time

[411] Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM]

[412] Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz]

[413] Motor Speed High Limit [RPM]

[414] Motor Speed High Limit [Hz]

[416] Torque Limit Motor Mode

[417] Torque Limit Generator Mode

[590] Digital & Relay Bus Control

[593] Pulse Out #27 Bus Control

[595] Pulse Out #29 Bus Control

[597] Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control

[653] Terminal 42 Output Bus Control

[663] Terminal X30/8 Bus Control

[673] Terminal X45/1 Bus Control

[683] Terminal X45/3 Bus Control

[890] Bus Jog 1 Speed

[891] Bus Jog 2 Speed

[1293] Cable Error Length

[1472] VLT Alarm Word

[1473] VLT Warning Word

[1474] VLT Ext. Status Word

[1500] Operating Hours

[1501] Running Hours

[1502] kWh Counter

[1600] Control Word

[1601] Reference [Unit]

[1602] Reference %

[1603] Status Word

[1605] Main Actual Value [%]

[1609] Custom Readout

[1610] Power [kW]

[1611] Power [hp]

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 137


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1612] Motor Voltage

[1613] Frequency

[1614] Motor Current

[1615] Frequency [%]

[1616] Torque [Nm]

[1617] Speed [RPM]

[1618] Motor Thermal

3 [1619] KTY sensor temperature

[1620] Motor Angle

[1622] Torque [%]

[1625] Torque [Nm] High

[1630] DC Link Voltage

[1632] Brake Energy /s

[1633] Brake Energy /2 min

[1634] Heatsink Temp.

[1635] Inverter Thermal

[1638] SL Controller State

[1639] Control Card Temp.

[1650] External Reference

[1651] Pulse Reference

[1652] Feedback [Unit]

[1653] Digi Pot Reference

[1660] Digital Input

[1661] Terminal 53 Switch Setting

[1662] Analog Input 53

[1663] Terminal 54 Switch Setting

[1664] Analog Input 54

[1665] Analog Output 42 [mA]

[1666] Digital Output [bin]

[1667] Freq. Input #29 [Hz]

[1668] Freq. Input #33 [Hz]

[1669] Pulse Output #27 [Hz]

[1670] Pulse Output #29 [Hz]

[1671] Relay Output [bin]

[1672] Counter A

[1673] Counter B

[1674] Prec. Stop Counter

[1675] Analog In X30/11

[1676] Analog In X30/12

[1677] Analog Out X30/8 [mA]

[1678] Analog Out X45/1 [mA]

[1679] Analog Out X45/3 [mA]

[1680] Fieldbus CTW 1

[1682] Fieldbus REF 1

[1684] Comm. Option STW

[1685] FC Port CTW 1

[1690] Alarm Word

138 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1691] Alarm Word 2

[1692] Warning Word

[1693] Warning Word 2

[1694] Ext. Status Word

[3401] PCD 1 Write to MCO

[3402] PCD 2 Write to MCO

[3403] PCD 3 Write to MCO

[3404] PCD 4 Write to MCO 3


[3405] PCD 5 Write to MCO

[3406] PCD 6 Write to MCO

[3407] PCD 7 Write to MCO

[3408] PCD 8 Write to MCO

[3409] PCD 9 Write to MCO

[3410] PCD 10 Write to MCO

[3421] PCD 1 Read from MCO

[3422] PCD 2 Read from MCO

[3423] PCD 3 Read from MCO

[3424] PCD 4 Read from MCO

[3425] PCD 5 Read from MCO

[3426] PCD 6 Read from MCO

[3427] PCD 7 Read from MCO

[3428] PCD 8 Read from MCO

[3429] PCD 9 Read from MCO

[3430] PCD 10 Read from MCO

[3440] Digital Inputs

[3441] Digital Outputs

[3450] Actual Position

[3451] Commanded Position

[3452] Actual Master Position

[3453] Slave Index Position

[3454] Master Index Position

[3455] Curve Position

[3456] Track Error

[3457] Synchronizing Error

[3458] Actual Velocity

[3459] Actual Master Velocity

[3460] Synchronizing Status

[3461] Axis Status

[3462] Program Status

[3464] MCO 302 Status

[3465] MCO 302 Control

[3470] MCO Alarm Word 1

[3471] MCO Alarm Word 2

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 139


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

9-27 Parameter Edit


Option: Function:
Parameters can be edited via Profibus, the standard RS485 interface, or the LCP.

[0] Disabled Disables editing via Profibus.

[1] * Enabled Enables editing via Profibus.

9-28 Process Control


3 Option: Function:
Process control (setting of Control Word, speed reference, and process data) is possible via either
Profibus or standard fieldbus but not both simultaneously. Local control is always possible via the
LCP. Control via process control is possible via either terminals or fieldbus depending on the settings
in par.8-50 Coasting Select to par.8-56 Preset Reference Select.

[0] Disable Disables process control via Profibus, and enables process control via standard fieldbus or Profibus
Master class 2.

[1] * Enable cyclic master Enables process control via Profibus Master Class 1, and disables process control via standard field-
bus or Profibus Master class 2.

9-44 Fault Message Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] This parameter displays the number of error events stored in par.9-45 Fault Code and par.
9-47 Fault Number. The maximum buffer capacity is eight error events. The buffer and counter are
set to 0 upon reset or power-up.

9-45 Fault Code


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] This buffer contains the alarm word for all alarms and warnings that have occurred since last reset
or power-up. The maximum buffer capacity is eight error events.

9-47 Fault Number


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] This buffer contains the alarm number (e.g. 2 for live zero error, 4 for mains phase loss) for all
alarms and warnings that have occurred since last reset or power-up. The maximum buffer capacity
is eight error events.

9-52 Fault Situation Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 1000 N/A] This parameter displays the number of error events which have occurred since last reset of power-
up.

9-53 Profibus Warning Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] This parameter displays Profibus communication warnings. Please refer to the Profibus Operating
Instructions for further information.

Read only

140 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Bit: Meaning:
0 Connection with DP-master is not ok
1 Not used
2 FDLNDL (Fieldbus Data link Layer) is not ok
3 Clear data command received
4 Actual value is not updated
5 Baudrate search
6 PROFIBUS ASIC is not transmitting
7 Initializing of PROFIBUS is not ok
8 Frequency converter is tripped
9 Internal CAN error
10
11
12
Wrong configuration data from PLC
Wrong ID sent by PLC
Internal error occured
3
13 Not configured
14 Timeout active
15 Warning 34 active

9-63 Actual Baud Rate


Option: Function:
This parameter displays the actual Profibus baud rate. The Profibus Master automatically sets the
baud rate.

[0] 9,6 kbit/s

[1] 19,2 kbit/s

[2] 93,75 kbit/s

[3] 187,5 kbit/s

[4] 500 kbit/s

[6] 1500 kbit/s

[7] 3000 kbit/s

[8] 6000 kbit/s

[9] 12000 kbit/s

[10] 31,25 kbit/s

[11] 45,45 kbit/s

[255] * No baudrate found

9-64 Device Identification


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] This parameter displays the device identification. Please refer to the Operating Instructions for Pro-
fibus, MG33CXYY for further explanation.

9-65 Profile Number


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] This parameter contains the profile identification. Byte 1 contains the profile number and byte 2 the
version number of the profile.

NB!
This parameter is not visible via LCP.

9-67 Control Word 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] This parameter accepts the Control Word from a Master Class 2 in the same format as PCD 1.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 141


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

9-68 Status Word 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] This parameter delivers the Status Word for a Master Class 2 in the same format as PCD 2.

9-70 Programming Set-up


Option: Function:
Select the set-up to be edited.

3 [0] Factory setup Uses default data. This option can be used as a data source to return the other set-ups to a known
state.

[1] Set-up 1 Edits Set-up 1.

[2] Set-up 2 Edits Set-up 2.

[3] Set-up 3 Edits Set-up 3.

[4] Set-up 4 Edits Set-up 4.

[9] * Active Set-up Follows the active set-up selected in par. 0-10 Active Set-up.

This parameter is unique to LCP and fieldbuses. See also par. 0-11 Programming Set-up.

9-71 Profibus Save Data Values


Option: Function:
Parameter values changed via Profibus are not automatically stored in non-volatile memory. Use
this parameter to activate a function that stores parameter values in the EEPROM non-volatile
memory, so changed parameter values will be retained at power-down.

[0] * Off Deactivates the non-volatile storage function.

[1] Store all setups Stores all parameter values for all set-ups in the non-volatile memory. The selection returns to
Off [0] when all parameter values have been stored.

[2] Store all setups Stores all parameter values for all set-ups in the non-volatile memory. The selection returns to
Off [0] when all parameter values have been stored.

9-72 ProfibusDriveReset
Option: Function:
[0] * No action

[1] Power-on reset Resets frequency converter upon power-up, as for power-cycle.

[3] Comm option reset Resets the Profibus option only, useful after changing certain settings in parameter group 9-**, e.g.
par.9-18 Node Address.
When reset, the frequency converter disappears from the fieldbus, which may cause a communi-
cation error from the master.

9-80 Defined Parameters (1)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the defined frequency converter parameters available for Profi-
bus.

142 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

9-81 Defined Parameters (2)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the defined frequency converter parameters available for Profi-
bus.

9-82 Defined Parameters (3) 3


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the defined frequency converter parameters available for Profi-
bus.

9-83 Defined Parameters (4)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the defined frequency converter parameters available for Profi-
bus.

9-84 Defined Parameters (5)


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the defined frequency converter parameters available for Profi-
bus.

9-90 Changed Parameters (1)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the frequency converter parameters deviating from default set-
ting.

9-91 Changed Parameters (2)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the frequency converter parameters deviating from default set-
ting.

9-92 Changed Parameters (3)


Array [116]
No LCP access
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the frequency converter parameters deviating from default set-
ting.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 143


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

9-94 Changed Parameters (5)


Array [116]
No LCP Address
Read only

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter displays a list of all the frequency converter parameters deviating from default set-
ting.

144 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.12 Parameters: DeviceNet CAN Fieldbus


3.12.1 10-** DeviceNet and CAN Fieldbus

Parameter group for DeviceNet CAN fieldbus parameters.

3.12.2 10-0* Common Settings 3


Parameter group for configuring common settings for CAN fieldbus options.

10-00 CAN Protocol


Option: Function:
[0] CANopen

[1] * DeviceNet View the active CAN protocol.

NB!
The options depend on installed option.

10-01 Baud Rate Select


Select the fieldbus transmission speed. The selection must correspond to the transmission speed of the master and the other fieldbus nodes.

Option: Function:
[16] 10 Kbps

[17] 20 Kbps

[18] 50 Kbps

[19] 100 Kbps

[20] * 125 Kbps

[21] 250 Kbps

[22] 500 Kbps

10-02 MAC ID
Range: Function:
63. N/A* [0 - 63. N/A] Selection of station address. Every station connected to the same network must have an unambig-
uous address.

10-05 Readout Transmit Error Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View the number of CAN control transmission errors since the last power-up.

10-06 Readout Receive Error Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View the number of CAN control receipt errors since the last power-up.

10-07 Readout Bus Off Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View the number of Bus Off events since the last power-up.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 145


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.12.3 10-1* DeviceNet

Parameters specific to the DeviceNet fieldbus.

10-10 Process Data Type Selection


Option: Function:
Select the Instance (telegram) for data transmission. The Instances available are dependent upon
the setting of par. 8-10 Control Profile.

3 When par. 8-10 Control Profile is set to [0] FC profile, par.10-10 Process Data Type Selection options
[0] and [1] are available.
When par. 8-10 Control Profile is set to [5] ODVA, par.10-10 Process Data Type Selection options
[2] and [3] are available.
Instances 100/150 and 101/151 are Danfoss-specific. Instances 20/70 and 21/71 are ODVA-specific
AC Drive profiles.
For guidelines in telegram selection, please refer to the DeviceNet Operating Instructions.
Note that a change to this parameter will be executed immediately.

[0] * INSTANCE 100/150

[1] INSTANCE 101/151

[2] INSTANCE 20/70

[3] INSTANCE 21/71

10-11 Process Data Config Write


Select the process write data for I/O Assembly Instances 101/151. Elements [2] and [3] of this array can be selected. Elements [0] and [1] of the
array are fixed.

Option: Function:
[0] * None

[302] Minimum Reference

[303] Maximum Reference

[312] Catch up/slow Down Value

[341] Ramp 1 Ramp up Time

[342] Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time

[351] Ramp 2 Ramp up Time

[352] Ramp 2 Ramp down Time

[380] Jog Ramp Time

[381] Quick Stop Ramp Time

[411] Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM]

[412] Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz]

[413] Motor Speed High Limit [RPM]

[414] Motor Speed High Limit [Hz]

[416] Torque Limit Motor Mode

[417] Torque Limit Generator Mode

[590] Digital & Relay Bus Control

[593] Pulse Out #27 Bus Control

[595] Pulse Out #29 Bus Control

[597] Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control

[653] Terminal 42 Output Bus Control

[663] Terminal X30/8 Bus Control

[673] Terminal X45/1 Bus Control

[683] Terminal X45/3 Bus Control

[890] Bus Jog 1 Speed

146 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[891] Bus Jog 2 Speed

[1293] Cable Error Length

[1680] Fieldbus CTW 1

[1682] Fieldbus REF 1

[3401] PCD 1 Write to MCO

[3402] PCD 2 Write to MCO

[3403] PCD 3 Write to MCO

[3404] PCD 4 Write to MCO 3


[3405] PCD 5 Write to MCO

[3406] PCD 6 Write to MCO

[3407] PCD 7 Write to MCO

[3408] PCD 8 Write to MCO

[3409] PCD 9 Write to MCO

[3410] PCD 10 Write to MCO

10-12 Process Data Config Read


Select the process read data for I/O Assembly Instances 101/151. Elements [2] and [3] of this array can be selected. Elements [0] and [1] of the array
are fixed.

Option: Function:
[0] * None

[1472] VLT Alarm Word

[1473] VLT Warning Word

[1474] VLT Ext. Status Word

[1500] Operating Hours

[1501] Running Hours

[1502] kWh Counter

[1600] Control Word

[1601] Reference [Unit]

[1602] Reference %

[1603] Status Word

[1605] Main Actual Value [%]

[1609] Custom Readout

[1610] Power [kW]

[1611] Power [hp]

[1612] Motor Voltage

[1613] Frequency

[1614] Motor Current

[1615] Frequency [%]

[1616] Torque [Nm]

[1617] Speed [RPM]

[1618] Motor Thermal

[1619] KTY sensor temperature

[1620] Motor Angle

[1622] Torque [%]

[1625] Torque [Nm] High

[1630] DC Link Voltage

[1632] Brake Energy /s

[1633] Brake Energy /2 min

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 147


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1634] Heatsink Temp.

[1635] Inverter Thermal

[1638] SL Controller State

[1639] Control Card Temp.

[1650] External Reference

[1651] Pulse Reference

[1652] Feedback [Unit]

3 [1653] Digi Pot Reference

[1660] Digital Input

[1661] Terminal 53 Switch Setting

[1662] Analog Input 53

[1663] Terminal 54 Switch Setting

[1664] Analog Input 54

[1665] Analog Output 42 [mA]

[1666] Digital Output [bin]

[1667] Freq. Input #29 [Hz]

[1668] Freq. Input #33 [Hz]

[1669] Pulse Output #27 [Hz]

[1670] Pulse Output #29 [Hz]

[1671] Relay Output [bin]

[1672] Counter A

[1673] Counter B

[1674] Prec. Stop Counter

[1675] Analog In X30/11

[1676] Analog In X30/12

[1677] Analog Out X30/8 [mA]

[1678] Analog Out X45/1 [mA]

[1679] Analog Out X45/3 [mA]

[1684] Comm. Option STW

[1685] FC Port CTW 1

[1690] Alarm Word

[1691] Alarm Word 2

[1692] Warning Word

[1693] Warning Word 2

[1694] Ext. Status Word

[3421] PCD 1 Read from MCO

[3422] PCD 2 Read from MCO

[3423] PCD 3 Read from MCO

[3424] PCD 4 Read from MCO

[3425] PCD 5 Read from MCO

[3426] PCD 6 Read from MCO

[3427] PCD 7 Read from MCO

[3428] PCD 8 Read from MCO

[3429] PCD 9 Read from MCO

[3430] PCD 10 Read from MCO

[3440] Digital Inputs

[3441] Digital Outputs

148 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[3450] Actual Position

[3451] Commanded Position

[3452] Actual Master Position

[3453] Slave Index Position

[3454] Master Index Position

[3455] Curve Position

[3456] Track Error

[3457] Synchronizing Error 3


[3458] Actual Velocity

[3459] Actual Master Velocity

[3460] Synchronizing Status

[3461] Axis Status

[3462] Program Status

[3464] MCO 302 Status

[3465] MCO 302 Control

[3470] MCO Alarm Word 1

[3471] MCO Alarm Word 2

10-13 Warning Parameter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View a DeviceNet-specific Warning word. One bit is assigned to every warning. Please refer to the
DeviceNet Operating Instructions (MG.33.DX.YY) for further information.

Bit: Meaning:
0 Bus not active
1 Explicit connection timeout
2 I/O connection
3 Retry limit reached
4 Actual is not updated
5 CAN bus off
6 I/O send error
7 Initialization error
8 No bus supply
9 Bus off
10 Error passive
11 Error warning
12 Duplicate MAC ID Error
13 RX queue overrun
14 TX queue overrun
15 CAN overrun

10-14 Net Reference


Read only from LCP

Option: Function:
Select the reference source in Instance 21/71 and 20/70.

[0] * Off Enables reference via analog/digital inputs.

[1] On Enables reference via the fieldbus.

10-15 Net Control


Read only from LCP

Option: Function:
Select the control source in Instance 21/71 and 20/70.

[0] * Off Enables control via analog/digital inputs.

[1] On Enable control via the fieldbus.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 149


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.12.4 10-2* COS Filters

Parameters for configuring COS filter settings.

10-20 COS Filter 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] Enter the value for COS Filter 1 to set up the filter mask for the Status Word. When operating in

3 COS (Change-Of-State), this function filters out bits in the Status Word that should not be sent if
they change.

10-21 COS Filter 2


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] Enter the value for COS Filter 2, to set up the filter mask for the Main Actual Value. When operating
in COS (Change-Of-State), this function filters out bits in the Main Actual Value that should not be
sent if they change.

10-22 COS Filter 3


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] Enter the value for COS Filter 3, to set up the filter mask for PCD 3. When operating in COS (Change-
Of-State), this function filters out bits in PCD 3 that should not be sent if they change.

10-23 COS Filter 4


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] Enter the value for COS Filter 4 to set up the filter mask for PCD 4. When operating in COS (Change-
Of-State), this function filters out bits in PCD 4 that should not be sent if they change.

3.12.5 10-3* Parameter Access

Parameter group providing access to indexed parameters and defining programming set-up.

10-30 Array Index


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View array parameters. This parameter is valid only when a DeviceNet fieldbus is installed.

10-31 Store Data Values


Option: Function:
Parameter values changed via DeviceNet are not automatically stored in non-volatile memory. Use
this parameter to activate a function that stores parameter values in the EEPROM non-volatile
memory, so changed parameter values will be retained at power-down.

[0] * Off Deactivates the non-volatile storage function.

[1] Store all setups Stores all parameter values from the active set-up in the non-volatile memory. The selection returns
to Off [0] when all values have been stored.

[2] Store all setups Stores all parameter values for all set-ups in the non-volatile memory. The selection returns to
Off [0] when all parameter values have been stored.

10-32 Devicenet Revision


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the DeviceNet revision number. This parameter is used for EDS file creation.

150 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

10-33 Store Always


Option: Function:
[0] * Off Deactivates non-volatile storage of data.

[1] On Stores parameter data received via DeviceNet in EEPROM non-volatile memory as default.

10-39 Devicenet F Parameters


Array [1000]
No LCP access
3
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] This parameter is used to configure the frequency converter via DeviceNet and build the EDS-file.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 151


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.13 Parameters: Smart Logic Control


3.13.1 13-** Prog. Features

Smart Logic Control (SLC) is essentially a sequence of user defined actions (see par.13-52 SL Controller Action [x]) executed by the SLC when the
associated user defined event (see par.13-51 SL Controller Event [x]) is evaluated as TRUE by the SLC. Events and actions are each numbered and linked
together in pairs (states). This means that when event [0] is fulfilled (attains the value TRUE), action [0] is executed. After this, the conditions of

3 event [1] will be evaluated and if evaluated TRUE, action [1] will be executed and so on. Only one event will be evaluated at any time. If an event is
evaluated as FALSE, nothing happens (in the SLC) during the current scan interval and no other events will be evaluated. This means that when the SLC
starts, it evaluates event [0] (and only event [0]) each scan interval. Only when event [0] is evaluated TRUE, will the SLC execute action [0] and start
evaluating event [1]. It is possible to programme from 1 to 20 events and actions.
When the last event / action has been executed, the sequence starts over again from event [0] / action [0]. The illustration shows an example with three
event / actions:

Starting and stopping the SLC:


Starting and stopping the SLC can be done by selecting .On [1]. or .Off [0]. in par.13-00 SL Controller Mode. The SLC always starts in state 0 (where it
evaluates event [0]). The SLC starts when the Start Event (defined in par.13-01 Start Event) is evaluated as TRUE (provided that On [1] is selected in
par.13-00 SL Controller Mode). The SLC stops when the Stop Event (par.13-02 Stop Event) is TRUE. par.13-03 Reset SLC resets all SLC parameters and
start programming from scratch.

3.13.2 13-0* SLC Settings

Use the SLC settings to activate, deactivate and reset the Smart Logic Control.

13-00 SL Controller Mode


Option: Function:
[0] * Off Disables the Smart Logic Controller.

[1] On Enables the Smart Logic Controller.

13-01 Start Event


Option: Function:
[0] * False Select the boolean (TRUE or FALSE) input to activate Smart Logic Control.
False [0] enters the fixed value - FALSE

[1] True True [1] enters the fixed value - TRUE.

[2] Running Running [2] The motor is running.

152 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[3] In range In range [3] The motor is running within the programmed current and speed ranges set in par.
4-50 Warning Current Low to par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

[4] On reference On reference [4] The motor is running on reference.

[5] Torque limit Torque limit [5] The torque limit, set in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode or par.4-17 Torque Limit
Generator Mode, has been exceeded.

[6] Current limit Current limit [6] The motor current limit, set in par.4-18 Current Limit, has been exceeded.

[7] Out of current range Out of current range [7] The motor current is outside the range set in par.4-18 Current Limit.
3
[8] Below I low Below I low [8] The motor current is lower than set in par.4-50 Warning Current Low.

[9] Above I high Above I high [9] The motor current is higher than set in par.4-51 Warning Current High.

[10] Out of speed range Out of speed range [10] The speed is outside the range set in par.4-52 Warning Speed Low and
par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

[11] Below speed low Below speed low [11] The output speed is lower than the setting in par.4-52 Warning Speed Low.

[12] Above speed high Above speed high [12] The output speed is higher than the setting in par.4-53 Warning Speed
High.

[13] Out of feedb. range Out of feedb. Range [13] The feedback is outside the range set in par.4-56 Warning Feedback
Low and par.4-57 Warning Feedback High.

[14] Below feedb. low Below feedb. Low [14] The feedback is below the limit set in par.4-56 Warning Feedback Low.

[15] Above feedb. high Above feedb. High [15] The feedback is above the limit set in par.4-57 Warning Feedback High.

[16] Thermal warning Thermal warning [16] The thermal warning turns on when the temperature exceeds the limit in the
motor, the frequency converter, the brake resistor or the thermistor.

[17] Mains out of range Mains out of range [17] The mains voltage is outside the specified voltage range.

[18] Reversing Reversing [18] The output is high when the frequency converter is running counter clockwise (the
logical product of the status bits “running” AND “reverse”).

[19] Warning Warning [19] A warning is active.

[20] Alarm (trip) Alarm (trip) [20] A (trip) alarm is active.

[21] Alarm (trip lock) Alarm (trip lock) [21] A (Trip lock) alarm is active.

[22] Comparator 0 Comparator 0 [22] Use the result of comparator 0.

[23] Comparator 1 Comparator 1 [23] Use the result of comparator 1.

[24] Comparator 2 Comparator 2 [24] Use the result of comparator 2.

[25] Comparator 3 Comparator 3 [25] Use the result of comparator 3.

[26] Logic rule 0 Logic rule 0 [26] Use the result of logic rule 0.

[27] Logic rule 1 Logic rule 1 [27] Use the result of logic rule 1.

[28] Logic rule 2 Logic rule 2 [28] Use the result of logic rule 2.

[29] Logic rule 3 Logic rule 3 [29] Use the result of logic rule 3.

[33] Digital input DI18 Digital input DI18 [33] Use the result of digital input 18.

[34] Digital input DI19 Digital input DI19 [34] Use the result of digital input 19.

[35] Digital input DI27 Digital input DI27 [35] Use the result of digital input 27.

[36] Digital input DI29 Digital input DI27 [35] Use the result of digital input 29.

[37] Digital input DI32 Digital input DI32 [37] Use the result of digital input 32.

[38] Digital input DI33 Digital input DI33 [38] Use the result of digital input 33.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 153


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[39] Start command Start command [39] A start command is issued.

[40] Drive stopped Drive stopped [40] A stop command ( Jog, Stop, Qstop, Coast) is issued – and not from the SLC
itself.

[41] Reset Trip Reset Trip [41] A reset is issued

[42] Auto-reset Trip Auto-reset Trip [42] An Auto reset is performed.

[43] Ok key OK key [43] The Ok key is pressed.

3 [44] Reset key Reset key [44] The reset key is pressed.

[45] Left key Left key [45] The left key is pressed.

[46] Right key Right key [46] The right key is pressed.

[47] Up key Up key [47] The up key is pressed.

[48] Down key Down key [48] The down key is pressed.

[50] Comparator 4 Comparator 4 [50] Use the result of comparator 4.

[51] Comparator 5 Comparator 5 [51] Use the result of comparator 5.

[60] Logic rule 4 Logic rule 4 [60] Use the result of logic rule 4.

[61] Logic rule 5 Logic rule 5 [61] Use the result of logic rule 5.

13-02 Stop Event


Select the boolean (TRUE or FALSE) input to activate Smart Logic Control.

Option: Function:
[0] * False For descriptions [0] - [61], see par.13-01 Start Event Start Event

[1] True

[2] Running

[3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

[13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

[22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

154 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[30] SL Time-out 0

[31] SL Time-out 1

[32] SL Time-out 2 3
[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

[38] Digital input DI33

[39] Start command

[40] Drive stopped

[41] Reset Trip

[42] Auto-reset Trip

[43] Ok key

[44] Reset key

[45] Left key

[46] Right key

[47] Up key

[48] Down key

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5

[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

[70] SL Time-out 3 SL Time-out 3 [70] Smart logic controller timer 3 is timed out.

[71] SL Time-out 4 SL Time-out 4 [71] Smart logic controller timer 4 is timed out.

[72] SL Time-out 5 SL Time-out 5 [72] Smart logic controller timer 5 is timed out.

[73] SL Time-out 6 SL- Time-out 6 [73] Smart logic controller timer 6 is timed out.

[74] SL Time-out 7 SL Time-out 7 [74] Smart logic controller timer 7 is timed out.

[75] Start command given

[76] Digital input x30 2

[77] Digital input x30 3

[78] Digital input x30 4

13-03 Reset SLC


Option: Function:
[0] * Do not reset SLC Retains programmed settings in all group 13 parameters (13-*).

[1] Reset SLC Resets all group 13 parameters (13-*) to default settings.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 155


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.13.3 13-1* Comparators

Comparators are used for comparing continuous variables (i.e. output frequency, output current, analog input etc.) to fixed preset values. In addition,
there are digital values that will be compared to fixed time values. See explanation in par. 13-10 Comparator Operand. Comparators are evaluated once
in each scan interval. Use the result (TRUE or FALSE) directly. All parameters in this parameter group are array parameters with index 0 to 5. Select index
0 to programme Comparator 0, select index 1 to programme Comparator 1, and so on.

13-10 Comparator Operand

3
Array [6]

Option: Function:
Choice [1] to [31] are variables which will be compared based on their values. Choice [50] to [186]
are digital values (TRUE/FALSE) where the comparison is based on the amount of time during which
they are set to TRUE or FALSE, respectively. See par. 13-11 Comparator Operator.
Select the variable to be monitored by the comparator.

[0] * DISABLED DISABLED [0] The comparator is disabled.

[1] Reference Reference [1] The resulting remote reference (not local) as a percentage.

[2] Feedback Feedback [2] In the unit [RPM] or [Hz]

[3] Motor speed Motor speed [3] [RPM] or [Hz]

[4] Motor current Motor current [4] [A]

[5] Motor torque Motor torque [5] [Nm]

[6] Motor power Motor power [6] [kW] or [hp]

[7] Motor voltage Motor voltage [7] [V]

[8] DC-link voltage DC-link voltage [8] [V]

[9] Motor thermal Motor thermal [9] Expressed as a percentage.

[10] VLT thermal VLT thermal [10] Expressed as a percentage.

[11] Heat sink temp. Heat sink temp [11] Expressed as a percentage.

[12] Analog input AI53 Analog input AI53 [12] Expressed as a percentage.

[13] Analog input AI54 Analog input AI54 [13] Expressed as a percentage.

[14] Analog input AIFB10 Analog input AIFB10 [14] [V]. AIFB10 is internal 10 V supply.

[15] Analog input AIS24V Analog input AIS24V [15] [V] Analog input AICCT [17] [°]. AIS24V is switch mode power supply:
SMPS 24 V.

[17] Analog input AICCT Analog input AICCT [17] [°]. AICCT is control card temperature.

[18] Pulse input FI29 Pulse input FI29 [18] Expressed as a percentage.

[19] Pulse input FI33 Pulse input FI33 [19] Expressed as a percentage.

[20] Alarm number Alarm number [20] The error number.

[21] Warning number

[22] Analog input x30 11

[23] Analog input x30 12

[30] Counter A Counter A [30] Number of counts

[31] Counter B Counter B [31] Number of counts

[50] FALSE False [50] Enters the fixed value of false in the comparator.

[51] TRUE True [51] Enters the fixed value of true in the comparator.

[52] Control ready Control ready [52] The control board receives supply voltage

156 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[53] Drive ready Drive ready [53] The frequency converter is ready for operation and applies a supply signal on the
control board.

[54] Running Running [54] The motor is running.

[55] Reversing Reversing [55] The output is high when the frequency converter is running counter clockwise (the
logical product of the status bits “running” AND “reverse”)

[56] In range In range [56] The motor is running within the programmed current and speed ranges set in par.
4-50 Warning Current Low to par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

[60] On reference On reference [60] The motor is running on reference.


3
[61] Below reference, low Below reference, low [61] The motor is running below the value given in par.4-54 Warning Refer-
ence Low

[62] Above ref, high Above reference, high [62] The motor is running above the value given in par.4-55 Warning Ref-
erence High

[65] Torque limit Torque limit [65] The torque limit, set in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode or par.4-17 Torque Limit
Generator Mode, has been exceeded.

[66] Current limit Current limit [66] The motor current limit, set in par.4-18 Current Limit, has been exceeded.

[67] Out of current range Out of current range [67] The motor current is outside the range set in par.4-18 Current Limit.

[68] Below I low Below I low [68] The motor current is lower than set in par.4-50 Warning Current Low.

[69] Above I high Above I high [69] The motor current is higher than set in par.4-51 Warning Current High.

[70] Out of speed range Out of speed range [70] The speed is outside the range set in par.4-52 Warning Speed Low and
par.4-53 Warning Speed High.

[71] Below speed low Below speed low [71] The output speed is lower than the setting in par.4-52 Warning Speed Low.

[72] Above speed high Above speed high [72] The output speed is higher than the setting in par.4-53 Warning Speed
High.

[75] Out of feedb. range Out of feedb. Range [75] The feedback is outside the range set in par.4-56 Warning Feedback
Low and par.4-57 Warning Feedback High.

[76] Below feedb. low Below feedb. Low [76] The feedback is below the limit set in par. par.4-56 Warning Feedback
Low.

[77] Above feedb. high Above feedb. High [77] The feedback is above the limit set in par.4-57 Warning Feedback High.

[80] Thermal warning Thermal warning [80] The thermal warning turns on when the temperature exceeds the limit in the
motor, the frequency converter, the brake resistor or thermistor.

[82] Mains out of range Mains out of range [82] The mains voltage is outside the specified voltage range.

[85] Warning Warning [85] A warning is active.

[86] Alarm (trip) Alarm (trip) [86] A (trip) alarm is active.

[87] Alarm (trip lock) Alarm (trip lock) [87] A (Trip lock) alarm is active.

[90] Bus OK Bus OK [90] Active communication (no time-out) via the serial communication port.

[91] Torque limit & stop Torque limit & stop [91] If the frequency converter has received a stop signal and is at the torque
limit, the signal is logic “0”.

[92] Brake fault (IGBT) Brake fault (IGBT) [92] The brake IGBT is short circuited.

[93] Mech. brake control Mech. brake control [93] The mechanical brake is active.

[94] Safe stop active

[100] Comparator 0 Comparator 0 [100] The result of comparator 0.

[101] Comparator 1 Comparator 1 [101] The result of comparator 1.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 157


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[102] Comparator 2 Comparator 2 [102] The result of comparator 2.

[103] Comparator 3 Comparator 3 [103] The result of comparator 3.

[104] Comparator 4 Comparator 4 [104] The result of comparator 4.

[105] Comparator 5 Comparator 5 [105] The result of comparator 5.

[110] Logic rule 0 Logic rule 0 [110] The result of Logic rule 0.

3
[111] Logic rule 1 Logic rule 1 [111] The result of Logic rule 1.

[112] Logic rule 2 Logic rule 2 [112] The result of Logic rule 2.

[113] Logic rule 3 Logic rule 3 [113] The result of Logic rule 3.

[114] Logic rule 4 Logic rule 4 [114] The result of Logic rule 4.

[115] Logic rule 5 Logic rule 5 [115] The result of Logic rule 5.

[120] SL Time-out 0 SL Time-out 0 [120] The result of SLC timer 0.

[121] SL Time-out 1 SL Time-out 1 [121] The result of SLC timer 1.

[122] SL Time-out 2 SL Time-out 2 [122] The result of SLC timer 2.

[123] SL Time-out 3 SL Time-out 3 [123] The result of SLC timer 3.

[124] SL Time-out 4 SL Time-out 4 [124] The result of SLC timer 4.

[125] SL Time-out 5 SL Time-out 5 [125] The result of SLC timer 5.

[126] SL Time-out 6 SL Time-out 6 [126] The result of SLC timer 6.

[127] SL Time-out 7 SL Time-out 7 [127] The result of SLC timer 7.

[130] Digital input DI18 Digital input DI18 [130] Digital input 18. High = True.

[131] Digital input DI19 Digital input DI19 [131] Digital input 19. High = True.

[132] Digital input DI27 Digital input DI27 [132] Digital input 27. High = True.

[133] Digital input DI29 Digital input DI29 [133] Digital input 29. High = True.

[134] Digital input DI32 Digital input DI32 [134] Digital input 32. High = True.

[135] Digital input DI33 Digital input DI33 [135] Digital input 33. High = True.

[150] SL digital output A SL digital output A [150] Use the result of the SLC output A.

[151] SL digital output B SL digital output B [151] Use the result of the SLC output B.

[152] SL digital output C SL digital output C [152] Use the result of the SLC output C.

[153] SL digital output D SL digital output D [153] Use the result of the SLC output D.

[154] SL digital output E SL digital output E [154] Use the result of the SLC output E.

[155] SL digital output F SL digital output F [155] Use the result of the SLC output F.

[160] Relay 1 Relay 1 [160] Relay 1 is active

[161] Relay 2 Relay 2 [161] Relay 2 is active

[180] Local ref. active Local ref. active [180] High when par. 3-13 Reference Site = [2] Local or when par. 3-13 Reference
Site is [0] Linked to hand Auto, at the same time as the LCP is in Hand on mode.

[181] Remote ref. active Remote ref. active [181] High when par. 3-13 Reference Site= [1] Remote or [0] Linked to hand/
auto, while the LCP is in Auto on mode.

[182] Start command Start command [182] High when there is an active start command, and no stop command.

[183] Drive stopped Drive stopped [183] A stop command ( Jog, Stop, Qstop, Coast) is issued – and not from the SLC
itself.

158 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[185] Drive in hand mode Drive in hand mode [185] High when the frequency converter is in hand mode.

[186] Drive in auto mode Drive in auto mode [186] High when the frequency converter is in auto mode.

[187] Start command given

[190] Digital input x30 2

[191] Digital input x30 3

[192] Digital input x30 4

13-11 Comparator Operator 3


Array [6]

Option: Function:
[0] * < Select < [0] for the result of the evaluation to be TRUE, when the variable selected in
par. 13-10 Comparator Operand is smaller than the fixed value in par.13-12 Comparator Value. The
result will be FALSE, if the variable selected in par. 13-10 Comparator Operand is greater than the
fixed value in par.13-12 Comparator Value.

[1] ≈ (equal) Select ≈ [1] for the result of the evaluation to be TRUE, when the variable selected in
par. 13-10 Comparator Operand is approximately equal to the fixed value in par.13-12 Comparator
Value.

[2] > Select > [2] for the inverse logic of option < [0].

13-12 Comparator Value


Array [6]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-100000.000 - 100000.000 N/A] Enter the ‘trigger level’ for the variable that is monitored by this comparator. This is an array pa-
rameter containing comparator values 0 to 5.

3.13.4 13-2* Timers

This parameter group consists of timer parameters.


Use the result (TRUE or FALSE) from timers directly to define an event (see par. 13-51 SL Controller Event), or as boolean input in a logic rule (see
par. 13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1, par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2 or par. 13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3). A timer is only FALSE when started by an action
(i.e. Start timer 1 [29]) until the timer value entered in this parameter is elapsed. Then it becomes TRUE again.
All parameters in this parameter group are array parameters with index 0 to 2. Select index 0 to program Timer 0, select index 1 to program Timer 1,
and so on.

13-20 SL Controller Timer


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 0.000 N/A] Enter the value to define the duration of the FALSE output from the programmed timer. A timer is
only FALSE if it is started by an action (i.e. Start timer 1 [29]) and until the given timer value has
elapsed.

3.13.5 13-4* Logic Rules

Combine up to three boolean inputs (TRUE / FALSE inputs) from timers, comparators, digital inputs, status bits and events using the logical operators
AND, OR, and NOT. Select boolean inputs for the calculation in par. 13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1, par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2 and par. 13-44 Logic
Rule Boolean 3. Define the operators used to logically combine the selected inputs in par.13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1 and par.13-43 Logic Rule Operator
2.

Priority of calculation
The results of par. 13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1, par.13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1 and par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2 are calculated first. The outcome
(TRUE / FALSE) of this calculation is combined with the settings of par.13-43 Logic Rule Operator 2 and par. 13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3, yielding the
final result (TRUE / FALSE) of the logic rule.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 159


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1


Array [6]

Option: Function:
[0] * False Select the first boolean (TRUE or FALSE) input for the selected logic rule.
See par.13-01 Start Event ([0] - [61]) and par.13-02 Stop Event ([70] - [75]) for further description.

[1] True

[2] Running

3 [3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

[13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

[22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[30] SL Time-out 0

[31] SL Time-out 1

[32] SL Time-out 2

[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

[38] Digital input DI33

[39] Start command

[40] Drive stopped

[41] Reset Trip

[42] Auto-reset Trip

160 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[43] Ok key

[44] Reset key

[45] Left key

[46] Right key

[47] Up key

[48] Down key

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5 3
[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

[70] SL Time-out 3

[71] SL Time-out 4

[72] SL Time-out 5

[73] SL Time-out 6

[74] SL Time-out 7

[75] Start command given

[76] Digital input x30 2

[77] Digital input x30 3

[78] Digital input x30 4

13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1


Array [6]

Option: Function:
Select the first logical operator to use on the Boolean inputs from par. 13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1
and par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2.
[13 -XX] signifies the boolean input of par. 13-*.

[0] * DISABLED Ignores par. , par.13-43 Logic Rule Operator 2, and par. 13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3.

[1] AND Evaluates the expression [13-40] AND [13-42].

[2] OR evaluates the expression [13-40] OR[13-42].

[3] AND NOT evaluates the expression [13-40] AND NOT [13-42].

[4] OR NOT evaluates the expression [13-40] OR NOT [13-42].

[5] NOT AND evaluates the expression NOT [13-40] AND [13-42].

[6] NOT OR evaluates the expression NOT [13-40] OR [13-42].

[7] NOT AND NOT evaluates the expression NOT [13-40] AND NOT [13-42].

[8] NOT OR NOT evaluates the expression NOT [13-40] OR NOT [13-42].

13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2


Array [6]

Option: Function:
[0] * False Select the second boolean (TRUE or FALSE) input for the selected logic rule. See par.13-01 Start
Event ([0] - [61]) and par.13-02 Stop Event ([70] - [75]) for further description.

[1] True

[2] Running

[3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 161


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

3 [13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

[22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[30] SL Time-out 0

[31] SL Time-out 1

[32] SL Time-out 2

[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

[38] Digital input DI33

[39] Start command

[40] Drive stopped

[41] Reset Trip

[42] Auto-reset Trip

[43] Ok key

[44] Reset key

[45] Left key

[46] Right key

[47] Up key

[48] Down key

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5

[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

162 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[70] SL Time-out 3

[71] SL Time-out 4

[72] SL Time-out 5

[73] SL Time-out 6

[74] SL Time-out 7

[75] Start command given

[76] Digital input x30 2

[77] Digital input x30 3 3


[78] Digital input x30 4

13-43 Logic Rule Operator 2


Array [6]

Option: Function:
Select the second logical operator to be used on the boolean input calculated in par. 13-40 Logic
Rule Boolean 1, par.13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1, and par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2, and the
boolean input coming from par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2.
[13-44] signifies the boolean input of par. 13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3.
[13-40/13-42] signifies the boolean input calculated in par. 13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1, par.
13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1, and par. 13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2. DISABLED [0] (factory setting).
select this option to ignore par. 13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3.

[0] * DISABLED

[1] AND

[2] OR

[3] AND NOT

[4] OR NOT

[5] NOT AND

[6] NOT OR

[7] NOT AND NOT

[8] NOT OR NOT

13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3


Array [6]

Option: Function:
[0] * False Select the third boolean (TRUE or FALSE) input for the selected logic rule. See par. 13-01 ([0] -
[61]) and par. 13-02 ([70] - [75]) for further description.

[1] True

[2] Running

[3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

[13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 163


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

3 [22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[30] SL Time-out 0

[31] SL Time-out 1

[32] SL Time-out 2

[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

[38] Digital input DI33

[39] Start command

[40] Drive stopped

[41] Reset Trip

[42] Auto-reset Trip

[43] Ok key

[44] Reset key

[45] Left key

[46] Right key

[47] Up key

[48] Down key

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5

[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

[70] SL Time-out 3

[71] SL Time-out 4

[72] SL Time-out 5

[73] SL Time-out 6

[74] SL Time-out 7

[75] Start command given

[76] Digital input x30 2

[77] Digital input x30 3

[78] Digital input x30 4

164 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.13.6 13-5* States

Parameters for programming the Smart Logic Controller.

13-51 SL Controller Event


Array [20]

Option: Function:
[0] * False Select the boolean input (TRUE or FALSE) to define the Smart Logic Controller event.See par. 3
13-01 Start Event ([0] - [61]) and par.13-02 Stop Event ([70] - [74]) for further description.

[1] True

[2] Running

[3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

[13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

[22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[30] SL Time-out 0

[31] SL Time-out 1

[32] SL Time-out 2

[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

[38] Digital input DI33

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 165


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[39] Start command

[40] Drive stopped

[41] Reset Trip

[42] Auto-reset Trip

[43] Ok key

[44] Reset key

[45] Left key

3 [46] Right key

[47] Up key

[48] Down key

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5

[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

[70] SL Time-out 3

[71] SL Time-out 4

[72] SL Time-out 5

[73] SL Time-out 6

[74] SL Time-out 7

[75] Start command given

[76] Digital input x30 2

[77] Digital input x30 3

[78] Digital input x30 4

13-52 SL Controller Action


Array [20]

Option: Function:
[0] * DISABLED Select the action corresponding to the SLC event. Actions are executed when the corresponding
event (defined in par.13-51 SL Controller Event) is evaluated as true. The following actions are
available for selection:

*DISABLED [0]

[1] No action No action [1]

[2] Select set-up 1 Select set-up 1 [2] - changes the active set-up (par. 0-10) to ‘1’.

[3] Select set-up 2 Select set-up 2 [3] - changes the active set-up (par. 0-10) to ‘2’.

[4] Select set-up 3 Select set-up 3 [4] - changes the active set-up (par. 0-10) to ‘3’.

[5] Select set-up 4 Select set-up 4 [5] - changes the active set-up (par. 0-10) to ‘4’. If the set-up is changed, it will
merge with other set-up commands coming from either the digital inputs or via a fieldbus.

[10] Select preset ref 0 Select preset reference 0 [10] – selects preset reference 0.

[11] Select preset ref 1 Select preset reference 1 [11] – selects preset reference 1.

[12] Select preset ref 2 Select preset reference 2 [12] – selects preset reference 2.

[13] Select preset ref 3 Select preset reference 3 [13] – selects preset reference 3.

[14] Select preset ref 4 Select preset reference 4 [14] – selects preset reference 4.

[15] Select preset ref 5 Select preset reference 5 [15] – selects preset reference 5.

[16] Select preset ref 6 Select preset reference 6 [16] – selects preset reference 6.

166 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[17] Select preset ref 7 Select preset reference 7 [17] - selects preset reference 7. If the active preset reference is changed,
it will merge with other preset reference commands coming from either the digital inputs or via a
fieldbus.

[18] Select ramp 1 Select ramp 1 [18] - selects ramp 1.

[19] Select ramp 2 Select ramp 2 [19] - selects ramp 2.

[20] Select ramp 3 Select ramp 3 [20] - selects ramp 3.

[21] Select ramp 4 Select ramp 4 [21] - selects ramp 4.


3
[22] Run Run [22] - issues a start command to the frequency converter.

[23] Run reverse Run reverse [23] - issues a start reverse command to the frequency converter.

[24] Stop Stop [24] - issues a stop command to the frequency converter.

[25] Qstop Qstop [25] - issues a quick stop command to the frequency converter.

[26] Dcstop Dcstop [26] - issues a DC stop command to the frequency converter.

[27] Coast Coast [27] - the frequency converter coasts immediately. All stop commands including the coast
command stop the SLC.

[28] Freeze output Freeze output [28] - freezes the output frequency of the frequency converter.

[29] Start timer 0 Start timer 0 [29] - starts timer 0, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[30] Start timer 1 Start timer 1 [30] - starts timer 1, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[31] Start timer 2 Start timer 2 [31] - starts timer 2, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[32] Set digital out A low Set digital output A low [32] - any output with SL output A will be low.

[33] Set digital out B low Set digital output B low [33] - any output with SL output B will be low.

[34] Set digital out C low Set digital output C low [34] - any output with SL output Cwill be low.

[35] Set digital out D low Set digital output D low [35] - any output with SL output D will be low.

[36] Set digital out E low Set digital output E low [36] - any output with SL output E will be low.

[37] Set digital out F low Set digital output F low [37] - any output with SL output F will be low.

[38] Set digital out A high Set digital output A high [38] - any output with SL output A will be high.

[39] Set digital out B high Set digital output B high [39] - any output with SL output B will be high.

[40] Set digital out C high Set digital output C high [40] - any output with SL output C will be high.

[41] Set digital out D high Set digital output D high [41] - any output with SL output D will be high.

[42] Set digital out E high Set digital output E high [42] - any output with SL output E will be high.

[43] Set digital out F high Set digital output F high [43] - any output with SL output Fwill be high.

[60] Reset Counter A Reset Counter A [60] - resets Counter A to zero.

[61] Reset Counter B Reset Counter B [61] - resets Counter B to zero.

[70] Start timer 3 Start Timer 3 [70] - Start Timer 3, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[71] Start timer 4 Start Timer 4 [71] - Start Timer 4, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[72] Start timer 5 Start Timer 5 [72] - Start Timer 5, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[73] Start timer 6 Start Timer 6 [73] - Start Timer 6, see par. 13-20 for further description.

[74] Start timer 7 Start Timer 7 [74] - Start Timer 7, see par. 13-20 for further description.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 167


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.14 Parameters: Special Functions


3.14.1 14-** Special Functions

Parameter group for configuring special frequency converter functions.

3 3.14.2 Inverter Switching 14-0*

Parameters for configuring the inverter switching.

14-00 Switching Pattern


Option: Function:
[0] 60 AVM Select the switching pattern: 60° AVM or SFAVM.

[1] * SFAVM

NB!
The output frequency value of the frequency converter must never exceed 1/10 of the switching frequency. When the motor is running,
adjust the switching frequency in par.4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM] until the motor is as noiseless as possible. See also par.
14-00 Switching Pattern and the section Special conditions in the FC 300 Design Guide.

NB!
Switching frequencies higher than 5.0 kHz lead to automatic derating of the maximum output of the frequency converter.

14-01 Switching Frequency


Select the inverter switching frequency. Changing the switching frequency can help to reduce acoustic noise from the motor. Default depend on power
size.

Option: Function:
[0] 1.0 kHz

[1] 1.5 kHz

[2] 2.0 kHz

[3] 2.5 kHz

[4] 3.0 kHz

[5] 3.5 kHz

[6] 4.0 kHz

[7] * 5.0 kHz

[8] 6.0 kHz

[9] 7.0 kHz

[10] 8.0 kHz

[11] 10.0 kHz

[12] 12.0 kHz

[13] 14.0 kHz

[14] 16.0 kHz

NB!
The output frequency value of the frequency converter must never exceed 1/10 of the switching frequency. When the motor is running,
adjust the switching frequency in par.4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM] until the motor is as noiseless as possible. See also par.
14-00 Switching Pattern and the section Special conditions in the VLT AutomationDrive Design Guide.

168 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

NB!
Switching frequencies higher than 5.0 kHz lead to automatic derating of the maximum output of the frequency converter.

14-03 Overmodulation
Option: Function:
[0] Off Select On [1] to connect the overmodulation function for the output voltage, to obtain an output
voltage up to 15% greater than the mains voltage. 3
Select Off [0] for no overmodulation of the output voltage, in order to avoid torque ripple on the
motor shaft. This feature may be useful for applications such as grinding machines.

[1] * On

14-04 PWM Random


Option: Function:
[0] * Off No change of the acoustic motor switching noise.

[1] On Transforms the acoustic motor switching noise from a clear ringing tone to a less noticeable ‘white’
noise. This is achieved by slightly and randomly altering the synchronism of the pulse width modu-
lated output phases.

3.14.3 14-1* Mains On/Off

Parameters for configuring mains failure monitoring and handling. If a mains failure appears, the frequency converter will try to continue in a controlled
way until the power in the DC link has been exhausted.

14-10 Mains Failure


Option: Function:
Function: Select the function to which the frequency converter must act when the threshold in par.
14-11 Mains Voltage at Mains Fault has been reached.
par.14-10 Mains Failure cannot be changed while motor is running.

Controlled ramp down:


The frequency converter will perform a controlled ramp down. If par.2-10 Brake Function is Off [0]
or AC brake [2], the ramp will follow the Over Voltage Ramping. If par.2-10 Brake Function is [1]
Resistor Brake the ramp will follow the setting in par.3-81 Quick Stop Ramp Time.

Controlled ramp-down [1]:


After power-up the frequency converter is ready for start. Controlled ramp-down and trip [2]: After
power-up the frequency converter needs a reset for starting.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 169


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

1. The power is back before the energy from DC /moment of inertia from load is too low. The
frequency converter will perform a controlled ramp down when par.14-11 Mains Voltage
at Mains Fault level has been reached.

2. The frequency converter will perform a controlled ramp down as long as energy in the DC
link is present. After this point the motor will be coasted.

Kinetic back-up:
The frequency converter will perform a Kinetic back-up. If par.2-10 Brake Function is Off [0] or AC
brake [2] , the ramp will follow the Over Voltage Ramping. If par.2-10 Brake Function is [1] Resistor
Brake the ramp will follow the setting in par.3-81 Quick Stop Ramp Time.

Kinetic Back-up [4]: The frequency converter will keep on running as long as there is energy in the
system due to the moment of inertia produced by the load.

Kinetic Back-up [5]: The frequency converter will ride through on speed as long as the energy is
present from moment of inertia from the load. If the DC voltage goes below par.14-11 Mains Voltage
at Mains Fault the frequency converter will perform a trip.

[0] * No function

[1] Ctrl. ramp-down

[2] Ctrl. ramp-down, trip

[3] Coasting

[4] Kinetic back-up

170 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[5] Kinetic back-up, trip

[6] Alarm

14-11 Mains Voltage at Mains Fault


Range: Function:
342. V* [180 - 600 V] This parameter defines the threshold voltage at which the selected function in par. 14-10 Mains
Failure should be activated.

14-12 Function at Mains Imbalance 3


Operation under severe main imbalance conditions reduces the lifetime of the motor. Conditions are considered severe if the motor is operated
continuously near nominal load (e.g. a pump or fan running near full speed).

Option: Function:
[0] * Trip Trips the frequency converter

[1] Warning Issues a warning

[2] Disabled No action

3.14.4 14-2* Trip Reset

Parameters for configuring auto reset handling, special trip handling and control card self test or initialisation.

14-20 Reset Mode


Option: Function:
Select the reset function after tripping. Once reset, the frequency converter can be restarted.

[0] * Manual reset Select Manual reset [0], to perform a reset via [RESET] or via the digital inputs.

[1] Automatic reset x 1 Select Automatic reset x 1…x20 [1]-[12] to perform between one and twenty automatic resets after
tripping.

[2] Automatic reset x 2

[3] Automatic reset x 3

[4] Automatic reset x 4

[5] Automatic reset x 5

[6] Automatic reset x 6

[7] Automatic reset x 7

[8] Automatic reset x 8

[9] Automatic reset x 9

[10] Automatic reset x 10

[11] Automatic reset x 15

[12] Automatic reset x 20

[13] Infinite auto reset Select Infinite Automatic Reset [13] for continuous resetting after tripping.

NB!
The motor may start without warning. If the specified number of AUTOMATIC RESETs is reached within 10 minutes, the frequency
converter enters Manual reset [0] mode. After the Manual reset is performed, the setting of par.14-20 Reset Mode reverts to the original
selection. If the number of automatic resets is not reached within 10 minutes, or when a Manual reset is performed, the internal
AUTOMATIC RESET counter returns to zero.

NB!
Automatic reset will also be active for resetting safe stop function in firmware version < 4.3x.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 171


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

NB!
The setting in par.14-20 Reset Mode is disregarded in case of Fire Mode being active (see par. 24-0*, Fire Mode).

14-21 Automatic Restart Time


Range: Function:

3 10 s* [0 - 600 s] Enter the time interval from trip to start of the automatic reset function. This parameter is active
when par.14-20 Reset Mode is set to Automatic reset [1] - [13].

14-22 Operation Mode


Option: Function:
Use this parameter to specify normal operation; to perform tests; or to initialise all parameters
except par.15-03 Power Up's, par.15-04 Over Temp's and par.15-05 Over Volt's. This function is
active only when the power is cycled to the frequency converter.
Select Normal operation [0] for normal operation of the frequency converter with the motor in the
selected application.
Select Control card test [1] to test the analog and digital inputs and outputs and the +10 V control
voltage. The test requires a test connector with internal connections. Use the following procedure
for the control card test:

1. Select Control card test [1].

2. Disconnect the mains supply and wait for the light in the display to go out.

3. Set switches S201 (A53) and S202 (A54) = ‘ON’ / I.

4. Insert the test plug (see below).

5. Connect to mains supply.

6. Carry out various tests.

7. The results are displayed on the LCP and the frequency converter moves into an infinite
loop.

8. par.14-22 Operation Mode is automatically set to Normal operation. Carry out a power
cycle to start up in Normal operation after a control card test.

If the test is OK:


LCP read-out: Control Card OK.
Disconnect the mains supply and remove the test plug. The green LED on the Control Card will light
up.

If the test fails:


LCP read-out: Control Card I/O failure.
Replace the frequency converter or Control card. The red LED on the Control Card is turned on. Test
plugs (connect the following terminals to each other): 18 - 27 - 32; 19 - 29 - 33; 42 - 53 - 54

172 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

Select Initialization [2] to reset all parameter values to default settings, except for par.15-03 Power
Up's, par.15-04 Over Temp's, and par.15-05 Over Volt's. The frequency converter will reset during
the next power-up.
par.14-22 Operation Mode will also revert to the default setting Normal operation [0].

[0] * Normal operation

[1] Control card test

[2] Initialisation

[3] Boot mode

14-24 Trip Delay at Current Limit


Range: Function:
60 s* [0 - 60 s] Enter the current limit trip delay in seconds. When the output current reaches the current limit (par.
4-18 Current Limit), a warning is triggered. When the current limit warning has been continuously
present for the period specified in this parameter, the frequency converter trips. Disable the trip
delay by setting the parameter to 60 s = OFF. Thermal monitoring of the frequency converter will
still remain active.

14-25 Trip Delay at Torque Limit


Range: Function:
60 s* [0 - 60 s] Enter the torque limit trip delay in seconds. When the output torque reaches the torque limits (par.
4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and par.4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode), a warning is triggered.
When the torque limit warning has been continuously present for the period specified in this pa-
rameter, the frequency converter trips. Disable the trip delay by setting the parameter to 60 s =
OFF. Thermal monitoring of the frequency converter will still remain active.

14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault


Range: Function:
0. s* [0 - 35 s] When the frequency converter detects an over-voltage in the set time trip will be effected after the
set time.
If value = 0, protection mode is disabled

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 173


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

NB!
It is recommended to disable protection mode in hoisting applications.

14-29 Service Code


Range: Function:
3 0 N/A* [-2147483647 - 2147483647 N/A] For internal service only.

3.14.5 14-3* Current Limit Control

The frequency converter features an integral Current Limit Controller which is activated when the motor current, and thus the torque, is higher than the
torque limits set in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode and par.4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode.
When the current limit is reached during motor operation or regenerative operation, the frequency converter will try to reduce torque below the preset
torque limits as quickly as possible without losing control of the motor.
While the current control is active, the frequency converter can only be stopped by setting a digital input to Coast inverse [2] or Coast and reset inv. [3].
Any signal on terminals 18 to 33 will not be active until the frequency converter is no longer near the current limit.
By using a digital input set to Coast inverse [2] or Coast and reset inv. [3], the motor does not use the ramp-down time, since the frequency converter
is coasted. If a quick stop is necessary, use the mechanical brake control function along with an external electro-mechanical brake attached to the
application.

14-30 Current Lim Ctrl, Proportional Gain


Range: Function:
100 %* [0 - 500 %] Enter the proportional gain value for the current limit controller. Selection of a high value makes
the controller react faster. Too high a setting leads to controller instability.

14-31 Current Lim Ctrl, Integration Time


Range: Function:
0.020 s* [0.002 - 2.000 s] Controls the current limit control integration time. Setting it to a lower value makes it react faster.
A setting too low leads to control instability.

14-32 Current Lim Ctrl, Filter Time


Range: Function:
1.0 ms* [1.0 - 100.0 ms]

3.14.6 14-35 Stall Protection

14-35 Stall Protection


Option: Function:
Select Enable [1] to enable the stall protection in field-weakening in flux mode. Select Disable [0]
if you desire to disable it. This might cause the motor to be lost. Par 14-35 is active in Flux mode
only.

[0] Disabled

[1] * Enabled

3.14.7 14-4* Energy Optimising

Parameters for adjusting the energy optimisation level in both Variable Torque (VT) and Automatic Energy Optimization (AEO) mode in par.1-03 Torque
Characteristics.

174 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

14-40 VT Level
Range: Function:
66 %* [40 - 90 %] Enter the level of motor magnetisation at low speed. Selection of a low value reduces energy loss
in the motor, but also reduces load capability.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

14-41 AEO Minimum Magnetisation

3
Range: Function:
40. %* [40 - 75 %] Enter the minimum allowable magnetisation for AEO. Selection of a low value reduces energy loss
in the motor, but can also reduce resistance to sudden load changes.

14-42 Minimum AEO Frequency


Range: Function:
10 Hz* [5 - 40 Hz] Enter the minimum frequency at which the Automatic Energy Optimisation (AEO) is to be active.

14-43 Motor Cosphi


Range: Function:
0.66 N/A* [0.40 - 0.95 N/A] The Cos(phi) setpoint is automatically set for optimum AEO performance. This parameter should
normally not be altered. However in some situations it may be necessary to enter a new value to
fine-tune.

3.14.8 14-5* Environment

These parameters help the frequency converter to operate under special environmental conditions.

14-50 RFI Filter


Option: Function:
[0] Off Select Off [0] only if the frequency converter is fed by an isolated mains source, i.e. from a special
IT mains source.
In this mode, the internal RFI filter capacitors between chassis and the mains RFI filter circuit are
cut-out to avoid damage of the intermediate circuit and to reduce the ground capacity currents
according to IEC 61800-3.

[1] * On Select On [1] to ensure that the frequency converter complies with EMC standards.

14-52 Fan Control


Select minimum speed of the main fan.
Select Auto [0] to run fan only when internal temperature in frequency converter is in range 35° C to approx. 55° C.
Fan runs at low speed below 35° C, and at full speed at approx. 55° C.

Option: Function:
[0] * Auto

[1] On 50%

[2] On 75%

[3] On 100%

14-53 Fan Monitor


Option: Function:
Select which reaction the frequency converter should take in case a fan fault is detected.

[0] Disabled

[1] * Warning

[2] Trip

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 175


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

14-55 Output Filter


Option: Function:
Select the type of output filter connected. This parameter cannot be adjusted while motor is running.

[0] * No Filter

[1] Sine-Wave Filter

14-56 Capacitance Output Filter

3 Range:
2.0 uF* [0.1 - 6500.0 uF]
Function:
Set the capacitance of the output filter. The value can be found on the filter label.

NB!
This is required for correct compensation in Flux mode (par.1-01 Motor Control
Principle)

14-57 Inductance Output Filter


Range: Function:
7.000 mH* [0.001 - 65.000 mH] Set the inductance of the output filter. The value can be found on the filter label.

NB!
This is required for correct compensation in Flux mode (par.1-01 Motor Control
Principle)

3.14.9 14-6* Options

14-80 Option Supplied by External 24VDC


Option: Function:
[0] No Select No [0] to use the drive's 24 V DC supply.

[1] * Yes Select Yes [1] if an external 24 V DC supply will be used to power the option. I/O will be galvanically
isolated from the drive when operated from an external supply.

3.14.10 14-7* Compatibility

This parameter is for setting of compatibility for VLT 3000, VLT 5000 to FC 300

14-72 VLT Alarm Word


Option: Function:
[0] 0 - 4294967295 Read out the alarm word corresponding to VLT 3000 or VLT 5000

14-73 VLT Warning Word


Option: Function:
[0] 0 - 4294967295 Read out the warning word corresponding to VLT 3000 or VLT 5000

14-74 VLT Ext. Status Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] Read out the ext. status word corresponding to VLT 3000 or VLT 5000

176 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.15 Parameters: Drive Information


3.15.1 15-** Drive Information

Parameter group containing frequency converter information such as operating data, hardware configuration and software versions.

3.15.2 15-0* Operating Data 3


Parameter group containing operating data e.g. Operating Hours, kWh counters, Power Ups, etc.

15-00 Operating Hours


Range: Function:
0 h* [0 - 2147483647 h] View how many hours the frequency converter has run. The value is saved when the frequency
converter is turned off.

15-01 Running Hours


Range: Function:
0 h* [0 - 2147483647 h] View how many hours the motor has run. Reset the counter in par. 15-07 Reset Running Hours
Counter. The value is saved when the frequency converter is turned off.

15-02 kWh Counter


Range: Function:
0 kWh* [0 - 2147483647 kWh] Registering the power consumption of the motor as a mean value over one hour. Reset the counter
in par.15-06 Reset kWh Counter.

15-03 Power Up's


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 2147483647 N/A] View the number of times the frequency converter has been powered up.

15-04 Over Temp's


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the number of frequency converter temperature faults which have occurred.

15-05 Over Volt's


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the number of frequency converter overvoltages which have occurred.

15-06 Reset kWh Counter


Option: Function:
[0] * Do not reset Select Do not reset [0] if no reset of the kWh counter is desired.

[1] Reset counter Select Reset [1] and press [OK] to reset the kWh counter to zero (see par.15-02 kWh Counter).

NB!
The reset is carried out by pressing [OK].

15-07 Reset Running Hours Counter


Option: Function:
[0] * Do not reset

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 177


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[1] Reset counter Select Reset [1] and press [OK] to reset the Running Hours counter to zero (see par.15-01 Running
Hours). This parameter cannot be selected via the serial port, RS 485.
Select Do not reset [0] if no reset of the Running Hours counter is desired.

3.15.3 15-1* Data Log Settings

The Data Log enables continuous logging of up to 4 data sources (par. 15-10 Logging Source) at individual rates (par.15-11 Logging Interval). A trigger
3 event (par. 15-12 Trigger Event) and window (par. 15-14 Samples Before Trigger) are used to start and stop the logging conditionally.

15-10 Logging Source


Array [4]

Option: Function:
Select which variables are to be logged.

[0] * None

[1472] VLT Alarm Word

[1473] VLT Warning Word

[1474] VLT Ext. Status Word

[1600] Control Word

[1601] Reference [Unit]

[1602] Reference %

[1603] Status Word

[1610] Power [kW]

[1611] Power [hp]

[1612] Motor Voltage

[1613] Frequency

[1614] Motor Current

[1616] Torque [Nm]

[1617] Speed [RPM]

[1618] Motor Thermal

[1622] Torque [%]

[1625] Torque [Nm] High

[1630] DC Link Voltage

[1632] Brake Energy /s

[1633] Brake Energy /2 min

[1634] Heatsink Temp.

[1635] Inverter Thermal

[1650] External Reference

[1651] Pulse Reference

[1652] Feedback [Unit]

[1660] Digital Input

[1662] Analog Input 53

[1664] Analog Input 54

[1665] Analog Output 42 [mA]

[1666] Digital Output [bin]

[1675] Analog In X30/11

[1676] Analog In X30/12

[1677] Analog Out X30/8 [mA]

[1690] Alarm Word

178 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

[1692] Warning Word

[1694] Ext. Status Word

[3470] MCO Alarm Word 1

[3471] MCO Alarm Word 2

15-11 Logging Interval


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 0.000 N/A] Enter the interval in milliseconds between each sampling of the variables to be logged.
3
15-12 Trigger Event
Select the trigger event. When the trigger event occurs, a window is applied to freeze the log. The log will then retain a specified percentage of samples
before the occurrence of the trigger event (par.15-14 Samples Before Trigger).

Option: Function:
[0] * False

[1] True

[2] Running

[3] In range

[4] On reference

[5] Torque limit

[6] Current limit

[7] Out of current range

[8] Below I low

[9] Above I high

[10] Out of speed range

[11] Below speed low

[12] Above speed high

[13] Out of feedb. range

[14] Below feedb. low

[15] Above feedb. high

[16] Thermal warning

[17] Mains out of range

[18] Reversing

[19] Warning

[20] Alarm (trip)

[21] Alarm (trip lock)

[22] Comparator 0

[23] Comparator 1

[24] Comparator 2

[25] Comparator 3

[26] Logic rule 0

[27] Logic rule 1

[28] Logic rule 2

[29] Logic rule 3

[33] Digital input DI18

[34] Digital input DI19

[35] Digital input DI27

[36] Digital input DI29

[37] Digital input DI32

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 179


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

[38] Digital input DI33

[50] Comparator 4

[51] Comparator 5

[60] Logic rule 4

[61] Logic rule 5

15-13 Logging Mode

3 Option:
[0] * Log always
Function:
Select Log always [0] for continuous logging.

[1] Log once on trigger Select Log once on trigger [1] to conditionally start and stop logging using par. 15-12 Trigger
Event and par. 15-14 Samples Before Trigger.

15-14 Samples Before Trigger


Range: Function:
50 N/A* [0 - 100 N/A] Enter the percentage of all samples prior to a trigger event which are to be retained in the log. See
also par.15-12 Trigger Event and par.15-13 Logging Mode.

3.15.4 15-2* Historic Log

View up to 50 logged data items via the array parameters in this parameter group. For all parameters in the group, [0] is the most recent data and [49]
the oldest data. Data is logged every time an event occurs (not to be confused with SLC events). Events in this context are defined as a change in one
of the following areas:

1. Digital input

2. Digital outputs (not monitored in this SW release)

3. Warning word

4. Alarm word

5. Status word

6. Control word

7. Extended status word

Events are logged with value, and time stamp in msec. The time interval between two events depends on how often events occur (maximum once every
scan time). Data logging is continuous but if an alarm occurs, the log is saved and the values can be viewed on the display. This feature is useful, for
example when carrying out service following a trip. View the historic log contained in this parameter via the serial communication port or via the display.

15-20 Historic Log: Event


Array [50]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View the event type of the logged events.

180 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

15-21 Historic Log: Value


Array [50]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 2147483647 N/A] View the value of the logged event. Interpret the event values according to this table:

Digtal input Decimal value. See par.16-60 Digital Input for description
after converting to binary value.
Digital output (not monitored in Decimal value. See par.16-66 Digital Output [bin] for de-

3
this SW release) scription after converting to binary value.
Warning word Decimal value. See par. 16-92 Warning Word for descrip-
tion.
Alarm word Decimal value. See par. 16-90 Alarm Word for description.
Status word Decimal value. See par.16-03 Status Word for description
after converting to binary value.
Control word Decimal value. See par.16-00 Control Word for description.
Extended status word Decimal value. See par.16-94 Ext. Status Word for descrip-
tion.

15-22 Historic Log: Time


Array [50]

Range: Function:
0 ms* [0 - 2147483647 ms] View the time at which the logged event occurred. Time is measured in ms since frequency converter
start. The max. value corresponds to approx. 24 days which means that the count will restart at
zero after this time period.

3.15.5 15-3* Alarm Log

Parameters in this group are array parameters, where up to 10 fault logs can be viewed. [0] is the most recent logged data, and [9] the oldest. Error
codes, values, and time stamp can be viewed for all logged data.

15-30 Fault Log: Error Code


Array [10]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 255 N/A] View the error code and look up its meaning in the Troubleshooting chapter of the FC 300 Design
Guide.

15-31 Alarm Log: Value


Array [10]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-32767 - 32767 N/A] View an extra description of the error. This parameter is mostly used in combination with alarm 38
‘internal fault’.

15-32 Alarm Log: Time


Array [10]

Range: Function:
0 s* [0 - 2147483647 s] View the time when the logged event occurred. Time is measured in seconds from frequency con-
verter start-up.

3.15.6 15-4* Drive Identification

Parameters containing read only information about the hardware and software configuration of the frequency converter.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 181


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

15-40 FC Type
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the FC type. The read-out is identical to the FC 300 Series power field of the type code defi-
nition, characters 1-6.

15-41 Power Section


Range: Function:

3 0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the FC type. The read-out is identical to the FC 300 Series power field of the type code defi-
nition, characters 7-10.

15-42 Voltage
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the FC type. The read-out is identical to the FC 300 Series power field of the type code defi-
nition, characters 11-12.

15-43 Software Version


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the combined SW version (or ‘package version’) consisting of power SW and control SW.

15-44 Ordered Typecode String


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the type code string used for re-ordering the frequency converter in its original configuration.

15-45 Actual Typecode String


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the actual type code string.

15-46 Frequency Converter Ordering No


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the 8-digit ordering number used for re-ordering the frequency converter in its original con-
figuration.

15-47 Power Card Ordering No


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the power card ordering number.

15-48 LCP Id No
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the LCP ID number.

15-49 SW ID Control Card


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the control card software version number.

15-50 SW ID Power Card


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the power card software version number.

15-51 Frequency Converter Serial Number


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the frequency converter serial number.

182 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

15-53 Power Card Serial Number


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the power card serial number.

3.15.7 15-6* Option Ident.

This read-only parameter group contains information about the hardware and software configuration of the options installed in slots A, B C0 and C1.

15-60 Option Mounted


3
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the installed option type.

15-61 Option SW Version


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the installed option software version.

15-62 Option Ordering No


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] Shows the ordering number for the installed options.

15-63 Option Serial No


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 0 N/A] View the installed option serial number.

3.15.8 15-9* Parameter Info

Parameter lists

15-92 Defined Parameters


Array [1000]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] View a list of all defined parameters in the frequency converter. The list ends with 0.

15-93 Modified Parameters


Array [1000]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] View a list of the parameters that have been changed from their default setting. The list ends with
0. Changes may not be visible until up to 30 seconds after implementation.

15-99 Parameter Metadata


Array [30]

Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 9999 N/A] This parameter contains data used by the MCT10 software tool.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 183


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.16 Parameters: Data Read-outs


3.16.1 16-** Data Readouts

Parameter group for data read-outs, e.g. actual references, voltages, control, alarm, warning and status words.

3 3.16.2 16-0* General Status

Parameters for reading the general status, e.g. the calculated reference, the active control word, status.

16-00 Control Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the Control word sent from the frequency converter via the serial communication port in hex
code.

16-01 Reference [Unit]


Range: Function:
0.000 Ref- [-999999.000 - 999999.000 Refer- View the present reference value applied on impulse or analog basis in the unit resulting from the
erenceFeed-enceFeedbackUnit] configuration selected in par. 1-00 Configuration Mode (Hz, Nm or RPM).
backUnit*

16-02 Reference [%]


Range: Function:
0.0 %* [-200.0 - 200.0 %] View the total reference. The total reference is the sum of digital, analog, preset, bus, and freeze
references, plus catch-up and slow-down.

16-03 Status Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the Status word sent from the frequency converter via the serial communication port in hex
code.

16-05 Main Actual Value [%]


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [-100.00 - 100.00 %] View the two-byte word sent with the Status word to the bus Master reporting the Main Actual Value.

16-09 Custom Readout


Range: Function:
0.00 Cus- [0.00 - 0.00 CustomReadoutUnit] View the value of custom readout from par.0-30 Unit for User-defined Readout to par.0-32 Custom
tomReadou- Readout Max Value
tUnit*

3.16.3 16-1* Motor Status

Parameters for reading the motor status values.

16-10 Power [kW]


Range: Function:
0.00 kW* [0.00 - 10000.00 kW] View the motor power in kW. The value shown is calculated on the basis of the actual motor voltage
and motor current. The value is filtered, and therefore approx. 30 ms may pass from when an input
value changes to when the data read-out values change.

184 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

16-11 Power [hp]


Range: Function:
0.00 hp* [0.00 - 10000.00 hp] View the motor power in HP. The value shown is calculated on the basis of the actual motor voltage
and motor current. The value is filtered, and therefore approximately 30 ms may pass from when
an input value changes to when the data read-out values change.

16-12 Motor Voltage

3
Range: Function:
0.0 V* [0.0 - 6000.0 V] View the motor voltage, a calculated value used for controlling the motor.

16-13 Frequency
Range: Function:
0.0 Hz* [0.0 - 6500.0 Hz] View the motor frequency, without resonance dampening.

16-14 Motor Current


Range: Function:
0.00 A* [0.00 - 10000.00 A] View the motor current measured as a mean value, IRMS. The value is filtered, and thus approxi-
mately 30 ms may pass from when an input value changes to when the data read-out values change.

16-15 Frequency [%]


Range: Function:
0.00 %* [-100.00 - 100.00 %] View a two-byte word reporting the actual motor frequency (without resonance dampening) as a
percentage (scale 0000-4000 Hex) of par.4-19 Max Output Frequency. Set par.9-16 PCD Read Con-
figuration index 1 to send it with the Status Word instead of the MAV.

16-16 Torque [Nm]


Range: Function:
0.0 Nm* [-3000.0 - 3000.0 Nm] View the torque value with sign, applied to the motor shaft. Linearity is not exact between 160%
motor current and torque in relation to the rated torque. Some motors supply more than 160%
torque. Consequently, the min. value and the max. value will depend on the max. motor current as
well as the motor used. The value is filtered, and thus approx. 30 ms may pass from when an input
changes value to when the data read-out values change.

16-17 Speed [RPM]


Range: Function:
0 RPM* [-30000 - 30000 RPM] View the actual motor RPM. In open loop or closed loop process control the motor RPM is estimated.
In speed closed loop modes the motor RPM is measured.

16-18 Motor Thermal


Range: Function:
0 %* [0 - 100 %] View the calculated thermal load on the motor. The cut-out limit is 100%. The basis for calculation
is the ETR function selected in par. 1-90 Motor Thermal Protection.

16-19 KTY sensor temperature


Range: Function:
0 C* [0 - 0 C] Returning the actual temperature on KTY sensor buil into the motor.
See par. 1-9*.

16-20 Motor Angle


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the current encoder/resolver angle offset relative to the index position. The value range of
0-65535 corresponds to 0-2*pi (radians).

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 185


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

16-22 Torque [%]


Range: Function:
0 %* [-200 - 200 %] Value shown is the torque in percent of nominal torque, with sign, applied to the motor shaft.

16-25 Torque [Nm] High


Range: Function:
0.0 Nm* [-200000000.0 - 200000000.0 Nm] View the torque value with sign, applied to the motor shaft. Some motors supply more than 160%

3 torque. Consequently, the min. value and the max. value will depend on the max. motor current as
well as the motor used. This specific readout has been adapted to be able to show higher values
than the standard readout in par.16-16 Torque [Nm].

3.16.4 16-3* Drive Status

Parameters for reporting the status of the frequency converter.

16-30 DC Link Voltage


Range: Function:
0 V* [0 - 10000 V] View a measured value. The value is filtered with an 30 ms time constant.

16-32 Brake Energy /s


Range: Function:
0.000 kW* [0.000 - 10000.000 kW] View the brake power transmitted to an external brake resistor, stated as an instantaneous value.

16-33 Brake Energy /2 min


Range: Function:
0.000 kW* [0.000 - 10000.000 kW] View the brake power transmitted to an external brake resistor. The mean power is calculated on
an average basis for the most recent 120 seconds.

16-34 Heatsink Temp.


Range: Function:
0 C* [0 - 255 C] View the frequency converter heatsink temperature. The cut-out limit is 90 ± 5 °C, and the motor
cuts back in at 60 ± 5 °C.

16-35 Inverter Thermal


Range: Function:
0 %* [0 - 100 %] View the percentage load on the inverter.

16-36 Inv. Nom. Current


Range: Function:
10.00 A* [0.01 - 10000.00 A] View the inverter nominal current, which should match the nameplate data on the connected motor.
The data are used for calculation of torque, motor protection, etc.

16-37 Inv. Max. Current


Range: Function:
16.00 A* [0.01 - 10000.00 A] View the inverter maximum current, which should match the nameplate data on the connected
motor. The data are used for calculation of torque, motor protection, etc.

16-38 SL Controller State


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 100 N/A] View the state of the event under execution by the SL controller.

186 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

16-39 Control Card Temp.


Range: Function:
0 C* [0 - 100 C] View the temperature on the control card, stated in °C.

16-40 Logging Buffer Full


Option: Function:
View whether the logging buffer is full (see par. 15-1*). The logging buffer will never be full when

[0] * No
par.15-13 Logging Mode is set to Log always [0].
3
[1] Yes

3.16.5 16-5* Ref. & Feedb.

Parameters for reporting the reference and feedback input.

16-50 External Reference


Range: Function:
0.0 N/A* [-200.0 - 200.0 N/A] View the total reference, the sum of digital, analog, preset, bus and freeze references, plus catch-
up and slow-down.

16-51 Pulse Reference


Range: Function:
0.0 N/A* [-200.0 - 200.0 N/A] View the reference value from programmed digital input(s). The read-out can also reflect the im-
pulses from an incremental encoder.

16-52 Feedback [Unit]


Range: Function:
0.000 Ref- [-999999.999 - 999999.999 Refer- View the feedback unit resulting from the selection of unit and scaling in par.3-00 Reference
erenceFeed-enceFeedbackUnit] Range, par.3-01 Reference/Feedback Unit, par.3-02 Minimum Reference and par.3-03 Maximum
backUnit* Reference.

16-53 Digi Pot Reference


Range: Function:
0.00 N/A* [-200.00 - 200.00 N/A] View the contribution of the Digital Potentiometer to the actual reference.

3.16.6 16-6* Inputs and Outputs

Parameters for reporting the digital and analog IO ports.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 187


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

16-60 Digital Input


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 1023 N/A] View the signal states from the active digital inputs. Example: Input 18 corresponds to bit no. 5, ‘0’
= no signal, ‘1’ = connected signal. Bit 6 works in the opposite way, on = '0', off = '1' (safe stop
input).

Bit 0 Digital input term. 33


Bit 1 Digital input term. 32

3 Bit
Bit
Bit
2
3
4
Digital input term. 29
Digital input term. 27
Digital input term. 19
Bit 5 Digital input term. 18
Bit 6 Digital input term. 37
Bit 7 Digital input GP I/O term. X30/4
Bit 8 Digital input GP I/O term. X30/3
Bit 9 Digital input GP I/O term. X30/2
Bit 10-63 Reserved for future terminals

00000000000000000
DI T-33
DI T-32
DI T-29
DI T-27
DI T-19
DI T-18
DI T-37
DI X30/4
DI X30/3
DI X30/2
DI X46/13
DI X46/11
DI X46/9
DI X46/7
DI X46/5
DI X46/3
DI X46/1

130BA894.10

16-61 Terminal 53 Switch Setting


Option: Function:
View the setting of input terminal 53. Current = 0; Voltage = 1.

[0] * Current

[1] Voltage

[2] Pt 1000 [°C]

[3] Pt 1000 [°F]

[4] Ni 1000 [°C]

[5] Ni 1000 [°F]

16-62 Analog Input 53


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-20.000 - 20.000 N/A] View the actual value at input 53.

188 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

16-63 Terminal 54 Switch Setting


Option: Function:
View the setting of input terminal 54. Current = 0; Voltage = 1.

[0] * Current

[1] Voltage

[2] Pt 1000 [°C]

3
[3] Pt 1000 [°F]

[4] Ni 1000 [°C]

[5] Ni 1000 [°F]

16-64 Analog Input 54


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-20.000 - 20.000 N/A] View the actual value at input 54.

16-65 Analog Output 42 [mA]


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 30.000 N/A] View the actual value at output 42 in mA. The value shown reflects the selection in par.6-50 Terminal
42 Output.

16-66 Digital Output [bin]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 15 N/A] View the binary value of all digital outputs.

16-67 Pulse Input #29 [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 130000 N/A] View the actual frequency rate on terminal 29.

16-68 Freq. Input #33 [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 130000 N/A] View the actual value of the frequency applied at terminal 33 as an impulse input.

16-69 Pulse Output #27 [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 40000 N/A] View the actual value of pulses applied to terminal 27 in digital output mode.

16-70 Pulse Output #29 [Hz]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 40000 N/A] View the actual value of pulses at terminal 29 in digital output mode.
This parameter is available for FC 302 only.

16-71 Relay Output [bin]


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 511 N/A] View the settings of all relays.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 189


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

16-72 Counter A
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-2147483648 - 2147483647 N/A] View the present value of Counter A. Counters are useful as comparator operands, see par.
13-10 Comparator Operand.
The value can be reset or changed either via digital inputs (parameter group 5-1*) or by using an
SLC action (par.13-52 SL Controller Action).

16-73 Counter B
3 Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-2147483648 - 2147483647 N/A] View the present value of Counter B. Counters are useful as comparator operands (par.13-10 Com-
parator Operand).
The value can be reset or changed either via digital inputs (parameter group 5-1*) or by using an
SLC action (par.13-52 SL Controller Action).

16-74 Prec. Stop Counter


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 2147483647 N/A] Returns the actual counter value of precise counter (par.1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value).

16-75 Analog In X30/11


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-20.000 - 20.000 N/A] View the actual value at input X30/11 of MCB 101.

16-76 Analog In X30/12


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [-20.000 - 20.000 N/A] View the actual value at input X30/12 of MCB 101.

16-77 Analog Out X30/8 [mA]


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 30.000 N/A] View the actual value at input X30/8 in mA.

16-78 Analog Out X45/1 [mA]


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 30.000 N/A] View the actual value at output X45/1. The value shown reflects the selection in par. 6-70 Terminal
X45/1 Output.

16-79 Analog Out X45/3 [mA]


Range: Function:
0.000 N/A* [0.000 - 30.000 N/A] View the actual value at output X45/3. The value shown reflects the selection in par. 6-80 Terminal
X45/3 Output.

3.16.7 16-8* Fieldbus & FC Port

Parameters for reporting the BUS references and control words.

16-80 Fieldbus CTW 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the two-byte Control word (CTW) received from the Bus-Master. Interpretation of the Control
word depends on the fieldbus option installed and the Control word profile selected in
par. 8-10 Control Profile.
For more information please refer to the relevant fieldbus manual.

190 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

16-82 Fieldbus REF 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-200 - 200 N/A] View the two-byte word sent with the control word form the Bus-Master to set the reference value.
For more information please refer to the relevant fieldbus manual.

16-84 Comm. Option STW


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the extended fieldbus comm. option status word.
For more information please refer to the relevant fieldbus manual. 3
16-85 FC Port CTW 1
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 65535 N/A] View the two-byte Control word (CTW) received from the Bus-Master. Interpretation of the control
word depends on the fieldbus option installed and the Control word profile selected in
par. 8-10 Control Profile.

16-86 FC Port REF 1


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [-200 - 200 N/A] View the two-byte Status word (STW) sent to the Bus-Master. Interpretation of the Status word
depends on the fieldbus option installed and the Control word profile selected in par. 8-10 Control
Profile.

3.16.8 16-9* Diagnosis Read-Outs

Parameters displaying alarm, warning and extended status words.

16-90 Alarm Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] View the alarm word sent via the serial communication port in hex code.

16-91 Alarm Word 2


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] View the alarm word sent via the serial communication port in hex code.

16-92 Warning Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] View the warning word sent via the serial communication port in hex code.

16-93 Warning Word 2


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] View the warning word sent via the serial communication port in hex code.

16-94 Ext. Status Word


Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0 - 4294967295 N/A] Returns the extended warning word sent via the serial communication port in hex code.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 191


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

3.17 Parameters: Encoder Input


3.17.1 17-** Motor Feedb. Option

Additional parameters to configure the Encoder (MCB102) or the Resolver (MCB103) Feedback Option.

3 3.17.2 17-1* Inc. Enc. Interface

Parameters in this group configure the incremental interface of the MCB102 option. Note that both the incremental and absolute interfaces are active at
the same time.

17-10 Signal Type


Select the incremental type (A/B channel) of the encoder in use. Find the information on the encoder data sheet.
Select None [0] if the feedback sensor is an absolute encoder only.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Option: Function:
[0] None

[1] * RS422 (5V TTL)

[2] Sinusoidal 1Vpp

17-11 Resolution (PPR)


Range: Function:
1024 N/A* [10 - 10000 N/A] Enter the resolution of the incremental track, i.e. the number of pulses or periods per revolution.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

3.17.3 17-2* Abs. Enc. Interface

Parameters in this group configure the absolute interface of the MCB102 option. Note that both the incremental and absolute interfaces are active at the
same time.

17-20 Protocol Selection


Select HIPERFACE [1] if the encoder is absolute only.
Select None [0] if the feedback sensor is an incremental encoder only.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Option: Function:
[0] * None

[1] HIPERFACE

[2] EnDat

[4] SSI

17-21 Resolution (Positions/Rev)


Select the resolution of the absolute encoder, i.e. the number of counts per revolution.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running. The value depends on setting in par.17-20 Protocol Selection.

Range: Function:
8192. N/A* [4. - 131072. N/A]

17-24 SSI Data Length


Range: Function:
13 N/A* [13 - 25 N/A] Set the number of bits for the SSI telegram. Choose 13 bits for single-turn encoders and 25 bits for
multi-turn encoder.

192 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

17-25 Clock Rate


Range: Function:
0 kHz* [100 - 0 kHz] Set the SSI clock rate. With long encoder cables the clock rate must be reduced.

17-26 SSI Data Format


Option: Function:
[0] * Gray code

[1] Binary code Set the data format of the SSI data. Choose between Gray or Binary format.
3
17-34 HIPERFACE Baudrate
Select the baud rate of the attached encoder.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running. The parameter is only accessible when par.17-20 Protocol Selection is set to HIPERFACE
[1].

Option: Function:
[0] 600

[1] 1200

[2] 2400

[3] 4800

[4] * 9600

[5] 19200

[6] 38400

3.17.4 17-5* Resolver Interface

Parameter group 17-5* is used for setting parameters for the MCB 103 Resolver Option.
Usually the resolver feedback is used as motor feedback from Permanent Magnet motors with par.1-01 Motor Control Principle set to Flux with motor
feedback.
Resolver parameters cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

17-50 Poles
Range: Function:
2 N/A* [2 - 2 N/A] Set the number of poles on the resolver.
The value is stated in the data sheet for resolvers.

17-51 Input Voltage


Range: Function:
7.0 V* [2.0 - 8.0 V] Set the input voltage to the resolver. The voltage is stated as RMS value.
The value is stated in the data sheet for resolvers

17-52 Input Frequency


Range: Function:
10.0 kHz* [2.0 - 15.0 kHz] Set the input frequency to the resolver.
The value is stated in the data sheet for resolvers.

17-53 Transformation Ratio


Range: Function:
0.5 N/A* [0.1 - 1.1 N/A] Set the transformation ratio for the resolver.
The transformation ration is:

V Out
T ratio =
V In

The value is stated in the data sheet for resolvers.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 193


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

17-59 Resolver Interface


Activate the MCB 103 resolver option when the resolver parameters are selected.
To avoid damage to resolvers par.17-50 Poles – par.17-53 Transformation Ratio must be adjusted before activating this parameter.

Option: Function:
[0] * Disabled

[1] Enabled

3 3.17.5 17-6* Monitoring and Application

This parameter group is for selecting additional functions when MCB 102 Encoder option or MCB 103 Resolver option is fitted into option slot B as speed
feedback.
Monitoring and Application parameters cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

17-60 Feedback Direction


Change the detected encoder rotation direction without changing the wiring to the encoder.
This parameter cannot be adjusted while the motor is running.

Option: Function:
[0] * Clockwise

[1] Counter clockwise

17-61 Feedback Signal Monitoring


Select which reaction the frequency converter should take in case a faulty encoder signal is detected.
The encoder function in par.17-61 Feedback Signal Monitoring is an electrical check of the hardware circuit in the encoder system.

Option: Function:
[0] Disabled

[1] * Warning

[2] Trip

[3] Jog

[4] Freeze Output

[5] Max Speed

[6] Switch to Open Loop

[7] Select Setup 1

[8] Select Setup 2

[9] Select Setup 3

[10] Select Setup 4

[11] stop & trip

194 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

3.18 Parameters: Data Readouts 2


18-90 Process PID Error
Range: Function:
0.0 %* [-200.0 - 200.0 %]

18-91 Process PID Output


Range: Function: 3
0.0 %* [-200.0 - 200.0 %]

18-92 Process PID Clamped Output


Range: Function:
0.0 %* [-200.0 - 200.0 %]

18-93 Process PID Gain Scaled Output


Range: Function:
0.0 %* [-200.0 - 200.0 %]

3.19 30-** Special Features


3.19.1 Wobble Function

The wobble function is primarily used for synthetic yarn winding applications. The wobble option is to be installed in the frequency converter controlling
the traverse drive. The traverse drive frequency converter will move the yarn back and forth in a diamond pattern across the surface of the yarn package.
To prevent a buildup of yarn at the same points at the surface, this pattern must be altered. The wobble option can accomplish this by continuously
varying the traverse velocity in a programmable cycle. The wobble function is created by superimposing a delta frequency around a center frequency.
To compensate for the inertia in the system a quick frequency jump can be included. Especially suitable for elastic yarn applications the option features
a randomized wobble ratio.

30-00 Wobble Mode


Option: Function:
The standard speed open loop mode in par. 1-00 is extended with a wobble function . In this pa-
rameter it is possible to select which method to be used for the wobbler. The frequency parameters

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 195


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

can be set as absolute values (direct frequencies) or as relative values (percentage of other pa-
rameter) . The wobble cycle time can be set as an absolute alue or as independent up- and down
times. When using an absolute cycle time, the up- and down times are configured through the
wobble ratio.

[0] * Abs. Freq., Abs. Time

[1] Abs. Freq., Up/ Down Time

[2] Rel. Freq., Abs. Time

3 [3] Rel. Freq., Up/ Down Time

This parameter can be set while running.

NB!
The setting of “Center Frequency” takes place via the normal reference handling parameters, 3-1*

30-01 Wobble Delta Frequency [Hz]


Range: Function:
5.0 Hz* [0.0 - 25.0 Hz] The delta frequency is determining the magnitude of the wobble frequency. The delta frequency is
superimposed on the center frequency. Parameter 30-01 is selecting both the positive and negative
delta frequency. The setting of parameter 30-01 must thus not be higher than the setting of the
center frequency. The initial ramp up time from standstill until the wobble sequence is running is
determined by parameters 3-1*.

30-02 Wobble Delta Frequency [%]


Range: Function:
25 %* [0 - 100 %] The delta frequency can also be expressed as percentage of the center frequency and can thus be
maximum 100%. The function is the same as for par. 30-01.

30-03 Wobble Delta Freq. Scaling Resource


Option: Function:
Select which drive input should be used to scale the delta frequency setting.

[0] * No function

[1] Analog input 53

[2] Analog input 54

[3] Frequency input 29 FC 302 only

[4] Frequency input 33

[7] Analog input X30/11

[8] Analog input X30/12

30-04 Wobble Jump Frequency [Hz]


Range: Function:
0.0 Hz* [0.0 - 0.0 Hz] The jump frequency is used to compensate for the inertia in the traverse system. If a jump in the
output frequency is required in the top and in the bottom of the wobble sequence, the frequency
jump is set in this parameter. If the traverse system has a very high inertia a high jump frequency
may create a torque limit warning or trip (warning/alarm 12) or an over voltage warning or trip
(warning/alarm 7). This parameter can only be changed in stop-mode

196 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 3 Parameter descriptions

30-05 Wobble Jump Frequency [%]


Range: Function:
0 %* [0 - 100 %] The jump frequency can also be expressed as percentage of the center frequency. The function is
the same as for par. 30-04.

30-06 Wobble Jump Time


Range: Function:
0.005 s* [0.005 - s] This parameter determines the slope of the jump ramp at the max. and min. wobble frequency.
3
30-07 Wobble Sequence Time
Range: Function:
10.0 s* [1.0 - 1000.0 s] This parameter determines the wobble sequence period. This parameter can only be changed in
stop-mode.
Wobble time = tup + tdown

30-08 Wobble Up/ Down Time


Range: Function:
5.0 s* [0.1 - 1000.0 s] Defines the individual up- and down times for each wobble cycle.

30-09 Wobble Random Function


Option: Function:
[0] * Off

[1] On

30-10 Wobble Ratio


Range: Function:
1.0 N/A* [0.1 - 0.0 N/A] If the ratio 0.1 is selected: tdown is 10 times greater than tup.
If the ratio 10 is selected: tup is 10 times greater than tdown.

30-11 Wobble Random Ratio Max.


Range: Function:
10.0 N/A* [par. 17-53 - 10.0 N/A] Enter the maximum allowed wobble ratio.

30-12 Wobble Random Ratio Min.


Range: Function:
0.1 N/A* [0.1 - par. 30-11 N/A] Enter the minimum allowed wobble ratio.

30-19 Wobble Delta Freq. Scaled


Range: Function:
0.0 Hz* [0.0 - 1000.0 Hz] Readout parameter. View the actual wobble delta frequency after scaling has been applied.

3.19.2 30-8* Compatibility

30-80 d-axis Inductance (Ld)


Range: Function:
0 mH* [0 - 0.000 mH] Enter the value of the d-axis inductance. Obtain the value from the permanent magnet motor data
sheet. The d-axis inductance cannot be found by performing an AMA.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 197


3 Parameter descriptions FC 300 Programming Guide

30-81 Brake Resistor (ohm)


Range: Function:
50.00 [0.01 - 32000.0 Ohm] Set the brake resistor value in Ohms. This value is used for monitoring the power to the brake
Ohm* resistor in par.2-13 Brake Power Monitoring. This parameter is only active in drives with an integral
dynamic brake.

30-83 Speed PID Proportional Gain

3
Range: Function:
0 N/A* [0.0000 - 1.0000 N/A] Enter the speed controller proportional gain. Quick control is obtained at high amplification. However
if amplification is too great, the process may become unstable.

30-84 Process PID Proportional Gain


Range: Function:
0.100 N/A* [0.000 - 10.000 N/A] Enter the process controller proportional gain. Quick control is obtained at high amplification. How-
ever if amplification is too great, the process may become unstable.

198 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 4 Parameter Lists

4 Parameter Lists

4.1 Parameter Lists


FC Series
All = valid for FC 301 and FC 302 series
01 = valid for FC 301 only
02 = valid for FC 302 only

4
Changes during operation
”TRUE” means that the parameter can be changed while the frequency converter is in operation and “FALSE” means that the frequency converter must
be stopped before a change can be made.

4-Set-up
'All set-ups': the parameter can be set individually in each of the four set-ups, i. e. one single parameter can have four different data values.
’1 set-up’: data value will be the same in all set-ups.

Conversion index
This number refers to a conversion figure used when writing or reading by means of a frequency converter.

Conv. index 100 67 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 -1 -2 -3 -4 -5 -6


Conv. factor 1 1/60 1000000 100000 10000 1000 100 10 1 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.0001 0.00001 0.000001

Data type Description Type


2 Integer 8 Int8
3 Integer 16 Int16
4 Integer 32 Int32
5 Unsigned 8 Uint8
6 Unsigned 16 Uint16
7 Unsigned 32 Uint32
9 Visible String VisStr
33 Normalized value 2 bytes N2
35 Bit sequence of 16 boolean variables V2
54 Time difference w/o date TimD

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 199


4
4.1.1 0-** Operation/Display

200
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
0-0* Basic Settings
0-01 Language [0] English 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
0-02 Motor Speed Unit [0] RPM 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
0-03 Regional Settings [0] International 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
0-04 Operating State at Power-up (Hand) [1] Forced stop, ref=old All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-1* Set-up Operations
4 Parameter Lists

0-10 Active Set-up [1] Set-up 1 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8


0-11 Edit Set-up [1] Set-up 1 All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-12 This Set-up Linked to [0] Not linked All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
0-13 Readout: Linked Set-ups 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
0-14 Readout: Edit Set-ups / Channel 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
0-2* LCP Display
0-20 Display Line 1.1 Small 1617 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
0-21 Display Line 1.2 Small 1614 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
0-22 Display Line 1.3 Small 1610 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
0-23 Display Line 2 Large 1613 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
0-24 Display Line 3 Large 1602 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
0-25 My Personal Menu SR 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint16
0-3* LCP Custom Readout
0-30 Unit for User-defined Readout [0] None All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-31 Min Value of User-defined Readout 0.00 CustomReadoutUnit All set-ups TRUE -2 Int32
0-32 Max Value of User-defined Readout 100.00 CustomReadoutUnit All set-ups TRUE -2 Int32
0-4* LCP Keypad
0-40 [Hand on] Key on LCP null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-41 [Off] Key on LCP null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-42 [Auto on] Key on LCP null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-43 [Reset] Key on LCP null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
0-5* Copy/Save
0-50 LCP Copy [0] No copy All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
0-51 Set-up Copy [0] No copy All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
0-6* Password
0-60 Main Menu Password 100 N/A 1 set-up TRUE 0 Int16
0-61 Access to Main Menu w/o Password [0] Full access 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
0-65 Quick Menu Password 200 N/A 1 set-up TRUE 0 Int16
0-66 Access to Quick Menu w/o Password [0] Full access 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
0-67 Bus Password Access 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.2 1-** Load/Motor
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
1-0* General Settings
1-00 Configuration Mode null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-01 Motor Control Principle null All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-02 Flux Motor Feedback Source [1] 24V encoder All set-ups x FALSE - Uint8
1-03 Torque Characteristics [0] Constant torque All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-04 Overload Mode [0] High torque All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-05 Local Mode Configuration [2] As mode par 1-00 All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-1* Motor Selection
1-10 Motor Construction [0] Asynchron All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-2* Motor Data
FC 300 Programming Guide

1-20 Motor Power [kW] SR All set-ups FALSE 1 Uint32


1-21 Motor Power [HP] SR All set-ups FALSE -2 Uint32
1-22 Motor Voltage SR All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
1-23 Motor Frequency SR All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
1-24 Motor Current SR All set-ups FALSE -2 Uint32
1-25 Motor Nominal Speed SR All set-ups FALSE 67 Uint16
1-26 Motor Cont. Rated Torque SR All set-ups FALSE -1 Uint32
1-29 Automatic Motor Adaptation (AMA) [0] Off All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-3* Adv. Motor Data
1-30 Stator Resistance (Rs) SR All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
1-31 Rotor Resistance (Rr) SR All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
1-33 Stator Leakage Reactance (X1) SR All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
1-34 Rotor Leakage Reactance (X2) SR All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
1-35 Main Reactance (Xh) SR All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
1-36 Iron Loss Resistance (Rfe) SR All set-ups FALSE -3 Uint32
1-37 d-axis Inductance (Ld) SR All set-ups x FALSE -4 Int32
1-39 Motor Poles SR All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
1-40 Back EMF at 1000 RPM SR All set-ups x FALSE 0 Uint16
1-41 Motor Angle Offset 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int16
1-5* Load Indep. Setting
1-50 Motor Magnetisation at Zero Speed 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
1-51 Min Speed Normal Magnetising [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
1-52 Min Speed Normal Magnetising [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


1-53 Model Shift Frequency SR All set-ups x FALSE -1 Uint16
1-55 U/f Characteristic - U SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
1-56 U/f Characteristic - F SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

201
4
4
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index

202
1-6* Load Depen. Setting
1-60 Low Speed Load Compensation 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
1-61 High Speed Load Compensation 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
1-62 Slip Compensation SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
1-63 Slip Compensation Time Constant SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
1-64 Resonance Dampening 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
1-65 Resonance Dampening Time Constant 5 ms All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint8
1-66 Min. Current at Low Speed 100 % All set-ups x TRUE 0 Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

1-67 Load Type [0] Passive load All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
1-68 Minimum Inertia SR All set-ups x FALSE -4 Uint32
1-69 Maximum Inertia SR All set-ups x FALSE -4 Uint32
1-7* Start Adjustments
1-71 Start Delay 0.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
1-72 Start Function [2] Coast/delay time All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-73 Flying Start [0] Disabled All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-74 Start Speed [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
1-75 Start Speed [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
1-76 Start Current 0.00 A All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
1-8* Stop Adjustments
1-80 Function at Stop [0] Coast All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-81 Min Speed for Function at Stop [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
1-82 Min Speed for Function at Stop [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
1-83 Precise Stop Function [0] Precise ramp stop All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
1-84 Precise Stop Counter Value 100000 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
1-85 Precise Stop Speed Compensation Delay 10 ms All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint8
1-9* Motor Temperature
1-90 Motor Thermal Protection [0] No protection All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-91 Motor External Fan [0] No All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
1-93 Thermistor Resource [0] None All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
1-95 KTY Sensor Type [0] KTY Sensor 1 All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
1-96 KTY Thermistor Resource [0] None All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
1-97 KTY Threshold level 80 °C 1 set-up x TRUE 100 Int16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.3 2-** Brakes
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
2-0* DC-Brake
2-00 DC Hold Current 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
2-01 DC Brake Current 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
2-02 DC Braking Time 10.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
2-03 DC Brake Cut In Speed [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
2-04 DC Brake Cut In Speed [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
2-1* Brake Energy Funct.
2-10 Brake Function null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
2-11 Brake Resistor (ohm) SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
2-12 Brake Power Limit (kW) SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
2-13 Brake Power Monitoring [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
FC 300 Programming Guide

2-15 Brake Check [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8


2-16 AC brake Max. Current 100.0 % All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint32
2-17 Over-voltage Control [0] Disabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
2–18 Brake Check Condition [0] At Power Up All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
2-2* Mechanical Brake
2-20 Release Brake Current ImaxVLT (P1637) All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
2-21 Activate Brake Speed [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
2-22 Activate Brake Speed [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
2-23 Activate Brake Delay 0.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
2-24 Stop Delay 0.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
2-25 Brake Release Time 0.20 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
2-26 Torque Ref 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
2-27 Torque Ramp Time 0.2 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
2-28 Gain Boost Factor 1.00 N/A All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

203
4
4
4.1.4 3-** Reference / Ramps

204
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
3-0* Reference Limits
3-00 Reference Range null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-01 Reference/Feedback Unit null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-02 Minimum Reference SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
3-03 Maximum Reference SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
3-04 Reference Function [0] Sum All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

3-1* References
3-10 Preset Reference 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
3-11 Jog Speed [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
3-12 Catch up/slow Down Value 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
3-13 Reference Site [0] Linked to Hand / Auto All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-14 Preset Relative Reference 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int32
3-15 Reference Resource 1 null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-16 Reference Resource 2 null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-17 Reference Resource 3 null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-18 Relative Scaling Reference Resource [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-19 Jog Speed [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
3-4* Ramp 1
3-40 Ramp 1 Type [0] Linear All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-41 Ramp 1 Ramp up Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-42 Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-45 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-46 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-47 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-48 Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-5* Ramp 2
3-50 Ramp 2 Type [0] Linear All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-51 Ramp 2 Ramp up Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-52 Ramp 2 Ramp down Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-55 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-56 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-57 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-58 Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
3-6* Ramp 3
3-60 Ramp 3 Type [0] Linear All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-61 Ramp 3 Ramp up Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-62 Ramp 3 Ramp down Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-65 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-66 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-67 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-68 Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-7* Ramp 4
3-70 Ramp 4 Type [0] Linear All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-71 Ramp 4 Ramp up Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-72 Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
FC 300 Programming Guide

3-75 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-76 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Accel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-77 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-78 Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-8* Other Ramps
3-80 Jog Ramp Time SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-81 Quick Stop Ramp Time SR 2 set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-82 Quick Stop Ramp Type [0] Linear All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-83 Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio at Decel. Start 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-84 Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio at Decel. End 50 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
3-9* Digital Pot.Meter
3-90 Step Size 0.10 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
3-91 Ramp Time 1.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
3-92 Power Restore [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
3-93 Maximum Limit 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
3-94 Minimum Limit -100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
3-95 Ramp Delay SR All set-ups TRUE -3 TimD

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

205
4
4
4.1.5 4-** Limits / Warnings

206
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
4-1* Motor Limits
4-10 Motor Speed Direction null All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
4-11 Motor Speed Low Limit [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-12 Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-14 Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

4-16 Torque Limit Motor Mode SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16


4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode 100.0 % All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
4-18 Current Limit SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint32
4-19 Max Output Frequency 132.0 Hz All set-ups FALSE -1 Uint16
4-2* Limit Factors
4-20 Torque Limit Factor Source [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4-21 Speed Limit Factor Source [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4-3* Motor Speed Mon.
4-30 Motor Feedback Loss Function [2] Trip All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4-31 Motor Feedback Speed Error 300 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-32 Motor Feedback Loss Timeout 0.05 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
4-34 Tracking Error Function [0] Disable All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4-35 Tracking Error 10 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-36 Tracking Error Timeout 1.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
4-37 Tracking Error Ramping 100 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-38 Tracking Error Ramping Timeout 1.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
4-39 Tracking Error After Ramping Timeout 5.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
4-5* Adj. Warnings
4-50 Warning Current Low 0.00 A All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
4-51 Warning Current High ImaxVLT (P1637) All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
4-52 Warning Speed Low 0 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-53 Warning Speed High outputSpeedHighLimit (P413) All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-54 Warning Reference Low -999999.999 N/A All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
4-55 Warning Reference High 999999.999 N/A All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
4-56 Warning Feedback Low -999999.999 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
4-57 Warning Feedback High 999999.999 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
4-58 Missing Motor Phase Function null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4-6* Speed Bypass
4-60 Bypass Speed From [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
4-61 Bypass Speed From [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
4-62 Bypass Speed To [RPM] SR All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4-63 Bypass Speed To [Hz] SR All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.6 5-** Digital In/Out
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
5-0* Digital I/O mode
5-00 Digital I/O Mode [0] PNP All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
5-01 Terminal 27 Mode [0] Input All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-02 Terminal 29 Mode [0] Input All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
5-1* Digital Inputs
5-10 Terminal 18 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-11 Terminal 19 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-12 Terminal 27 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-13 Terminal 29 Digital Input null All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
5-14 Terminal 32 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-15 Terminal 33 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
FC 300 Programming Guide

5-16 Terminal X30/2 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-17 Terminal X30/3 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-18 Terminal X30/4 Digital Input null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-19 Terminal 37 Safe Stop [1] Safe Stop Alarm 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
5-20 Terminal X46/1 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-21 Terminal X46/3 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-22 Terminal X46/5 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-23 Terminal X46/7 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-24 Terminal X46/9 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-25 Terminal X46/11 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-26 Terminal X46/13 Digital Input [0] No operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-3* Digital Outputs
5-30 Terminal 27 Digital Output null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-31 Terminal 29 Digital Output null All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
5-32 Term X30/6 Digi Out (MCB 101) null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-33 Term X30/7 Digi Out (MCB 101) null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-4* Relays
5-40 Function Relay null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-41 On Delay, Relay 0.01 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
5-42 Off Delay, Relay 0.01 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

207
4
4
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index

208
5-5* Pulse Input
5-50 Term. 29 Low Frequency 100 Hz All set-ups x TRUE 0 Uint32
5-51 Term. 29 High Frequency 100 Hz All set-ups x TRUE 0 Uint32
5-52 Term. 29 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0.000 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups x TRUE -3 Int32
5-53 Term. 29 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups x TRUE -3 Int32
5-54 Pulse Filter Time Constant #29 100 ms All set-ups x FALSE -3 Uint16
5-55 Term. 33 Low Frequency 100 Hz All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
5-56 Term. 33 High Frequency 100 Hz All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
4 Parameter Lists

5-57 Term. 33 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0.000 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
5-58 Term. 33 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
5-59 Pulse Filter Time Constant #33 100 ms All set-ups FALSE -3 Uint16
5-6* Pulse Output
5-60 Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-62 Pulse Output Max Freq #27 SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
5-63 Terminal 29 Pulse Output Variable null All set-ups x TRUE - Uint8
5-65 Pulse Output Max Freq #29 SR All set-ups x TRUE 0 Uint32
5-66 Terminal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
5-68 Pulse Output Max Freq #X30/6 SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
5-7* 24V Encoder Input
5-70 Term 32/33 Pulses per Revolution 1024 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
5-71 Term 32/33 Encoder Direction [0] Clockwise All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
5-9* Bus Controlled
5-90 Digital & Relay Bus Control 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
5-93 Pulse Out #27 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
5-94 Pulse Out #27 Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16
5-95 Pulse Out #29 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups x TRUE -2 N2
5-96 Pulse Out #29 Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up x TRUE -2 Uint16
5–97 Pulse Out #X30/6 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
5–98 Pulse Out #X30/6 Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.7 6-** Analog In/Out
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
6-0* Analog I/O Mode
6-00 Live Zero Timeout Time 10 s All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
6-01 Live Zero Timeout Function [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
6-1* Analog Input 1
6-10 Terminal 53 Low Voltage 0.07 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-11 Terminal 53 High Voltage 10.00 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current 0.14 mA All set-ups TRUE -5 Int16
6-13 Terminal 53 High Current 20.00 mA All set-ups TRUE -5 Int16
6-14 Terminal 53 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-15 Terminal 53 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-16 Terminal 53 Filter Time Constant 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide

6-2* Analog Input 2


6-20 Terminal 54 Low Voltage 0.07 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-21 Terminal 54 High Voltage 10.00 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-22 Terminal 54 Low Current 0.14 mA All set-ups TRUE -5 Int16
6-23 Terminal 54 High Current 20.00 mA All set-ups TRUE -5 Int16
6-24 Terminal 54 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-25 Terminal 54 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-26 Terminal 54 Filter Time Constant 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
6-3* Analog Input 3
6-30 Terminal X30/11 Low Voltage 0.07 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-31 Terminal X30/11 High Voltage 10.00 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-34 Term. X30/11 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-35 Term. X30/11 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-36 Term. X30/11 Filter Time Constant 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
6-4* Analog Input 4
6-40 Terminal X30/12 Low Voltage 0.07 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-41 Terminal X30/12 High Voltage 10.00 V All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-44 Term. X30/12 Low Ref./Feedb. Value 0 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-45 Term. X30/12 High Ref./Feedb. Value SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
6-46 Term. X30/12 Filter Time Constant 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
6-5* Analog Output 1
6-50 Terminal 42 Output null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


6-51 Terminal 42 Output Min Scale 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-52 Terminal 42 Output Max Scale 100.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-53 Terminal 42 Output Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
6-54 Terminal 42 Output Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16
6-55 Terminal 42 Output Filter [0] Off 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

209
4
4
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index

210
6-6* Analog Output 2
6-60 Terminal X30/8 Output null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
6-61 Terminal X30/8 Min. Scale 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-62 Terminal X30/8 Max. Scale 100.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-63 Terminal X30/8 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
6-64 Terminal X30/8 Output Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16
6-7* Analog Output 3
6-70 Terminal X45/1 Output null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

6-71 Terminal X45/1 Min. Scale 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-72 Terminal X45/1 Max. Scale 100.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-73 Terminal X45/1 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
6-74 Terminal X45/1 Output Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16
6-8* Analog Output 4
6-80 Terminal X45/3 Output null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
6-81 Terminal X45/3 Min. Scale 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-82 Terminal X45/3 Max. Scale 100.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 Int16
6-83 Terminal X45/3 Bus Control 0.00 % All set-ups TRUE -2 N2
6-84 Terminal X45/3 Output Timeout Preset 0.00 % 1 set-up TRUE -2 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.8 7-** Controllers
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
7-0* Speed PID Ctrl.
7-00 Speed PID Feedback Source null All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
7-02 Speed PID Proportional Gain SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
7-03 Speed PID Integral Time SR All set-ups TRUE -4 Uint32
7-04 Speed PID Differentiation Time SR All set-ups TRUE -4 Uint16
7-05 Speed PID Diff. Gain Limit 5.0 N/A All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
7-06 Speed PID Lowpass Filter Time 10.0 ms All set-ups TRUE -4 Uint16
7-07 Speed PID Feedback Gear Ratio 1.0000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -4 Uint32
7-08 Speed PID Feed Forward Factor 0% All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
7-1* Torque PI Ctrl.
7-12 Torque PI Proportional Gain 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide

7-13 Torque PI Integration Time 0.020 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16


7-2* Process Ctrl. Feedb
7-20 Process CL Feedback 1 Resource [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-22 Process CL Feedback 2 Resource [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-3* Process PID Ctrl.
7-30 Process PID Normal/ Inverse Control [0] Normal All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-31 Process PID Anti Windup [1] On All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-32 Process PID Start Speed 0 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
7-33 Process PID Proportional Gain 0.01 N/A All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
7-34 Process PID Integral Time 10000.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
7-35 Process PID Differentiation Time 0.00 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
7-36 Process PID Diff. Gain Limit 5.0 N/A All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
7-38 Process PID Feed Forward Factor 0% All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
7-39 On Reference Bandwidth 5% All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
7-4* Advanced Process PID Ctrl.
7-40 Process PID I-part Reset [0] No All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-41 Process PID Output Neg. Clamp -100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
7-42 Process PID Output Pos. Clamp 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
7-43 Process PID Gain Scale at Min. Ref. 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
7-44 Process PID Gain Scale at Max. Ref. 100 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int16
7-45 Process PID Feed Fwd Resource [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-46 Process PID Feed Fwd Normal/ Inv. Ctrl. [0] Normal All set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


7-49 Process PID Output Normal/ Inv. Ctrl. [0] Normal All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-5* Position PID Ctrl.
7-50 Process PID Extended PID [1] Enabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
7-51 Process PID Feed Fwd Gain 1.00 N/A All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
7-52 Process PID Feed Fwd Ramp up 0.01 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
7-53 Process PID Feed Fwd Ramp down 0.01 s All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
7-56 Process PID Ref. Filter Time 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
7-57 Process PID Fb. Filter Time 0.001 s All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

211
4
4
4.1.9 8-** Comm. and Options

212
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
8-0* General Settings
8-01 Control Site [0] Digital and ctrl.word All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-02 Control Word Source null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-03 Control Word Timeout Time 1.0 s 1 set-up TRUE -1 Uint32
8-04 Control Word Timeout Function null 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
8-05 End-of-Timeout Function [1] Resume set-up 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

8-06 Reset Control Word Timeout [0] Do not reset All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-07 Diagnosis Trigger [0] Disable 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-1* Ctrl. Word Settings
8-10 Control Word Profile [0] FC profile All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-13 Configurable Status Word STW null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-14 Configurable Control Word CTW [1] Profile default All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-3* FC Port Settings
8-30 Protocol [0] FC 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
8-31 Address 1 N/A 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint8
8-32 FC Port Baud Rate null 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
8-33 Parity / Stop Bits [0] Even Parity, 1 Stop Bit 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
8-35 Minimum Response Delay 10 ms All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
8-36 Max Response Delay SR 1 set-up TRUE -3 Uint16
8-37 Max Inter-Char Delay SR 1 set-up TRUE -5 Uint16
8-4* FC MC protocol set
8-40 Telegram selection [1] Standard telegram 1 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-5* Digital/Bus
8-50 Coasting Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-51 Quick Stop Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-52 DC Brake Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-53 Start Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-54 Reversing Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-55 Set-up Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-56 Preset Reference Select [3] Logic OR All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
8-8* FC Port Diagnostics
8-80 Bus Message Count 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
8-81 Bus Error Count 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
8-82 Slave Messages Rcvd 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
8-83 Slave Error Count 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
8-9* Bus Jog
8-90 Bus Jog 1 Speed 100 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


8-91 Bus Jog 2 Speed 200 RPM All set-ups TRUE 67 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.10 9-** Profibus
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
9-00 Setpoint 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
9-07 Actual Value 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-15 PCD Write Configuration SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
9-16 PCD Read Configuration SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
9-18 Node Address 126 N/A 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint8
9-22 Telegram Selection [108] PPO 8 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
9-23 Parameters for Signals 0 All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
9-27 Parameter Edit [1] Enabled 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint16
9-28 Process Control [1] Enable cyclic master 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
9-31 Safe Address 0 N/A 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint16
9-44 Fault Message Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide

9-45 Fault Code 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16


9-47 Fault Number 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
9-52 Fault Situation Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
9-53 Profibus Warning Word 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 V2
9-63 Actual Baud Rate [255] No baudrate found All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
9-64 Device Identification 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
9-65 Profile Number 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[2]
9-67 Control Word 1 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 V2
9-68 Status Word 1 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 V2
9-71 Profibus Save Data Values [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
9-72 ProfibusDriveReset [0] No action 1 set-up FALSE - Uint8
9-80 Defined Parameters (1) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-81 Defined Parameters (2) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-82 Defined Parameters (3) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-83 Defined Parameters (4) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-84 Defined Parameters (5) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-90 Changed Parameters (1) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-91 Changed Parameters (2) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-92 Changed Parameters (3) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-93 Changed parameters (4) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-94 Changed parameters (5) 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
9-99 Profibus Revision Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

213
4
4
4.1.11 10-** CAN Fieldbus

214
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
10-0* Common Settings
10-00 CAN Protocol null 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
10-01 Baud Rate Select null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
10-02 MAC ID SR 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
10-05 Readout Transmit Error Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
10-06 Readout Receive Error Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

10-07 Readout Bus Off Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
10-1* DeviceNet
10-10 Process Data Type Selection null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
10-11 Process Data Config Write SR All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
10-12 Process Data Config Read SR All set-ups TRUE - Uint16
10-13 Warning Parameter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
10-14 Net Reference [0] Off 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
10-15 Net Control [0] Off 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
10-2* COS Filters
10-20 COS Filter 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
10-21 COS Filter 2 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
10-22 COS Filter 3 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
10-23 COS Filter 4 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
10-3* Parameter Access
10-30 Array Index 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
10-31 Store Data Values [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
10-32 Devicenet Revision SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
10-33 Store Always [0] Off 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
10-34 DeviceNet Product Code SR 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint16
10-39 Devicenet F Parameters 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
10-5* CANopen
10-50 Process Data Config Write. SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
10-51 Process Data Config Read. SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.12 12-** Ethernet
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
12-0* IP Settings
12-00 IP Address Assignment [0] MANUAL All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-01 IP Address 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[4]
12-02 Subnet Mask 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[4]
12-03 Default Gateway 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[4]
12-04 DHCP Server 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[4]
12-05 Lease Expires SR All set-ups TRUE 0 TimD
12-06 Name Servers 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 OctStr[4]
12-07 Domain Name 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 VisStr[48]
12-08 Host Name 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 VisStr[48]
12-09 Physical Address 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 VisStr[17]
FC 300 Programming Guide

12-1* Ethernet Link Parameters


12-10 Link Status [0] No Link All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-11 Link Duration SR All set-ups TRUE 0 TimD
12-12 Auto Negotiation [1] On All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-13 Link Speed [0] None All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-14 Link Duplex [1] Full Duplex All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-2* Process Data
12-20 Control Instance SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
12-21 Process Data Config Write SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
12-22 Process Data Config Read SR 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
12-28 Store Data Values [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-29 Store Always [0] Off 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
12-3* EtherNet/IP
12-30 Warning Parameter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-31 Net Reference [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-32 Net Control [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-33 CIP Revision SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-34 CIP Product Code SR 1 set-up TRUE 0 Uint16
12-35 EDS Parameter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
12-37 COS Inhibit Timer 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-38 COS Filter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-8* Other Ethernet Services

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


12-80 FTP Server [0] Disabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-81 HTTP Server [0] Disabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-82 SMTP Service [0] Disabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-89 Transparent Socket Channel Port 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-9* Advanced Ethernet Services
12-90 Cable Diagnostic [0] Disabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-91 MDI-X [1] Enabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-92 IGMP Snooping [1] Enabled All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-93 Cable Error Length 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-94 Broadcast Storm Protection -1 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Int8
12-95 Broadcast Storm Filter [0] Broadcast only All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
12-98 Interface Counters 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
12-99 Media Counters 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

215
4
4
4.1.13 13-** Smart Logic

216
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
13-0* SLC Settings
13-00 SL Controller Mode null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-01 Start Event null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-02 Stop Event null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-03 Reset SLC [0] Do not reset SLC All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-1* Comparators
4 Parameter Lists

13-10 Comparator Operand null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8


13-11 Comparator Operator null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-12 Comparator Value SR 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
13-2* Timers
13-20 SL Controller Timer SR 1 set-up TRUE -3 TimD
13-4* Logic Rules
13-40 Logic Rule Boolean 1 null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-41 Logic Rule Operator 1 null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-42 Logic Rule Boolean 2 null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-43 Logic Rule Operator 2 null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-44 Logic Rule Boolean 3 null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-5* States
13-51 SL Controller Event null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
13-52 SL Controller Action null 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.14 14-** Special Functions
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
14-0* Inverter Switching
14-00 Switching Pattern [1] SFAVM All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-01 Switching Frequency null All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-03 Overmodulation [1] On All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
14-04 PWM Random [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-1* Mains On/Off
14-10 Mains Failure [0] No function All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
14-11 Mains Voltage at Mains Fault SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
14-12 Function at Mains Imbalance [0] Trip All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-2* Trip Reset
FC 300 Programming Guide

14-20 Reset Mode [0] Manual reset All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-21 Automatic Restart Time 10 s All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
14-22 Operation Mode [0] Normal operation All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-23 Typecode Setting null 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
14-24 Trip Delay at Current Limit 60 s All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
14-25 Trip Delay at Torque Limit 60 s All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
14-28 Production Settings [0] No action All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-29 Service Code 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
14-3* Current Limit Ctrl.
14-30 Current Lim Ctrl, Proportional Gain 100 % All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
14-31 Current Lim Ctrl, Integration Time 0.020 s All set-ups FALSE -3 Uint16
14-32 Current Lim Ctrl, Filter Time 1.0 ms All set-ups TRUE -4 Uint16
14-35 Stall Protection [1] Enabled All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
14-4* Energy Optimising
14-40 VT Level 66 % All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
14-41 AEO Minimum Magnetisation SR All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
14-42 Minimum AEO Frequency 10 Hz All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
14-43 Motor Cosphi SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint16
14-5* Environment
14-50 RFI Filter [1] On 1 set-up x FALSE - Uint8
14-52 Fan Control [0] Auto All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
14-53 Fan Monitor [1] Warning All set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


14-55 Output Filter [0] No Filter All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
14-56 Capacitance Output Filter 2.0 uF All set-ups FALSE -7 Uint16
14-57 Inductance Output Filter 7.000 mH All set-ups FALSE -6 Uint16
14-59 Actual Number of Inverter Units SR 1 set-up FALSE 0 Uint8
14-7* Compatibility
14-72 VLT Alarm Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
14-73 VLT Warning Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
14-74 VLT Ext. Status Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
14-8* Options
14-80 Option Supplied by External 24VDC [1] Yes 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

217
4
4
4.1.15 15-** Drive Information

218
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
15-0* Operating Data
15-00 Operating Hours 0h All set-ups FALSE 74 Uint32
15-01 Running Hours 0h All set-ups FALSE 74 Uint32
15-02 kWh Counter 0 kWh All set-ups FALSE 75 Uint32
15-03 Power Up's 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
15-04 Over Temp's 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

15-05 Over Volt's 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16


15-06 Reset kWh Counter [0] Do not reset All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
15-07 Reset Running Hours Counter [0] Do not reset All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
15-1* Data Log Settings
15-10 Logging Source 0 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
15-11 Logging Interval SR 2 set-ups TRUE -3 TimD
15-12 Trigger Event [0] False 1 set-up TRUE - Uint8
15-13 Logging Mode [0] Log always 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
15-14 Samples Before Trigger 50 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
15-2* Historic Log
15-20 Historic Log: Event 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
15-21 Historic Log: Value 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
15-22 Historic Log: Time 0 ms All set-ups FALSE -3 Uint32
15-3* Fault Log
15-30 Fault Log: Error Code 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
15-31 Fault Log: Value 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int16
15-32 Fault Log: Time 0s All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
15-4* Drive Identification
15-40 FC Type 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[6]
15-41 Power Section 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-42 Voltage 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-43 Software Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[5]
15-44 Ordered Typecode String 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[40]
15-45 Actual Typecode String 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[40]
15-46 Frequency Converter Ordering No 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[8]
15-47 Power Card Ordering No 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[8]
15-48 LCP Id No 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-49 SW ID Control Card 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-50 SW ID Power Card 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-51 Frequency Converter Serial Number 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[10]
15-53 Power Card Serial Number 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[19]

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
15-6* Option Ident
15-60 Option Mounted 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[30]
15-61 Option SW Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-62 Option Ordering No 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[8]
15-63 Option Serial No 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[18]
15-70 Option in Slot A 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[30]
15-71 Slot A Option SW Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-72 Option in Slot B 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[30]
15-73 Slot B Option SW Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-74 Option in Slot C0 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[30]
15-75 Slot C0 Option SW Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]
15-76 Option in Slot C1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[30]
FC 300 Programming Guide

15-77 Slot C1 Option SW Version 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[20]


15-9* Parameter Info
15-92 Defined Parameters 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
15-93 Modified Parameters 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
15-98 Drive Identification 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 VisStr[40]
15-99 Parameter Metadata 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

219
4
4
4.1.16 16-** Data Readouts

220
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
16-0* General Status
16-00 Control Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 V2
16-01 Reference [Unit] 0.000 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-02 Reference % 0.0 % All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
16-03 Status Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 V2
16-05 Main Actual Value [%] 0.00 % All set-ups FALSE -2 N2
4 Parameter Lists

16-09 Custom Readout 0.00 CustomReadoutUnit All set-ups FALSE -2 Int32


16-1* Motor Status
16-10 Power [kW] 0.00 kW All set-ups FALSE 1 Int32
16-11 Power [hp] 0.00 hp All set-ups FALSE -2 Int32
16-12 Motor Voltage 0.0 V All set-ups FALSE -1 Uint16
16-13 Frequency 0.0 Hz All set-ups FALSE -1 Uint16
16-14 Motor Current 0.00 A All set-ups FALSE -2 Int32
16-15 Frequency [%] 0.00 % All set-ups FALSE -2 N2
16-16 Torque [Nm] 0.0 Nm All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
16-17 Speed [RPM] 0 RPM All set-ups FALSE 67 Int32
16-18 Motor Thermal 0% All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
16-19 KTY sensor temperature 0 °C All set-ups FALSE 100 Int16
16-20 Motor Angle 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
16-22 Torque [%] 0% All set-ups FALSE 0 Int16
16-25 Torque [Nm] High 0.0 Nm All set-ups FALSE -1 Int32
16-3* Drive Status
16-30 DC Link Voltage 0V All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
16-32 Brake Energy /s 0.000 kW All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-33 Brake Energy /2 min 0.000 kW All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-34 Heatsink Temp. 0 °C All set-ups FALSE 100 Uint8
16-35 Inverter Thermal 0% All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
16-36 Inv. Nom. Current SR All set-ups FALSE -2 Uint32
16-37 Inv. Max. Current SR All set-ups FALSE -2 Uint32
16-38 SL Controller State 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8
16-39 Control Card Temp. 0 °C All set-ups FALSE 100 Uint8
16-40 Logging Buffer Full [0] No All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
16-5* Ref. & Feedb.
16-50 External Reference 0.0 N/A All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
16-51 Pulse Reference 0.0 N/A All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
16-52 Feedback [Unit] 0.000 ReferenceFeedbackUnit All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-53 Digi Pot Reference 0.00 N/A All set-ups FALSE -2 Int16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
16-6* Inputs & Outputs
16-60 Digital Input 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
16-61 Terminal 53 Switch Setting [0] Current All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
16-62 Analog Input 53 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-63 Terminal 54 Switch Setting [0] Current All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
16-64 Analog Input 54 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-65 Analog Output 42 [mA] 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int16
16-66 Digital Output [bin] 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int16
16-67 Freq. Input #29 [Hz] 0 N/A All set-ups x FALSE 0 Int32
16-68 Freq. Input #33 [Hz] 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int32
16-69 Pulse Output #27 [Hz] 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int32
16-70 Pulse Output #29 [Hz] 0 N/A All set-ups x FALSE 0 Int32
FC 300 Programming Guide

16-71 Relay Output [bin] 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Int16


16-72 Counter A 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
16-73 Counter B 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
16-74 Prec. Stop Counter 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
16-75 Analog In X30/11 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-76 Analog In X30/12 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int32
16-77 Analog Out X30/8 [mA] 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int16
16-78 Analog Out X45/1 [mA] 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int16
16-79 Analog Out X45/3 [mA] 0.000 N/A All set-ups FALSE -3 Int16
16-8* Fieldbus & FC Port
16-80 Fieldbus CTW 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 V2
16-82 Fieldbus REF 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 N2
16-84 Comm. Option STW 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 V2
16-85 FC Port CTW 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 V2
16-86 FC Port REF 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 N2
16-9* Diagnosis Readouts
16-90 Alarm Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-91 Alarm Word 2 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-92 Warning Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-93 Warning Word 2 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
16-94 Ext. Status Word 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

221
4
4
4.1.17 17-** Motor Feedb.Option

222
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
17-1* Inc. Enc. Interface
17-10 Signal Type [1] RS422 (5V TTL) All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-11 Resolution (PPR) 1024 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint16
17-2* Abs. Enc. Interface
17-20 Protocol Selection [0] None All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-21 Resolution (Positions/Rev) SR All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
4 Parameter Lists

17-24 SSI Data Length 13 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint8


17-25 Clock Rate SR All set-ups FALSE 3 Uint16
17-26 SSI Data Format [0] Gray code All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-34 HIPERFACE Baudrate [4] 9600 All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-5* Resolver Interface
17-50 Poles 2 N/A 1 set-up FALSE 0 Uint8
17-51 Input Voltage 7.0 V 1 set-up FALSE -1 Uint8
17-52 Input Frequency 10.0 kHz 1 set-up FALSE 2 Uint8
17-53 Transformation Ratio 0.5 N/A 1 set-up FALSE -1 Uint8
17-59 Resolver Interface [0] Disabled All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-6* Monitoring and App.
17-60 Feedback Direction [0] Clockwise All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
17-61 Feedback Signal Monitoring [1] Warning All set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.18 18-** Data Readouts 2
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
18-90 PID Readouts
18-90 Process PID Error 0.0 % All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
18-91 Process PID Output 0.0 % All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
18-92 Process PID Clamped Output 0.0 % All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
18-93 Process PID Gain Scaled Output 0.0 % All set-ups FALSE -1 Int16
FC 300 Programming Guide

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

223
4
4
4.1.19 30-** Special Features

224
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
30-0* Wobbler
30-00 Wobble Mode [0] Abs. Freq., Abs. Time All set-ups FALSE - Uint8
30-01 Wobble Delta Frequency [Hz] 5.0 Hz All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
30-02 Wobble Delta Frequency [%] 25 % All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
30-03 Wobble Delta Freq. Scaling Resource [0] No function All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
30-04 Wobble Jump Frequency [Hz] 0.0 Hz All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

30-05 Wobble Jump Frequency [%] 0% All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8


30-06 Wobble Jump Time SR All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
30-07 Wobble Sequence Time 10.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
30-08 Wobble Up/ Down Time 5.0 s All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint16
30-09 Wobble Random Function [0] Off All set-ups TRUE - Uint8
30-10 Wobble Ratio 1.0 N/A All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
30-11 Wobble Random Ratio Max. 10.0 N/A All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
30-12 Wobble Random Ratio Min. 0.1 N/A All set-ups TRUE -1 Uint8
30-19 Wobble Delta Freq. Scaled 0.0 Hz All set-ups FALSE -1 Uint16
30-8* Compatibility (I)
30-80 d-axis Inductance (Ld) SR All set-ups FALSE -6 Int32
30-81 Brake Resistor (ohm) SR All set-ups TRUE -2 Uint32
30-83 Speed PID Proportional Gain SR All set-ups TRUE -4 Uint32
30-84 Process PID Proportional Gain 0.100 N/A All set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide
4.1.20 32-** MCO Basic Settings
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
32-0* Encoder 2
32-00 Incremental Signal Type [1] RS422 (5V TTL) 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-01 Incremental Resolution 1024 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-02 Absolute Protocol [0] None 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-03 Absolute Resolution 8192 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-05 Absolute Encoder Data Length 25 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
32-06 Absolute Encoder Clock Frequency 262.000 kHz 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-07 Absolute Encoder Clock Generation [1] On 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-08 Absolute Encoder Cable Length 0m 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
32-09 Encoder Monitoring [0] Off 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-10 Rotational Direction [1] No action 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
FC 300 Programming Guide

32-11 User Unit Denominator 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32


32-12 User Unit Numerator 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-3* Encoder 1
32-30 Incremental Signal Type [1] RS422 (5V TTL) 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-31 Incremental Resolution 1024 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-32 Absolute Protocol [0] None 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-33 Absolute Resolution 8192 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-35 Absolute Encoder Data Length 25 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
32-36 Absolute Encoder Clock Frequency 262.000 kHz 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-37 Absolute Encoder Clock Generation [1] On 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-38 Absolute Encoder Cable Length 0m 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
32-39 Encoder Monitoring [0] Off 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-40 Encoder Termination [1] On 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-5* Feedback Source
32-50 Source Slave [2] Encoder 2 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-51 MCO 302 Last Will [1] Trip 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-6* PID Controller
32-60 Proportional factor 30 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-61 Derivative factor 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-62 Integral factor 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-63 Limit Value for Integral Sum 1000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
32-64 PID Bandwidth 1000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


32-65 Velocity Feed-Forward 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-66 Acceleration Feed-Forward 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-67 Max. Tolerated Position Error 20000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-68 Reverse Behavior for Slave [0] Reversing allowed 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-69 Sampling Time for PID Control 1 ms 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Uint16
32-70 Scan Time for Profile Generator 1 ms 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Uint8
32-71 Size of the Control Window (Activation) 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-72 Size of the Control Window (Deactiv.) 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-8* Velocity & Accel.
32-80 Maximum Velocity (Encoder) 1500 RPM 2 set-ups TRUE 67 Uint32
32-81 Shortest Ramp 1.000 s 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Uint32
32-82 Ramp Type [0] Linear 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
32-83 Velocity Resolution 100 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-84 Default Velocity 50 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-85 Default Acceleration 50 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
32-9* Development
32-90 Debug Source [0] Controlcard 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

225
4
4
4.1.21 33-** MCO Adv. Settings

226
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
33-0* Home Motion
33-00 Force HOME [0] Home not forced 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-01 Zero Point Offset from Home Pos. 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-02 Ramp for Home Motion 10 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-03 Velocity of Home Motion 10 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-04 Behaviour during HomeMotion [0] Revers and index 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
4 Parameter Lists

33-1* Synchronization
33-10 Synchronization Factor Master (M:S) 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-11 Synchronization Factor Slave (M:S) 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-12 Position Offset for Synchronization 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-13 Accuracy Window for Position Sync. 1000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-14 Relative Slave Velocity Limit 0% 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint8
33-15 Marker Number for Master 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
33-16 Marker Number for Slave 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
33-17 Master Marker Distance 4096 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-18 Slave Marker Distance 4096 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-19 Master Marker Type [0] Encoder Z positive 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-20 Slave Marker Type [0] Encoder Z positive 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-21 Master Marker Tolerance Window 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-22 Slave Marker Tolerance Window 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-23 Start Behaviour for Marker Sync [0] Start Function 1 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint16
33-24 Marker Number for Fault 10 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
33-25 Marker Number for Ready 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
33-26 Velocity Filter 0 us 2 set-ups TRUE -6 Int32
33-27 Offset Filter Time 0 ms 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Uint32
33-28 Marker Filter Configuration [0] Marker filter 1 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-29 Filter Time for Marker Filter 0 ms 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Int32
33-30 Maximum Marker Correction 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint32
33-31 Synchronisation Type [0] Standard 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-4* Limit Handling
33-40 Behaviour atEnd Limit Switch [0] Call error handler 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-41 Negative Software End Limit -500000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-42 Positive Software End Limit 500000 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
33-43 Negative Software End Limit Active [0] Inactive 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-44 Positive Software End Limit Active [0] Inactive 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-45 Time in Target Window 0 ms 2 set-ups TRUE -3 Uint8
33-46 Target Window LimitValue 1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


33-47 Size of Target Window 0 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
FC 300 Programming Guide
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
33-5* I/O Configuration
33-50 Terminal X57/1 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-51 Terminal X57/2 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-52 Terminal X57/3 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-53 Terminal X57/4 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-54 Terminal X57/5 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-55 Terminal X57/6 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-56 Terminal X57/7 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-57 Terminal X57/8 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-58 Terminal X57/9 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-59 Terminal X57/10 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-60 Terminal X59/1 and X59/2 Mode [1] Output 2 set-ups FALSE - Uint8
FC 300 Programming Guide

33-61 Terminal X59/1 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-62 Terminal X59/2 Digital Input [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-63 Terminal X59/1 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-64 Terminal X59/2 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-65 Terminal X59/3 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-66 Terminal X59/4 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-67 Terminal X59/5 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-68 Terminal X59/6 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-69 Terminal X59/7 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-70 Terminal X59/8 Digital Output [0] No function 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-8* Global Parameters
33-80 Activated Program Number -1 N/A 2 set-ups TRUE 0 Int8
33-81 Power-up State [1] Motor on 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-82 Drive Status Monitoring [1] On 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-83 Behaviour afterError [0] Coast 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-84 Behaviour afterEsc. [0] Controlled stop 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8
33-85 MCO Supplied by External 24VDC [0] No 2 set-ups TRUE - Uint8

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


4 Parameter Lists

227
4
4
4.1.22 34-** MCO Data Readouts

228
Par. No. # Parameter description Default value 4-set-up FC 302 Change during op- Conver- Type
only eration sion index
34-0* PCD Write Par.
34-01 PCD 1 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-02 PCD 2 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-03 PCD 3 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-04 PCD 4 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-05 PCD 5 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
4 Parameter Lists

34-06 PCD 6 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16


34-07 PCD 7 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-08 PCD 8 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-09 PCD 9 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-10 PCD 10 Write to MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-2* PCD Read Par.
34-21 PCD 1 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-22 PCD 2 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-23 PCD 3 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-24 PCD 4 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-25 PCD 5 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-26 PCD 6 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-27 PCD 7 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-28 PCD 8 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-29 PCD 9 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-30 PCD 10 Read from MCO 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-4* Inputs & Outputs
34-40 Digital Inputs 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-41 Digital Outputs 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-5* Process Data
34-50 Actual Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-51 Commanded Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-52 Actual Master Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-53 Slave Index Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-54 Master Index Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-55 Curve Position 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-56 Track Error 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-57 Synchronizing Error 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-58 Actual Velocity 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-59 Actual Master Velocity 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-60 Synchronizing Status 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


34-61 Axis Status 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-62 Program Status 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Int32
34-64 MCO 302 Status 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-65 MCO 302 Control 0 N/A All set-ups TRUE 0 Uint16
34-7* Diagnosis readouts
34-70 MCO Alarm Word 1 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
34-71 MCO Alarm Word 2 0 N/A All set-ups FALSE 0 Uint32
FC 300 Programming Guide
FC 300 Programming Guide 5 Troubleshooting

5 Troubleshooting

5.1.1 Warnings/Alarm Messages

A warning or an alarm is signalled by the relevant LED on the front of the frequency converter and indicated by a code on the display.

A warning remains active until its cause is no longer present. Under certain circumstances operation of the motor may still be continued. Warning messages
may be critical, but are not necessarily so.

In the event of an alarm, the frequency converter will have tripped. Alarms must be reset to restart operation once their cause has been rectified.

This may be done in three ways:


1. By using the [RESET] control button on the LCP control panel.

2. Via a digital input with the “Reset” function. 5


3. Via serial communication/optional fieldbus.

NB!
After a manual reset using the [RESET] button on the LCP, the [AUTO ON] button must be pressed to restart the motor.

If an alarm cannot be reset, the reason may be that its cause has not been rectified, or the alarm is trip-locked (see also table on following page).

Alarms that are trip-locked offer additional protection, meaning that the mains supply must be switched off before the alarm can be reset. After being
switched back on, the frequency converter is no longer blocked and may be reset as described above once the cause has been rectified.

Alarms that are not trip-locked can also be reset using the automatic reset function in par.14-20 Reset Mode (Warning: automatic wake-up is possible!)

If a warning and alarm is marked against a code in the table on the following page, this means that either a warning occurs before an alarm, or else that
you can specify whether it is a warning or an alarm that is to be displayed for a given fault.

This is possible, for instance, in par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection. After an alarm or trip, the motor carries on coasting, and the alarm and warning
flash. Once the problem has been rectified, only the alarm continues flashing until the frequency converter is reset.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 229


5 Troubleshooting FC 300 Programming Guide

No. Description Warning Alarm/Trip Alarm/Trip Lock Parameter


Reference
1 10 Volts low X

2 Live zero error (X) (X) par.6-01 Live Zero Time-


out Function
3 No motor (X) par.1-80 Function at Stop
4 Mains phase loss (X) (X) (X) par.14-12 Function at
Mains Imbalance
5 DC link voltage high X
6 DC link voltage low X
7 DC over-voltage X X
8 DC under voltage X X
9 Inverter overloaded X X
10 Motor ETR over temperature (X) (X) par.1-90 Motor Thermal
Protection
11 Motor thermistor over temperature (X) (X) par.1-90 Motor Thermal
Protection
12 Torque limit X X
13 Over Current X X X

5 14
15
16
Earth Fault
Hardware mismatch
Short Circuit
X X
X
X
X
X
X
17 Control word time-out (X) (X) par.8-04 Control Word
Timeout Function
22 Hoist Mech. Brake
23 Internal Fan Fault X
24 External Fan Fault X par.14-53 Fan Monitor
25 Brake resistor short-circuited X
26 Brake resistor power limit (X) (X) par.2-13 Brake Power
Monitoring
27 Brake chopper short-circuited X X
28 Brake check (X) (X) par.2-15 Brake Check
29 Heatsink temp X X X
30 Motor phase U missing (X) (X) (X) par.4-58 Missing Motor
Phase Function
31 Motor phase V missing (X) (X) (X) par.4-58 Missing Motor
Phase Function
32 Motor phase W missing (X) (X) (X) par.4-58 Missing Motor
Phase Function
33 Inrush Fault X X
34 Fieldbus communication fault X X
36 Mains failure X X
37 Phase imbalance X
38 Internal Fault X X
39 Heatsink sensor X X
40 Overload of Digital Output Terminal 27 (X) par.5-00 Digital I/O
Mode, par.5-01 Terminal
27 Mode
41 Overload of Digital Output Terminal 29 (X) par.5-00 Digital I/O
Mode, par.5-02 Terminal
29 Mode
42 Overload of Digital Output On X30/6 (X) par. 5-32 Term X30/6
Digi Out (MCB 101)
42 Overload of Digital Output On X30/7 (X) par. 5-33 Term X30/7
Digi Out (MCB 101)
46 Pwr. card supply X X
47 24 V supply low X X X
48 1.8 V supply low X X
49 Speed limit X
50 AMA calibration failed X
51 AMA check Unom and Inom X
52 AMA low Inom X
53 AMA motor too big X

Table 5.1: Alarm/Warning code list

230 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 5 Troubleshooting

No. Description Warning Alarm/Trip Alarm/Trip Lock Parameter


Reference
54 AMA motor too small X
55 AMA parameter out of range X
56 AMA interrupted by user X
57 AMA time-out X
58 AMA internal fault X X
59 Current limit X
61 Tracking Error (X) (X) par.4-30 Motor Feed-
back Loss Function
62 Output Frequency at Maximum Limit X

63 Mechanical Brake Low (X) par.2-20 Release Brake


Current
64 Voltage Limit X

65 Control Board Over-temperature X X X


66 Heat sink Temperature Low X
67 Option Configuration has Changed X
68 Safe Stop (X) (X)1) par.5-19 Terminal 37

69
70
Pwr. Card Temp
Illegal FC configuration
X X
X
Safe Stop
5
71 PTC 1 Safe Stop X X1) par.5-19 Terminal 37
Safe Stop
72 Dangerous Failure X1) par.5-19 Terminal 37
Safe Stop
73 Safe Stop Auto Restart
77 Reduced power mode X par. 14-59 Actual Num-
ber of Inverter Units
78 Tracking Error
79 Illegal PS config X X
80 Drive Initialized to Default Value X
81 CSIV corrupt
82 CSIV parameter error
85 Profibus/Profisafe Error
90 Encoder Loss (X) (X) par.17-61 Feedback Sig-
nal Monitoring
91 Analogue input 54 wrong settings X S202
100-199 See Operating Instructions for MCO 305
243 Brake IGBT X X
244 Heatsink temp X X X
245 Heatsink sensor X X
246 Pwr.card supply X X
247 Pwr.card temp X X
248 Illegal PS config X X
250 New spare part X par. 14-23 Typecode
Setting
251 New Type Code X X

Table 5.2: Alarm/Warning code list

(X) Dependent on parameter


1) Can not be Auto reset via par.14-20 Reset Mode
A trip is the action when an alarm has appeared. The trip will coast the motor and can be reset by pressing the reset button or make a reset by a digital
input (Par. 5-1* [1]). The origin event that caused an alarm cannot damage the frequency converter or cause dangerous conditions. A trip lock is an
action when an alarm occurs, which may cause damage to frequency converter or connected parts. A Trip Lock situation can only be reset by a power
cycling.

LED indication
Warning yellow
Alarm flashing red
Trip locked yellow and red

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 231


5 Troubleshooting FC 300 Programming Guide

Alarm Word Extended Status Word


Bit Hex Dec Alarm Word Alarm Word 2 Warning Word Warning Extended
Word 2 Status Word
0 00000001 1 Brake Check (A28) ServiceTrip, Read/ Brake Check (W28) Ramping
Write
1 00000002 2 Pwr. Card Temp ServiceTrip, (re- Pwr. Card Temp (W69) AMA Running
(A69) served)
2 00000004 4 Earth Fault (A14) ServiceTrip, Type- Earth Fault (W14) Start CW/CCW
code/Sparepart
3 00000008 8 Ctrl.Card Temp ServiceTrip, (re- Ctrl.Card Temp (W65) Slow Down
(A65) served)
4 00000010 16 Ctrl. Word TO (A17) ServiceTrip, (re- Ctrl. Word TO (W17) Catch Up
served)
5 00000020 32 Over Current (A13) Over Current (W13) Feedback High
6 00000040 64 Torque Limit (A12) Torque Limit (W12) Feedback Low
7 00000080 128 Motor Th Over Motor Th Over (W11) Output Current High
(A11)
8 00000100 256 Motor ETR Over Motor ETR Over (W10) Output Current Low
(A10)
9 00000200 512 Inverter Overld. Inverter Overld (W9) Output Freq High

5 10 00000400 1024
(A9)
DC under Volt (A8) DC under Volt (W8) Output Freq Low
11 00000800 2048 DC over Volt (A7) DC over Volt (W7) Brake Check OK
12 00001000 4096 Short Circuit (A16) DC Voltage Low (W6) Braking Max
13 00002000 8192 Inrush Fault (A33) DC Voltage High (W5) Braking
14 00004000 16384 Mains ph. Loss (A4) Mains ph. Loss (W4) Out of Speed Range
15 00008000 32768 AMA Not OK No Motor (W3) OVC Active
16 00010000 65536 Live Zero Error (A2) Live Zero Error (W2) AC Brake
17 00020000 131072 Internal Fault (A38) KTY error 10V Low (W1) KTY Warn Password Timelock
18 00040000 262144 Brake Overload Fans error Brake Overload (W26) Fans Warn Password Protection
(A26)
19 00080000 524288 U phase Loss (A30) ECB error Brake Resistor (W25) ECB Warn
20 00100000 1048576 V phase Loss (A31) Brake IGBT (W27)
21 00200000 2097152 W phase Loss (A32) Speed Limit (W49)
22 00400000 4194304 Fieldbus Fault Fieldbus Fault (W34) Unused
(A34)
23 00800000 8388608 24 V Supply Low 24V Supply Low (W47) Unused
(A47)
24 01000000 16777216 Mains Failure (A36) Mains Failure (W36) Unused
25 02000000 33554432 1.8V Supply Low Current Limit (W59) Unused
(A48)
26 04000000 67108864 Brake Resistor Low Temp (W66) Unused
(A25)
27 08000000 134217728 Brake IGBT (A27) Voltage Limit (W64) Unused
28 10000000 268435456 Option Change Encoder loss (W90) Unused
(A67)
29 20000000 536870912 Drive Initial- Output freq. lim. (W62) Unused
ized(A80)
30 40000000 1073741824 Safe Stop (A68) PTC 1 Safe Stop Safe Stop (W68) PTC 1 Safe Unused
(A71) Stop (W71)
31 80000000 2147483648 Mech. brake low Dangerous Failure Extended Status Word Unused
(A63) (A72)

Table 5.3: Description of Alarm Word, Warning Word and Extended Status Word

The alarm words, warning words and extended status words can be read out via serial bus or optional fieldbus for diagnose. See alsopar.16-94 Ext. Status
Word.

WARNING 1, 10 Volts low: Check the supply voltage and supply currents to the frequency converter.
The 10 V voltage from terminal 50 on the control card is below 10 V.
WARNING 5, DC link voltage high:
Remove some of the load from terminal 50, as the 10 V supply is over- The intermediate circuit voltage (DC) is higher than the overvoltage limit
loaded. Max. 15 mA or minimum 590 Ω. of the control system. The frequency converter is still active.
WARNING/ALARM 2, Live zero error: WARNING 6, DC link voltage low
The signal on terminal 53 or 54 is less than 50% of the value set in par. The intermediate circuit voltage (DC) is below the undervoltage limit of
6-10 Terminal 53 Low Voltage, par.6-12 Terminal 53 Low Current, par.
the control system. The frequency converter is still active.
6-20 Terminal 54 Low Voltage, or par.6-22 Terminal 54 Low Current re-
WARNING/ALARM 7, DC over voltage:
spectively.
If the intermediate circuit voltage exceeds the limit, the frequency con-
WARNING/ALARM 3, No motor: verter trips after a time.
No motor has been connected to the output of the frequency converter.
Possible corrections:
WARNING/ALARM 4, Mains phase loss: Connect a brake resistor
A phase is missing on the supply side, or the mains voltage imbalance is
Extend the ramp time
too high.
This message also appears in case of a fault in the input rectifier on the Activate functions in par.2-10 Brake Function
frequency converter.

232 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 5 Troubleshooting

Increase par.14-26 Trip Delay at Inverter Fault ALARM 14, Earth fault:
There is a discharge from the output phases to earth, either in the cable
Alarm/warning limits: between the frequency converter and the motor or in the motor itself.
3 x 200 - 240 3 x 380 - 500 V 3 x 525 - 600 V
Turn off the frequency converter and remove the earth fault.
V
[VDC] [VDC] [VDC] ALARM 15, Incomplete hardware:
Undervoltage 185 373 532
Voltage warning 205 410 585 A fitted option is not handled by the present control board (hardware or
low software).
Voltage warning 390/405 810/840 943/965
high (w/o brake ALARM 16, Short-circuit
- w/brake) There is short-circuiting in the motor or on the motor terminals.
Overvoltage 410 855 975
Turn off the frequency converter and remove the short-circuit.
The voltages stated are the intermediate circuit voltage of the fre-
quency converter with a tolerance of ± 5 %. The corresponding WARNING/ALARM 17, Control word timeout:
mains voltage is the intermediate circuit voltage (DC-link) divided There is no communication to the frequency converter.
by 1.35
The warning will only be active when par.8-04 Control Word Timeout
Function is NOT set to OFF.
WARNING/ALARM 8, DC under voltage:
If the intermediate circuit voltage (DC) drops below the “voltage warning
If par.8-04 Control Word Timeout Function is set to Stop and Trip, a 5
warning appears and the frequency converter ramps down until it trips,
low” limit (see table above), the frequency converter checks if 24 V back-
while giving an alarm.
up supply is connected.
par.8-03 Control Word Timeout Time could possibly be increased.
If no 24 V backup supply is connected, the frequency converter trips after
a given time depending on the unit. WARNING 23, Internal fan fault:

To check whether the supply voltage matches the frequency converter, The fan warning function is an extra protection function that checks if the

see General Specifications. fan is running / mounted. The fan warning can be disabled in par.
14-53 Fan Monitor (set to [0] Disabled).
WARNING/ALARM 9, Inverter overloaded:
The frequency converter is about to cut out because of an overload (too WARNING 24, External fan fault:

high current for too long). The counter for electronic, thermal inverter The fan warning function is an extra protection function that checks if the
fan is running / mounted. The fan warning can be disabled in par.
protection gives a warning at 98% and trips at 100%, while giving an
alarm. You cannot reset the frequency converter until the counter is be- 14-53 Fan Monitor (set to [0] Disabled).

low 90%. WARNING 25, Brake resistor short-circuited:


The fault is that the frequency converter is overloaded by more than The brake resistor is monitored during operation. If it short-circuits, the
100% for too long. brake function is disconnected and the warning appears. The frequency

WARNING/ALARM 10, Motor ETR over temperature: converter still works, but without the brake function. Turn off the fre-

According to the electronic thermal protection (ETR), the motor is too hot. quency converter and replace the brake resistor (see par.2-15 Brake

You can choose if you want the frequency converter to give a warning or Check).

an alarm when the counter reaches 100% in par.1-90 Motor Thermal ALARM/WARNING 26, Brake resistor power limit:
Protection. The fault is that the motor is overloaded by more than 100% The power transmitted to the brake resistor is calculated as a percentage,
for too long. Check that the motor par.1-24 Motor Current is set correctly. as a mean value over the last 120 s, on the basis of the resistance value

WARNING/ALARM 11, Motor thermistor over temp: of the brake resistor (par.2-11 Brake Resistor (ohm)) and the intermedi-

The thermistor or the thermistor connection is disconnected. You can ate circuit voltage. The warning is active when the dissipated braking

choose if you want the frequency converter to give a warning or an alarm power is higher than 90%. If Trip [2] has been selected in par.2-13 Brake

when the counter reaches 100% in par.1-90 Motor Thermal Protection. Power Monitoring, the frequency converter cuts out and issues this alarm,

Check that the thermistor is connected correctly between terminal 53 or when the dissipated braking power is higher than 100%.

54 (analog voltage input) and terminal 50 (+ 10 V supply), or between ALARM/ WARNING 27, Brake chopper fault:
terminal 18 or 19 (digital input PNP only) and terminal 50. If aKTY sen- The brake transistor is monitored during operation and if it short-circuits,
soris used, check for correct connection between terminal 54 and 55. the brake function disconnects and the warning comes up. The frequency

WARNING/ALARM 12, Torque limit: converter is still able to run, but since the brake transistor has short-

The torque is higher than the value in par.4-16 Torque Limit Motor circuited, substantial power is transmitted to the brake resistor, even if it

Mode (in motor operation) or the torque is higher than the value in par. is inactive.

4-17 Torque Limit Generator Mode (in regenerative operation). Turn off the frequency converter and remove the brake resistor.
This alarm/ warning could also occur should the brake resistor overheat.
WARNING/ALARM 13, Over Current:
Terminal 104 to 106 are available as brake resistor. Klixon inputs, see
The inverter peak current limit (approx. 200% of the rated current) is
section Brake Resistor Temperature Switch.
exceeded. The warning will last approx. 8-12 sec., then the frequency
converter trips and issues an alarm. Turn off the frequency converter and
Warning: There is a risk of substantial power being
check if the motor shaft can be turned and if the motor size matches the
transmitted to the brake resistor if the brake transistor
frequency converter.
is short-circuited.
If extended mechanical brake control is selected, trip can be reset exter-
nally.

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 233


5 Troubleshooting FC 300 Programming Guide

ALARM/WARNING 28, Brake check failed:


1312 Option SW in slot C1 is too old
Brake resistor fault: the brake resistor is not connected/working. 1315 Option SW in slot A is not supported (not allowed)
1316 Option SW in slot B is not supported (not allowed)
ALARM 29, Drive over temperature: 1317 Option SW in slot C0 is not supported (not allowed)
If the enclosure is IP 20 or IP 21/Type 1, the cut-out temperature of the 1318 Option SW in slot C1 is not supported (not allowed)
1536 An exception in the Application Orientated Control is
heat-sink is 95 oC +5 oC. The temperature fault cannot be reset, until the registered. Debug information written in LCP
temperature of the heatsink is below 70 oC +5 oC. 1792 DSP watchdog is active. Debugging of power part data
Motor Orientated Control data not transferred correctly
The fault could be: 2049 Power data restarted
2315 Missing SW version from power unit
- Ambient temperature too high
2816 Stack overflow Control board module
- Too long motor cable 2817 Scheduler slow tasks
2818 Fast tasks
ALARM 30, Motor phase U missing: 2819 Parameter thread
2820 LCP stack overflow
Motor phase U between the frequency converter and the the motor is
2821 Serial port overflow
missing. 2822 USB port overflow
Turn off the frequency converter and check motor phase U. 3072- Parameter value is outside its limits. Perform a initiali-
5122 zation. Parameter number causing the alarm: Subtract

5 ALARM 31, Motor phase V missing:


Motor phase V between the frequency converter and the motor is missing.
the code from 3072. Ex Error code 3238: 3238-3072 =
166 is outside the limit
5123 Option in slot A: Hardware incompatible with Control
Turn off the frequency converter and check motor phase V. board hardware
5124 Option in slot B: Hardware incompatible with Control
ALARM 32, Motor phase W missing: board hardware
Motor phase W between the frequency converter and the motor is miss- 5125 Option in slot C0: Hardware incompatible with Control
board hardware
ing. 5126 Option in slot C1: Hardware incompatible with Control
Turn off the frequency converter and check motor phase W. board hardware
5376- Out of memory
ALARM 33, Inrush fault: 6231
Too many power ups have occured within a short time period. See the
chapter General Specifications for the allowed number of power ups with- WARNING 40, Overload of Digital Output Terminal 27
in one minute. Check the load connected to terminal 27 or remove short-circuit connec-
tion. Check par.5-00 Digital I/O Mode and par.5-01 Terminal 27 Mode.
WARNING/ALARM 34, Fieldbus communication fault:
The fieldbus on the communication option card is not working correctly. WARNING 41, Overload of Digital Output Terminal 29:
Please check parameters associated with the module and make sure Check the load connected to terminal 29 or remove short-circuit connec-
module is properly inserted in Slot A of the drive. Check the wiring for tion. Check par.5-00 Digital I/O Mode and par.5-02 Terminal 29 Mode.
fieldbus. WARNING 42, Overload of Digital Output On X30/6 :
WARNING/ALARM 36, Mains failure: Check the load connected to X30/6 or remove short-circuit connection.
This warning/alarm is only active if the supply voltage to the frequency Check par. 5-32 Term X30/6 Digi Out (MCB 101).
converter is lost and par.14-10 Mains Failure is NOT set to OFF. Possible WARNING 42, Overload of Digital Output On X30/7 :
correction: check the fuses to the frequency converter Check the load connected to X30/7 or remove short-circuit connection.
ALARM 37, Phase imbalance: Check par. 5-33 Term X30/7 Digi Out (MCB 101).
There is a current imbalance between the power units WARNING 47, 24 V supply low:
ALARM 38, Internal fault: The external 24 V DC backup power supply may be overloaded, otherwise
By this alarm it may be necessary to contact your Danfoss supplier. Some Contact your Danfoss supplier.
typical alarm messages: WARNING 48, 1.8 V supply low:
Contact your Danfoss supplier.
0 The serial port cannot be initialized. Serious hardware
failure WARNING 49, Speed limit:
256 The power EEPROM data is defect or too old The speed is not within the specified range in par.4-11 Motor Speed Low
512 The control board EEPROM data is defect or too old
513 Communication time out Reading EEPROM data Limit [RPM] and par.4-13 Motor Speed High Limit [RPM].
514 Communication time out Reading EEPROM data
ALARM 50, AMA calibration failed:
515 The Application Orientated Control cannot recognize the
EEPROM data Contact your Danfoss supplier.
516 Cannot write write to the EEPROM because a write com-
mand is on progress ALARM 51, AMA check Unom and Inom:
517 The write command is under time out The setting of motor voltage, motor current, and motor power is pre-
518 Failure in the EEPROM
519 Missing or invalid BarCode data in EEPROM 1024 – 1279 sumably wrong. Check the settings.
CAN telegram cannot be sent. (1027 indicate a possible
ALARM 52, AMA low Inom:
hardware failure)
1281 Digital Signal Processor flash time-out The motor current is too low. Check the settings.
1282 Power micro software version mismatch
1283 Power EEPROM data version mismatch ALARM 53, AMA motor too big:
1284 Cannot read Digital Signal Processor software version The motor is too big for the AMA to be carried out.
1299 Option SW in slot A is too old
1300 Option SW in slot B is too old ALARM 54, AMA motor too small:
1311 Option SW in slot C0 is too old
The motor is too small for the AMA to be carried out.

234 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide 5 Troubleshooting

ALARM 55, AMA par. out of range: tivated. When that happens, a reset signal must be is be sent (via Bus,
The motor parameter values found from the motor are outside acceptable Digital I/O, or by pressing [RESET]).
range. WARNING 71, PTC 1 Safe Stop:
ALARM 56, AMA interrupted by user: Safe Stop has been activated from the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card
The AMA has been interrupted by the user. (motor too warm). Normal operation can be resumed when the MCB 112

ALARM 57, AMA timeout: applies 24 V DC to T-37 again (when the motor temperature reaches an
acceptable level) and when the Digital Input from the MCB 112 is deac-
Try to start the AMA again a number of times, until the AMA is carried
out. Please note that repeated runs may heat the motor to a level where tivated. Warning: Automatic Restart.

the resistance Rs and Rr are increased. In most cases, however, this is ALARM 72, Dangerous Failure:
not critical. Safe Stop with Trip Lock. The Dangerous Failure Alarm is issued if the
combination of safe stop commands is unexpected. This is the case if the
ALARM 58, AMA internal fault:
MCB 112 VLT PTC Thermistor Card enables X44/ 10 but safe stop is
Contact your Danfoss supplier.
somehow not enabled. Furthermore, if the MCB 112 is the only device
WARNING 59, Current limit:
using safe stop (specified through selection [4] or [5] in par. 5-19), an
The current is higher than the value in par.4-18 Current Limit.

ALARM/WARNING 61, Tracking Error:


unexpected combination is activation of safe stop without the X44/ 10
being activated. The following table summarizes the unexpected combi-
5
An error between calculated speed and speed measurement from feed- nations that lead to Alarm 72. Note that if X44/ 10 is activated in selection
back device. The function Warning/Alarm/Disabling setting is in par. 2 or 3, this signal is ignored! However, the MCB 112 will still be able to
4-30 Motor Feedback Loss Function. Accepted error setting in par. activate Safe Stop.
4-31 Motor Feedback Speed Error and the allowed time the error occur
setting in par.4-32 Motor Feedback Loss Timeout. During a commission- Function No. X44/ 10 (DI) Safe Stop T37
ing procedure the function may be effective. PTC 1 Warning [4] + -
WARNING 62, Output Frequency at Maximum Limit: - +
The output frequency is higher than the value set in par.4-19 Max Output PTC 1 Alarm [5] + -
Frequency. This is a warning in VVC+ mode and an alarm (trip) in Flux - +
mode. PTC 1 & Relay A [6] + -
PTC 1 & Relay W [7] + -
ALARM 63, Mechanical Brake Low:
PTC 1 & RelayA/ W [8] + -
The actual motor current has not exceeded the “release brake” current
PTC 1 & Relay W/A [9] + -
within the “Start delay” time window.

WARNING 64, Voltage Limit:


+: activated
The load and speed combination demands a motor voltage higher than
-: Not activated
the actual DC link voltage.
ALARM 78, Tracking Error:
WARNING/ALARM/TRIP 65, Control Card Over Temperature: Please contact Danfoss
Control card over temperature: The cut-out temperature of the control
ALARM 80, Drive Initialised to Default Value:
card is 80° C.
Parameter settings are initialised to default setting after a manual (three-
WARNING 66, Heatsink Temperature Low: finger) reset.
The heat sink temperature is measured as 0° C. This could indicate that
ALARM 90, Encoder loss:
the temperature sensor is defect and thus the fan speed is increased to
Check the connection to encoder option and eventually replace the MCB
the maximum in case the power part or control card is very hot.
102or MCB 103.
ALARM 67, Option Configuration has Changed:
ALARM 91, Analogue Input 54 Wrong Settings:
One or more options has either been added or removed since the last
Switch S202 has to be set in position OFF (voltage input) when a KTY
power down.
sensor is connected to analogue input terminal 54.
ALARM 68, Safe Stop:
ALARM 250, New Spare Part:
Safe Stop has been activated. To resume normal operation, apply 24 V
The power or Switch Mode Power Supply has been exchanged. The fre-
DC to T-37. Press reset button on LCP.
quency converter type code must be restored in the EEPROM. Select the
WARNING 68, Safe Stop: correct type code in par. 14-23 Typecode Setting according to the label
Safe Stop has been activated. Normal operation is resumed when Safe on unit. Remember to select ‘Save to EEPROM’ to complete.
Stop is disabled. Warning: Automatic Restart!
ALARM 251, New Type Code:
ALARM 70, Illegal FC Configuration: The Frequency Converter has got a new type code.
Actual combination of control board and power board is illegal.

ALARM 71, PTC 1 Safe Stop:


Safe Stop has been activated from the MCB 112 PTC Thermistor Card
(motor too warm). Normal operation can be resumed when the MCB 112
applies 24 V DC to T-37 again (when the motor temperature reaches an
acceptable level) and when the Digital Input from the MCB 112 is deac-

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 235


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

Index

A
Abbreviations 4
Ac Brake Max. Current 2-16 65
Access To Main Menu W/o Password 0-61 43
Access To Quick Menu W/o Password 0-66 44
Activate Brake Delay 2-23 67
[Activate Brake Speed Hz] 2-22 67
[Activate Brake Speed Rpm] 2-21 67
Active Set-up 0-10 33
Actual Baud Rate 9-63 141
Actual Typecode String 15-45 182
Actual Value 9-07 133
Address 8-31 129
Aeo Minimum Magnetisation 14-41 175
Alarm Log 181
Alarm Log: Time 15-32 181
Alarm Log: Value 15-31 181
Alarm Messages 229
Alarm Word 128
Alarm Word 16-90 191
Alarm Word 2 16-91 191
Analog In X30/11 16-75 190
Analog In X30/12 16-76 190
Analog Input 53 16-62 188
Analog Input 54 16-64 189
Analog Inputs 6
[Analog Out X30/8 Ma] 16-77 190
[Analog Out X45/1 Ma] 16-78 190
[Analog Out X45/3 Ma] 16-79 190
[Analog Output 42 Ma] 16-65 189
Array Index 10-30 150
[Auto On] Key On Lcp 0-42 42
Automatic Motor Adaptation (ama) 1-29 48
Automatic Restart Time 14-21 172

B
Back Emf At 1000 Rpm 1-40 51
Baud Rate Select 10-01 145
Brake Check 2-15 65
Brake Check Condition 2-18 66
Brake Control 233
Brake Energy /2 Min 16-33 186
Brake Energy /s 16-32 186
Brake Function 2-10 64
Brake Power 6
Brake Power Limit (kw) 2-12 64
Brake Power Monitoring 2-13 64
Brake Release Time 2-25 67
Brake Resistor (ohm) 2-11 64, 198
Break-away Torque 5
Bus Controlled 106
Bus Jog 1 Speed 8-90 132
Bus Jog 2 Speed 8-91 132
Bus Password Access 0-67 44
[Bypass Speed From Hz] 4-61 89
[Bypass Speed From Rpm] 4-60 89
[Bypass Speed To Hz] 4-63 89
[Bypass Speed To Rpm] 4-62 89

C
Can Protocol 10-00 145
Capacitance Output Filter 14-56 176
Catch Up 92

236 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide Index

Catch Up/slow Down Value 3-12 71


Changed Parameters (1) 9-90 143
Changed Parameters (2) 9-91 143
Changed Parameters (3) 9-92 143
Changed Parameters (5) 9-94 144
Changing A Data Value 25
Changing A Group Of Numeric Data Values 24
Changing A Text Value 24
Changing Data 23
Clock Rate 17-25 193
Clockwise 56
Coasting 4, 17
Coasting Select 8-50 130
Comm. Option Stw 16-84 191
Communication Option 234
Comparator Operand 13-10 156
Comparator Operator 13-11 159
Comparator Value 13-12 159
Configurable Control Word Ctw 8-14 128
Configurable Status Word Stw 8-13 128
Configuration 126, 128
Configuration Mode 1-00 45
Control Cables 11
Control Card Temp. 16-39 187
Control Site 8-01 125
Control Word 16-00 184
Control Word 1 9-67 141
Control Word Profile 8-10 128
Control Word Source 8-02 126
Control Word Timeout Function 8-04 126
Control Word Timeout Time 8-03 126
Cooling 58
Cos Filter 1 10-20 150
Cos Filter 2 10-21 150
Cos Filter 3 10-22 150
Cos Filter 4 10-23 150
Counter A 16-72 190
Counter B 16-73 190
Current Lim Ctrl, Filter Time 14-32 174
Current Lim Ctrl, Integration Time 14-31 174
Current Lim Ctrl, Proportional Gain 14-30 174
Current Limit 4-18 84
Custom Readout 16-09 184
Custom Readout Max Value 0-32 41

D
Data Log Settings 178
D-axis Inductance (ld) 1-37 50, 197
Dc Brake Current 2-01 63
[Dc Brake Cut In Speed Hz] 2-04 63
[Dc Brake Cut In Speed Rpm] 2-03 63
Dc Brake Select 8-52 130
Dc Braking Time 2-02 63
Dc Hold Current 2-00 63
Dc Link 232
Dc Link Voltage 16-30 186
Default Settings 199
Default Settings 1
Defined Parameters 15-92 183
Defined Parameters (1) 9-80 142
Defined Parameters (2) 9-81 143
Defined Parameters (3) 9-82 143
Defined Parameters (4) 9-83 143
Defined Parameters (5) 9-84 143
Definitions 4
Device Identification 9-64 141
Devicenet 146

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 237


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

Devicenet And Can Fieldbus 145


Devicenet F Parameters 10-39 151
Devicenet Revision 10-32 150
Diagnosis Trigger 8-07 127
Digi Pot Reference 16-53 187
Digital & Relay Bus Control 5-90 106
Digital I/o Mode 5-00 89
Digital Input 16-60 188
[Digital Output Bin] 16-66 189
Display Line 1.1 Small 0-20 36
Display Mode 18
Display Mode - Selection Of Read-outs 19
Drive Identification 181
Drive Information 177

E
Edit Set-up 0-11 33
Electrical Terminals 10
Electronic Terminal Relay 60
Encoder Pulses 106
End-of-timeout Function 8-05 127
Environment 175
Etr 185, 233
Ext. Status Word 16-94 191
External Reference 16-50 187

F
Fan Control 14-52 175
Fan Monitor 14-53 175
Fault Code 9-45 140
Fault Log: Error Code 15-30 181
Fault Message Counter 9-44 140
Fault Number 9-47 140
Fault Situation Counter 9-52 140
Fc Port Baud Rate 8-32 129
Fc Port Ctw 1 16-85 191
Fc Port Ref 1 16-86 191
Fc Profile 128
Fc Type 15-40 182
Feedback Direction 17-60 194
Feedback Signal Monitoring 17-61 194
[Feedback Unit] 16-52 187
Fieldbus Ctw 1 16-80 190
Fieldbus Ref 1 16-82 191
Flux Motor Feedback Source 1-02 45
Flying Start 1-73 56
Freeze Output 4
[Freq. Input #33 Hz] 16-68 189
Frequency 16-13 185
[Frequency %] 16-15 185
Frequency Converter Ordering No 15-46 182
Frequency Converter Serial Number 15-51 182
Function At Mains Imbalance 14-12 171
Function At Stop 1-80 56
Function Relay 5-40 98

G
Gain Boost Factor 2-28 68
General Warning 3
Graphical Display 15

H
[Hand On] Key On Lcp 0-40 42
Heatsink Temp. 16-34 186
High Speed Load Compensation 1-61 54

238 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide Index

Hiperface Baudrate 17-34 193


Historic Log 180
Historic Log: Event 15-20 180
Historic Log: Time 15-22 181
Historic Log: Value 15-21 181

I
Incremental Encoder 187
Indexed Parameters 25
Indicator Lights 16
Inductance Output Filter 14-57 176
Infinitely Variable Change Of Numeric Data Value 24
Initialisation 1
Input Frequency 17-52 193
Input Voltage 17-51 193
Intermediate Circuit 232
Inv. Max. Current 16-37 186
Inv. Nom. Current 16-36 186
Inverter Thermal 16-35 186
Iron Loss Resistance (rfe) 1-36 50

J
Jog 4
Jog Ramp Time 3-80 80
[Jog Speed Hz] 3-11 71
[Jog Speed Rpm] 3-19 74

K
Keypad, 0-4* 42
Kty Sensor 233
Kty Sensor Temperature 16-19 185
Kty Sensor Type 1-95 62
Kty Thermistor Resource 1-96 62
Kty Threshold Level 1-97 62
Kwh Counter 15-02 177

L
Language 0-01 31
Language Package 1 31
Language Package 2 31
Language Package 3 31
Language Package 4 31
Lcp 26
Lcp Copy 0-50 42
Lcp Id No 15-48 182
Leds 15
Live Zero Timeout Function 6-01 108
Live Zero Timeout Time 6-00 108
Load Type 1-67 54
Local Control Keys 1
Local Mode Configuration 1-05 46
Local Reference 32
Logging Buffer Full 16-40 187
Logging Interval 15-11 179
Logging Mode 15-13 180
Logging Source 15-10 178
Logic Rule Boolean 1 13-40 160
Logic Rule Boolean 2 13-42 161
Logic Rule Boolean 3 13-44 163
Logic Rule Operator 1 13-41 161
Logic Rule Operator 2 13-43 163
Low Speed Load Compensation 1-60 53

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 239


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

M
Mac Id 10-02 145
[Main Actual Value %] 16-05 184
Main Menu 20
Main Menu Mode 16
Main Menu Mode 23
Main Menu Password 0-60 43
Main Reactance 48
Main Reactance (xh) 1-35 50
Mains Failure 14-10 169
Mains Supply 8
Mains Voltage At Mains Fault 14-11 171
Max Inter-char Delay 8-37 129
Max Output Frequency 4-19 84
Max Response Delay 8-36 129
Maximum Inertia 1-69 55
Maximum Limit 3-93 82
Maximum Reference 3-03 70
[Min Speed For Function At Stop Hz] 1-82 57
[Min Speed For Function At Stop Rpm] 1-81 57
[Min Speed Normal Magnetising Hz] 1-52 51
[Min Speed Normal Magnetising Rpm] 1-51 51
Min Value Of User-defined Readout 0-31 41
Min. Current At Low Speed 1-66 54
Minimum Aeo Frequency 14-42 175
Minimum Inertia 1-68 55
Minimum Limit 3-94 82
Minimum Reference 3-02 70
Minimum Response Delay 8-35 129
Missing Motor Phase Function 4-58 88
Model Shift Frequency 1-53 52
Modified Parameters 15-93 183
Motor Angle 16-20 185
Motor Angle Offset 1-41 51
Motor Construction 1-10 46
Motor Cont. Rated Torque 1-26 48
Motor Control Principle 1-01 45
Motor Cosphi 14-43 175
Motor Current 1-24 47, 185
Motor External Fan 1-91 60
Motor Feedback Loss Function 4-30 85
Motor Feedback Loss Timeout 4-32 86
Motor Feedback Speed Error 4-31 86
Motor Frequency 1-23 47
Motor Magnetisation At Zero Speed 1-50 51
Motor Nominal Speed 1-25 48
Motor Poles 1-39 50
[Motor Power Hp] 1-21 47
[Motor Power Kw] 1-20 47
Motor Protection 58
Motor Speed Direction 4-10 83
[Motor Speed High Limit Hz] 4-14 84
[Motor Speed High Limit Rpm] 4-13 83
[Motor Speed Low Limit Hz] 4-12 83
[Motor Speed Low Limit Rpm] 4-11 83
Motor Speed Unit 0-02 32
Motor Status 184
Motor Thermal 16-18 185
Motor Thermal Protection 1-90 58
Motor Voltage 1-22 47, 185
My Personal Menu 0-25 39

N
Net Control 10-15 149
Net Reference 10-14 149

240 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide Index

Node Address 9-18 136


Numerical Local Control Panel 26

O
Off Delay, Relay 5-42 100
[Off] Key On Lcp 0-41 42
On Delay, Relay 5-41 100
On Reference Bandwidth 7-39 123
Operating Hours 15-00 177
Operating Mode 32
Operating State At Power-up (hand) 0-04 32
Operation Mode 14-22 172
Option Ident. 183
Option Mounted 15-60 183
Option Ordering No 15-62 183
Option Serial No 15-63 183
Option Supplied By External 24vdc 14-80 176
Option Sw Version 15-61 183
Ordered Typecode String 15-44 182
Output Filter 14-55 176
Output Speed 55
Over Temp's 15-04 177
Over Volt's 15-05 177
Overload Mode 1-04 46
Overmodulation 14-03 169
Over-voltage Control 2-17 65

P
Parameter Access 150
Parameter Edit 9-27 140
Parameter Info 183
Parameter Metadata 15-99 183
Parameter Selection 23
Parameter Set-up 20
Parameters For Signals 9-23 137
Pcd Read Configuration 9-16 134
Pcd Write Configuration 9-15 133
Poles 17-50 193
Potentiometer Reference 13
Power Card Ordering No 15-47 182
Power Card Serial Number 15-53 183
[Power Hp] 16-11 185
[Power Kw] 16-10 184
Power Restore 3-92 82
Power Section 15-41 182
Power Up's 15-03 177
Prec. Stop Counter 16-74 190
Precise Stop Counter Value 1-84 57
Precise Stop Function 1-83 57
Precise Stop Speed Compensation Delay 1-85 57
Preset Reference 3-10 71
Preset Reference Select 8-56 132
Preset Relative Reference 3-14 72
Process Cl Feedback 1 Resource 7-20 122
Process Cl Feedback 2 Resource 7-22 122
Process Control 9-28 140
Process Data Config Read 10-12 147
Process Data Config Write 10-11 146
Process Data Type Selection 10-10 146
Process Pid Anti Windup 7-31 122
Process Pid Clamped Output 18-92 195
Process Pid Diff. Gain Limit 7-36 123
Process Pid Differentiation Time 7-35 123
Process Pid Error 18-90 195
Process Pid Extended Pid 7-50 125
Process Pid Fb. Filter Time 7-57 125
Process Pid Feed Forward Factor 7-38 123

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 241


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

Process Pid Feed Fwd Gain 7-51 125


Process Pid Feed Fwd Normal/ Inv. Ctrl. 7-46 124
Process Pid Feed Fwd Ramp Down 7-53 125
Process Pid Feed Fwd Ramp Up 7-52 125
Process Pid Feed Fwd Resource 7-45 124
Process Pid Gain Scale At Max. Ref. 7-44 124
Process Pid Gain Scale At Min. Ref. 7-43 124
Process Pid Gain Scaled Output 18-93 195
Process Pid Integral Time 7-34 123
Process Pid I-part Reset 7-40 123
Process Pid Normal/ Inverse Control 7-30 122
Process Pid Output 18-91 195
Process Pid Output Neg. Clamp 7-41 124
Process Pid Output Normal/ Inv. Ctrl. 7-49 124
Process Pid Output Pos. Clamp 7-42 124
Process Pid Proportional Gain 7-33 123, 198
Process Pid Ref. Filter Time 7-56 125
Process Pid Start Speed 7-32 123
Profibus Save Data Values 9-71 142
Profibus Warning Word 9-53 140
Profibusdrivereset 9-72 142
Profile Number 9-65 141
Programming Set-up 9-70 142
Protection Mode 9
Protocol 8-30 129
Protocol Selection 17-20 192
Pulse Filter Time Constant #29 5-54 102
Pulse Filter Time Constant #33 5-59 102
[Pulse Input #29 Hz] 16-67 189
Pulse Out #27 Bus Control 5-93 106
Pulse Out #27 Timeout Preset 5-94 106
Pulse Out #29 Bus Control 5-95 107
Pulse Out #29 Timeout Preset 5-96 107
Pulse Out #x30/6 Bus Control 5-97 107
Pulse Out #x30/6 Timeout Preset 5-98 107
[Pulse Output #27 Hz] 16-69 189
[Pulse Output #29 Hz] 16-70 189
Pulse Output Max Freq #27 5-62 104
Pulse Output Max Freq #29 5-65 104
Pulse Output Max Freq #x30/6 5-68 105
Pulse Reference 16-51 187
Pulse Start/stop 12
Pwm Random 14-04 169

Q
Quick Menu 16, 21
Quick Menu Mode 16, 20
Quick Menu Password 0-65 43
Quick Stop Ramp Time 3-81 80
Quick Stop Ramp Type 3-82 81
Quick Stop Select 8-51 130
Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio At Decel. End 3-84 81
Quick Stop S-ramp Ratio At Decel. Start 3-83 81
Quick Transfer Of Parameter Settings Between Multiple Frequency Converters 18

R
Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time 3-42 75
Ramp 1 Ramp Up Time 3-41 75
Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. End 3-46 76
Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. Start 3-45 75
Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. End 3-48 76
Ramp 1 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. Start 3-47 76
Ramp 1 Type 3-40 75
Ramp 2 Ramp Down Time 3-52 76
Ramp 2 Ramp Up Time 3-51 76
Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. End 3-56 77
Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. Start 3-55 77

242 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide Index

Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. End 3-58 77


Ramp 2 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. Start 3-57 77
Ramp 2 Type 3-50 76
Ramp 3 Ramp Down Time 3-62 78
Ramp 3 Ramp Up Time 3-61 78
Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. End 3-66 78
Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. Start 3-65 78
Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. End 3-68 78
Ramp 3 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. Start 3-67 78
Ramp 3 Type 3-60 77
Ramp 4 Ramp Down Time 3-72 79
Ramp 4 Ramp Up Time 3-71 79
Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. End 3-76 79
Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio At Accel. Start 3-75 79
Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. End 3-78 79
Ramp 4 S-ramp Ratio At Decel. Start 3-77 79
Ramp 4 Type 3-70 78
Ramp Delay 3-95 82
Ramp Time 3-91 82
Rated Motor Speed 5
Rcd 7
Readout Bus Off Counter 10-07 145
Readout Receive Error Counter 10-06 145
Readout Transmit Error Counter 10-05 145
Readout: Edit Set-ups / Channel 0-14 35
Readout: Linked Set-ups 0-13 35
[Reference %] 16-02 184
Reference Function 3-04 70
Reference Range 3-00 69
Reference Resource 1 3-15 72
Reference Resource 2 3-16 73
Reference Resource 3 3-17 73
Reference Site 3-13 72
[Reference Unit] 16-01 184
Reference/feedback Unit 3-01 69
Regional Settings 0-03 32
Relative Scaling Reference Resource 3-18 73
[Relay Output Bin] 16-71 189
Relay Outputs 96
Release Brake Current 2-20 67
Reset 17
Reset Control Word Timeout 8-06 127
Reset Kwh Counter 15-06 177
Reset Mode 14-20 171
Reset Running Hours Counter 15-07 177
Reset Slc 13-03 155
[Reset] Key On Lcp 0-43 42
Resolution (positions/rev) 17-21 192
Resolution (ppr) 17-11 192
Resolver Interface 17-59 194
Resonance Dampening 1-64 54
Resonance Dampening Time Constant 1-65 54
Reversing Select 8-54 131
Rfi Filter 14-50 175
Rotor Leakage Reactance (x2) 1-34 50
Rotor Resistance (rr) 1-31 49
Running Hours 15-01 177

S
Safety Precautions 8
Samples Before Trigger 15-14 180
Screened/armoured 11
Serial Communication 6
Service Code 14-29 174
Setpoint 9-00 133
Set-up Copy 0-51 43
Set-up Select 8-55 131

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 243


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

Signal Type 17-10 192


Sl Controller Action 13-52 166
Sl Controller Event 13-51 165
Sl Controller Mode 13-00 152
Sl Controller State 16-38 186
Sl Controller Timer 13-20 159
Slip Compensation 1-62 54
Slip Compensation Time Constant 1-63 54
Software Version 15-43 182
Special Functions 168
Speed Pid Diff. Gain Limit 7-05 120
Speed Pid Differentiation Time 7-04 120
Speed Pid Feed Forward Factor 7-08 121
Speed Pid Feedback Gear Ratio 7-07 121
Speed Pid Feedback Source 7-00 119
Speed Pid Integral Time 7-03 120
Speed Pid Lowpass Filter Time 7-06 120
Speed Pid Proportional Gain 7-02 119, 198
[Speed Rpm] 16-17 185
Speed Up/down 13
Ssi Data Format 17-26 193
Ssi Data Length 17-24 192
Stall Protection 14-35 174
Start Current 1-76 56
Start Delay 55
Start Delay 1-71 55
Start Event 13-01 152
Start Function 55
Start Function 1-72 55
Start Select 8-53 131
[Start Speed Hz] 1-75 56
[Start Speed Rpm] 1-74 56
Start/stop 12
Stator Leakage Reactance 48
Stator Leakage Reactance (x1) 1-33 49
Stator Resistance (rs) 1-30 49
Status 16
Status Messages 15
Status Word 16-03 184
Status Word 1 9-68 142
Step Size 3-90 81
Step-by-step 25
Stop Delay 2-24 67
Stop Event 13-02 154
Store Always 10-33 151
Store Data Values 10-31 150
Sw Id Control Card 15-49 182
Sw Id Power Card 15-50 182
Switching Frequency 14-01 168
Switching Pattern 14-00 168
Synchronous Motor Speed 5

T
Telegram Selection 8-40 129
Telegram Selection 9-22 136
Term 32/33 Encoder Direction 5-71 106
Term 32/33 Pulses Per Revolution 5-70 106
Term. 29 High Frequency 5-51 101
Term. 29 High Ref./feedb. Value 5-53 101
Term. 29 Low Frequency 5-50 101
Term. 29 Low Ref./feedb. Value 5-52 101
Term. 33 High Frequency 5-56 102
Term. 33 High Ref./feedb. Value 5-58 102
Term. 33 Low Frequency 5-55 102
Term. 33 Low Ref./feedb. Value 5-57 102
Term. X30/11 Filter Time Constant 6-36 111
Term. X30/11 High Ref./feedb. Value 6-35 111

244 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark


FC 300 Programming Guide Index

Term. X30/11 Low Ref./feedb. Value 6-34 111


Term. X30/12 Filter Time Constant 6-46 111
Term. X30/12 High Ref./feedb. Value 6-45 111
Term. X30/12 Low Ref./feedb. Value 6-44 111
Terminal 27 Mode 5-01 90
Terminal 27 Pulse Output Variable 5-60 103
Terminal 29 Mode 5-02 90
Terminal 29 Pulse Output Variable 5-63 104
Terminal 37 Safe Stop 5-19 94
Terminal 42 Output 6-50 112
Terminal 42 Output Bus Control 6-53 113
Terminal 42 Output Filter 6-55 114
Terminal 42 Output Max Scale 6-52 113
Terminal 42 Output Min Scale 6-51 113
Terminal 42 Output Timeout Preset 6-54 114
Terminal 53 Filter Time Constant 6-16 109
Terminal 53 High Current 6-13 109
Terminal 53 High Ref./feedb. Value 6-15 109
Terminal 53 High Voltage 6-11 109
Terminal 53 Low Current 6-12 109
Terminal 53 Low Ref./feedb. Value 6-14 109
Terminal 53 Low Voltage 6-10 109
Terminal 53 Switch Setting 16-61 188
Terminal 54 Filter Time Constant 6-26 110
Terminal 54 High Current 6-23 110
Terminal 54 High Ref./feedb. Value 6-25 110
Terminal 54 High Voltage 6-21 110
Terminal 54 Low Current 6-22 110
Terminal 54 Low Ref./feedb. Value 6-24 110
Terminal 54 Low Voltage 6-20 109
Terminal 54 Switch Setting 16-63 189
Terminal X30/11 High Voltage 6-31 110
Terminal X30/11 Low Voltage 6-30 110
Terminal X30/12 High Voltage 6-41 111
Terminal X30/12 Low Voltage 6-40 111
Terminal X30/6 Pulse Output Variable 5-66 105
Terminal X30/8 Bus Control 6-63 116
Terminal X30/8 Max. Scale 6-62 116
Terminal X30/8 Min. Scale 6-61 115
Terminal X30/8 Output 6-60 114
Terminal X30/8 Output Timeout Preset 6-64 116
Terminal X45/1 Output Min Scale, 6-71 117
Terminal X45/3 Output Min Scale, 6-81 118
Thermal Load 51, 185
Thermistor 58
Thermistor 7
Thermistor Source 1-93 60
This Set-up Linked To 0-12 34
[Torque %] 16-22 186
Torque Characteristics 1-03 46
Torque Limit Factor Source 4-20 84
Torque Limit Generator Mode 4-17 84
Torque Limit Motor Mode 4-16 84
[Torque Nm] 16-16 185
[Torque Nm] High 16-25 186
Torque Pi Integration Time 7-13 122
Torque Pi Proportional Gain 7-12 121
Torque Ramp Time 2-27 68
Torque Ref 2-26 68
Tracking Error 4-35 86
Tracking Error After Ramping Timeout 4-39 87
Tracking Error Function 4-34 86
Tracking Error Ramping 4-37 86
Tracking Error Ramping Timeout 4-38 87
Tracking Error Timeout 4-36 86
Transformation Ratio 17-53 193
Trigger Event 15-12 179
Trip Delay At Current Limit 14-24 173

MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark 245


Index FC 300 Programming Guide

Trip Delay At Inverter Fault 14-26 173


Trip Delay At Torque Limit 14-25 173
Trip Reset 171

U
U/f Characteristic - F 1-56 53
U/f Characteristic - U 1-55 52
Unit For User-defined Readout 0-30 40

V
Vlt Ext. Status Word 14-74 176
Voltage 15-42 182
Voltage Reference Via A Potentiometer 13
Vt Level 14-40 175
Vvcplus 7

W
Warning Current High 4-51 87
Warning Current Low 4-50 87
Warning Feedback High 4-57 88
Warning Feedback Low 4-56 88
Warning Parameter 10-13 149
Warning Reference High 4-55 88
Warning Reference Low 4-54 88
Warning Speed High 4-53 88
Warning Speed Low 4-52 87
Warning Word 128
Warning Word 16-92 191
Warning Word 2 16-93 191
Warnings 229
Wobble Delta Freq. Scaled 30-19 197
Wobble Delta Freq. Scaling Resource 30-03 196
[Wobble Delta Frequency %] 30-02 196
[Wobble Delta Frequency Hz] 30-01 196
[Wobble Jump Frequency %] 30-05 197
[Wobble Jump Frequency Hz] 30-04 196
Wobble Jump Time 30-06 197
Wobble Mode 30-00 195
Wobble Random Function 30-09 197
Wobble Random Ratio Max. 30-11 197
Wobble Random Ratio Min. 30-12 197
Wobble Ratio 30-10 197
Wobble Sequence Time 30-07 197
Wobble Up/ Down Time 30-08 197

246 MG.33.M5.02 - VLT® is a registered Danfoss trademark

You might also like